2014 200
2014
OWNER’S MANUAL
Chrysler Group LLC
14C41-126-AA
First Edition
Printed in U.S.A.
200
VEHICLES SOLD IN CANADA
With respect to any Vehicles Sold in Canada, the name Chrysler
Group LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name Chrysler
Canada Inc. used in substitution therefore.
Drunken driving is one of the most frequent causes of accidents.
This manual illustrates and describes the operation of features
and equipment that are either standard or optional on this
vehicle. This manual may also include a description of features
and equipment that are no longer available or were not ordered
on this vehicle. Please disregard any features and equipment
described in this manual that are not on this vehicle.
Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood alcohol
levels far below the legal minimum. If you are drinking, don’t drive.
Ride with a designated non-drinking driver, call a cab, a friend, or use
public transportation.
Chrysler Group LLC reserves the right to make changes in
design and specifications, and/or make additions to or improvements to its products without imposing any obligation upon itself
to install them on products previously manufactured.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
WARNING!
Driving after drinking can lead to an accident. Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are slower, and your judgment is impaired when you have been drinking. Never drink
and then drive.
Copyright © 2013 Chrysler Group LLC
SECTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
1
2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2
3
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
3
4
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
4
5
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
5
6
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
6
7
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
7
8
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
8
9
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
9
10
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
10
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
䡵 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER . . . . . . . .6
䡵 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS . . . .7
䡵 WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
1
4 INTRODUCTION
When it comes to service, remember that your authorized
dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained techCongratulations on selecting your new Chrysler Group
nicians and genuine parts, and cares about your satisfacLLC vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision
tion.
workmanship, distinctive styling, and high quality - all
essentials that are traditional to our vehicles.
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
INTRODUCTION
This Owner’s Manual has been prepared with the assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint
you with the operation and maintenance of your vehicle.
It is supplemented by Warranty Information, and various
customer-oriented documents. Please take the time to
read these publications carefully. Following the instructions and recommendations in this manual will help
assure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section
contains the information you desire.
Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the
items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and
illustrations may differ from your vehicle’s equipment.
The detailed index at the back of this Owner’s Manual
contains a complete listing of all subjects.
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it Consult the following table for a description of the
should be stored in the vehicle for convenient referenc- symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout
ing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
this Owner’s Manual:
INTRODUCTION 5
1
6 INTRODUCTION
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
This Owners Manual contains WARNINGS against operating procedures that could result in a collision or
bodily injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures that could result in damage to your vehicle. If you
do not read this entire Owners Manual, you may miss
important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is on the left
front corner of the instrument panel and is visible from
outside of the vehicle through the windshield. This
number also appears stamped on the right front door sill
under the sill moulding and printed on the Automobile
Information Disclosure Label affixed to a window on
your vehicle, the vehicle registration and title.
Vehicle Identification Number
INTRODUCTION 7
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle could
seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety and
may lead to a collision resulting in serious injury or
death.
Stamped VIN Location
NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
1
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2
CONTENTS
䡵 A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
▫ To Arm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
▫ To Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
▫ Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ Tamper Alert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
▫ Locking the Doors with the Key . . . . . . . . . . . .15 䡵 ILLUMINATED ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . .21
䡵 SENTRY KEY® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 䡵 REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ To Unlock The Doors. . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Customer Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
▫ To Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
▫ To Unlatch The Trunk . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM — IF EQUIPPED . . .19
▫ Using The Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . .
▫ Rearming The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
. . . . . . . . .22
. . . . . . . . .22
. . . . . . . . .25
. . . . . . . . .26
. . . . . . . . .26
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Programming Additional Transmitters. . . . . . . .26
▫ Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .26
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
䡵 REMOTE START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED . . . .28
▫ How To Use Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
䡵 DOOR LOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Manual Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
▫ Child-Protection Door Lock System —
Rear Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
▫ Auto Window Up With Anti-Pinch
Protection — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
▫ Window Lockout Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
䡵 TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
䡵 TRUNK SAFETY WARNING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
▫ Trunk Internal Emergency Release . . . . . . . . . .41
䡵 OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
▫ Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
▫ Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure . . . . .50
䡵 POWER WINDOWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
▫ Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage . . .51
▫ Power Window Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
▫ Rear Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
▫ Auto Window Down — If Equipped . . . . . . . .37
▫ Seat Belts In Passenger Seating Positions . . . . . .51
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
▫ Automatic Locking Retractor Mode (ALR) —
If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
▫ Energy Management Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
▫ Seat Belt Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
▫ Supplemental Active Head Restraints (AHR) . . .54
▫ Air Bag Deployment Sensors And Controls . . . .66
▫ Event Data Recorder (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
▫ Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
▫ Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
䡵 ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS . . . .95
▫ Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
䡵 SAFETY TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
(BeltAlert®) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
▫ Transporting Passengers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
▫ Seat Belts And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . .59
▫ Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
▫ Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
▫ Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
▫ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) —
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Air Bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
▫ Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make
▫ Air Bag System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Outside The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
▫ Advanced Front Air Bag Features . . . . . . . . . . .62
2
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
The authorized dealer that sold you your vehicle has the
key code numbers for your vehicle locks. These numbers
can be used to order duplicate keys from your authorized
dealer. Ask your authorized dealer for these numbers
and keep them in a safe place.
You can insert the double-sided keys into the locks with
either side up.
Vehicle Key
Ignition Key Removal
Automatic Transaxle
Place the shift lever in PARK. Turn the ignition switch to
the ACC position, push the key and cylinder inward,
rotate the key to the LOCK position, and remove the key.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
NOTE:
• If you try to remove the key before you place the shift
lever in PARK, the key may become trapped temporarily in the ignition switch lock cylinder. If this occurs,
rotate the key to the right slightly, then remove the key
as described. If a malfunction occurs, the system will
trap the key in the ignition switch lock cylinder to
warn you that this safety feature is inoperable. The
engine can be started and stopped, but the key cannot
be removed until you obtain service.
Ignition Switch Positions
1 — LOCK
2 — ACC (ACCESSORY)
3 — ON/RUN
4 — START
• For vehicles not equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), the power window
switches, radio, hands–free system (if equipped), and
power outlets will remain active for 45 seconds after
the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position.
Opening either door will cancel this feature.
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), the power window
2
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
switches, radio, hands–free system (if equipped), and
power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes
after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position. Opening either front door will cancel this feature.
The time for this feature is programmable. Refer to
“Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/
Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
WARNING!
• Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the parking
brake, shift the transmission into PARK, and remove the Key Fob from the ignition. When leaving
the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
CAUTION!
An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves. Always
remove key from the ignition and lock all doors
when leaving the vehicle unattended.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
key forward. For door lock lubrication, see “Maintenance
Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” of this
Opening the driver’s door when the key is in the ignition
manual.
sounds a signal to remind you to remove the key.
Key-In-Ignition Reminder
NOTE:
SENTRY KEY®
• The Key-In-Ignition reminder only sounds when the The Sentry Key® Immobilizer System prevents unauignition key is placed in the LOCK or ACC position. thorized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation
• With either front door open, and the key in the is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked
ignition, both the power door locks and Remote Key- or unlocked.
less Entry (RKE) transmitter will not function.
The system uses ignition keys which have an embedded
Locking the Doors with the Key
electronic chip (transponder) to prevent unauthorized
There is only one external door lock cylinder which is vehicle operation. Therefore, only keys that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate
located in the driver’s door.
the vehicle. The system will shut the engine off in two
You can insert the key with either side up. To lock the
seconds if someone uses an invalid key to start the
door, turn the key rearward. To unlock the door, turn the
engine.
2
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: A key which has not been programmed is also
considered an invalid key even if it is cut to fit the
ignition switch lock cylinder for that vehicle.
During normal operation, after turning on the ignition
switch, the Vehicle Security Light will turn on for three
seconds for a bulb check. If the light remains on after the
bulb check, it indicates that there is a problem with the
electronics. In addition, if the light begins to flash after
the bulb check, it indicates that someone used an invalid
key to start the engine. Either of these conditions will
result in the engine being shut off after two seconds.
CAUTION!
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer system is not compatible with some aftermarket remote starting systems.
Use of these systems may result in vehicle starting
problems and loss of security protection.
All of the keys provided with your vehicle have been
programmed to the vehicle electronics.
Replacement Keys
NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to the
If the Vehicle Security Light turns on during normal vehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Once
vehicle operation (vehicle running for longer than 10 a Sentry Key® has been programmed to a vehicle, it
seconds), it indicates that there is a fault in the electron- cannot be programmed to any other vehicle.
ics. Should this occur, have the vehicle serviced as soon
as possible by an authorized dealer.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
CAUTION!
Always remove the Sentry Key® from the vehicle
and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Customer Key Programming
You can program new keys to the system if you have two
valid Sentry Keys® by performing the following procedure:
1. Cut the additional Sentry Key® Transponder blank(s)
At the time of purchase, the original owner is provided
to match the ignition switch lock cylinder key code.
with a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN).
The PIN is required for authorized dealer replacement of 2. Insert the first valid key into the ignition switch. Turn
the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position for at
keys. Duplication of keys may be performed at an
least three seconds, but no longer than 15 seconds.
authorized dealer or by using the Customer Key ProThen, turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position
gramming procedure. This procedure consists of proand remove the first key.
gramming a blank key to the vehicle electronics. A blank
key is one which has never been programmed.
3. Insert the second valid key into the ignition switch.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position
NOTE: When having the Sentry Key® Immobilizer
within 15 seconds. After ten seconds, a chime will
System serviced, bring all vehicle keys with you to the
sound. In addition, the Vehicle Security Light will
authorized dealer.
begin to flash. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK
position and remove the second key.
2
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
4. Insert a blank Sentry Key® into the ignition switch.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position
within 60 seconds. After 10 seconds, a single chime
will sound. In addition, the Vehicle Security Light will
stop flashing. To indicate that programming is complete, the indicator light will turn on again for three
seconds and then turn off.
NOTE: If a programmed key is lost, see your authorized
dealer to have all remaining keys erased from the systems memory. This will prevent the lost key from starting
your vehicle. The remaining keys must then be reprogrammed. All vehicle keys must be taken to your authorized dealer at the time of service to be reprogrammed.
General Information
The new Sentry Key® is programmed. The Remote
The Sentry Key® system complies with FCC rules part 15
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter will also be proand with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is
grammed during this procedure.
subject to the following conditions:
Repeat this procedure to program up to eight keys. If you
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
do not have a programmed Sentry Key® contact your
• This device must accept any interference that may be
authorized dealer for details.
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
horn after three minutes, turn off all of the visual signals
after 15 minutes, and then the Vehicle Security Alarm will
The Vehicle Security Alarm monitors the doors and trunk
rearm itself.
for unauthorized entry and ignition switch for unauthorized operation. While the Vehicle Security Alarm is To Arm The System
armed, interior switches for door locks and decklid
1. Remove the keys from the ignition switch and get out
release are disabled.
of the vehicle.
If something triggers the alarm, the Vehicle Security
2. Lock the door using either the power door lock switch
Alarm will signal for about 18 minutes. For the first 3
(one door must be open) or the LOCK button on the
minutes, the horn will sound intermittently, the headRemote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter (doors can be
lights will turn on, the park lamps and/or turn signals
open or closed), and close all doors.
will flash and the Vehicle Security Light in the cluster will
flash. Then the exterior lights will flash for another 15 NOTE: The Vehicle Security Alarm will not arm if you
minutes.
lock the doors with the manual door lock plungers.
VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM — IF EQUIPPED
Rearming The System
If something triggers the alarm, and no action is taken to
disarm it, the Vehicle Security Alarm will turn off the
2
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
3. The Vehicle Security Light in the instrument cluster
will flash for 16 seconds. This shows that the Vehicle
Security Alarm is arming. During this period, if a door
is opened, the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN,
or the power door locks are unlocked in any manner,
the Vehicle Security Alarm will automatically disarm.
To Disarm The System
Either press the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter
or insert a valid Sentry Key® into the ignition lock
cylinder and turn the key to the ON/START position.
NOTE:
• The driver’s door key cylinder and the trunk button on
the RKE transmitter cannot arm or disarm the Vehicle
• During the 16-second arming period, if a door is
Security Alarm.
opened or the ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN,
the Vehicle Security Alarm will automatically disarm. • The Vehicle Security Alarm remains armed during
trunk entry. Pressing the trunk button will not disarm
• Once armed, the Vehicle Security Alarm disables the
the Vehicle Security Alarm. If someone enters the
unlock switch on the driver door trim panel and
vehicle through the trunk and opens any door, the
passenger door trim panel, the trunk release button on
alarm will sound.
the instrument panel, and the HomeLink®/Garage
The Vehicle Security Alarm is designed to protect your
Door Opener (if equipped).
vehicle; however, you can create conditions where the
Vehicle Security Alarm will give you a false alarm. If one
NOTE:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
of the previously described arming sequences has occurred, the Vehicle Security Alarm will arm regardless of
whether you are in the vehicle or not. If you remain in the
vehicle and open a door, the alarm will sound. If this
occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
If the Vehicle Security Alarm is armed and the battery
becomes disconnected the Vehicle Security Alarm will
remain armed when the battery is reconnected. The
exterior lights will flash, and the horn will sound. If this
occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
ILLUMINATED ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED
The courtesy lights will turn on when you press the
unlock button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or open any door.
This feature also turns on the approach lighting in the
outside mirrors (if equipped). Refer to “Mirrors” in
“Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further information.
The interior lights will fade to off after approximately 30
seconds or they will immediately fade to off once the
Tamper Alert
ignition switch is turned to ON/RUN from the OFF
If the alarm was triggered, but the warning signals have position.
timed out, the park and taillights flash three times, and
the horn will chirp three times, when unlocking the NOTE:
vehicle with a valid RKE transmitter to alert the driver. • The front courtesy overhead console and door courtesy lights will remain on if the dimmer control is in
the ⬙Dome ON⬙ position (extreme top position).
2
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• The Illuminated Entry system will not operate if the
dimmer control is in the “Dome defeat” position
(extreme bottom position).
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
EQUIPPED
This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors, open
the trunk, or activate the Panic Alarm from distances
approximately 66 ft (20 m) using a Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter. The RKE transmitter does not need to
be pointed at the vehicle to activate the system.
NOTE:
Vehicle Key
• The line of transmission must not be blocked with To Unlock The Doors
metal objects.
Press and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE
• Inserting the key into the ignition switch disables all transmitter once to unlock the driver’s door, or twice to
unlock all doors. The turn signal lights will flash to
buttons on the RKE transmitter.
acknowledge the unlock signal. The Illuminated Entry
system (if equipped) will also turn on.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
Remote Key Unlock, Driver Door/All Doors First
Press
This feature lets you program the system to unlock either
the driver’s door or all doors on the first press of the
UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter. To change the
current setting, proceed as follows:
2. Release both buttons at the same time.
3. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle by pressing the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on the RKE transmitter with the ignition in the LOCK position and the
key removed.
4. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
its previous setting.
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle
NOTE: If there is no key in the ignition switch, pressing
Information
Center
(EVIC)/Personal
Settings
the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understandinside the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
system. Opening a door with the system activated will
• For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the cause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button to
following procedure:
deactivate the Vehicle Security Alarm system.
1. Press and hold the LOCK button on a programmed
RKE transmitter for at least four seconds, but not
longer than 10 seconds. Then, press and hold the
UNLOCK button while still holding the LOCK button.
2
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle by pressing the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on the RKE transThe feature will cause the turn signal lights to flash when
mitter with the ignition in the LOCK position and the
the doors are locked or unlocked with the RKE transmitkey removed.
ter. This feature can be turned on or turned off. To change
the current setting, proceed as follows:
4. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
its previous setting.
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle NOTE: If there is no key in the ignition switch, pressing
Information
Center
(EVIC)/Personal
Settings the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are in
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understand- the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
system. Opening a door with the system activated will
cause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button to
• For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the
deactivate the Vehicle Security Alarm system.
following procedure:
Illuminated Approach — If Equipped
1. Press and hold the UNLOCK button on a programmed
RKE transmitter for at least 4 seconds, but not longer This feature activates the headlights for up to 90 seconds
than 10 seconds. Then, press and hold the LOCK when the doors are unlocked with the RKE transmitter.
The time for this feature is programmable on vehicles
button while still holding the UNLOCK button.
equipped with EVIC. For details, refer to “Electronic
2. Release both buttons at the same time.
Flash Lights With Lock
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Personal Settings • For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the
following steps:
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding
Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
1. Press the LOCK button on a programmed RKE transmitter for at least 4 seconds, but not longer than 10
To Lock The Doors
seconds. Then, press the PANIC button while still
Press and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitholding the LOCK button.
ter to lock all doors. The turn signal lights will flash and
the horn will chirp once to acknowledge the lock signal. 2. Release both buttons at the same time.
Sound Horn With Lock
3. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle by pressing the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter with the
This feature will cause the horn to chirp when the doors
ignition in the LOCK position and the key removed.
are locked with the RKE transmitter. This feature can be
turned on or off. To change the current setting, proceed as 4. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
follows:
its previous setting.
• For vehicles equipped with EVIC, refer to “Electronic
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Personal Settings
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
2
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If there is no key in the ignition switch, pressing
the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter while you are in
the vehicle will activate the Vehicle Security Alarm.
Opening a door with the alarm activated will cause the
alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button to deactivate
the Vehicle Security Alarm.
To Unlatch The Trunk
The Panic Alarm will stay on for three minutes unless
you turn it off by pressing the PANIC button a second
time or if the vehicle speed is 5 mph (8 km/h) or greater.
NOTE: You may need to be close to the vehicle when
using the RKE transmitter to turn off the Panic Alarm due
to the Radio Frequency (RF) noises emitted by the
system.
Press the TRUNK button on the RKE transmitter two Programming Additional Transmitters
times to unlatch the trunk.
Refer to Sentry Key® “Customer Key Programming.”
Using The Panic Alarm
If you do not have a programmed RKE transmitter,
To turn the Panic Alarm feature on or off, press and hold
the PANIC button on the RKE transmitter for at least one
second and release. When the Panic Alarm is on, the
headlights turn on, the park lights will flash, the horn
will pulse on and off, and the Illuminated Entry system
(if equipped) will turn on.
contact your authorized dealer for details.
Transmitter Battery Replacement
The recommended replacement battery is CR2032.
NOTE: Perchlorate Material — special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
1. With the RKE transmitter buttons facing down, use a 2. Remove and replace the battery. Avoid touching the
flat blade screwdriver to pry the two halves of the RKE
new battery with your fingers. Skin oils may cause
transmitter apart. Make sure not to damage the seal
battery deterioration. If you touch a battery, clean it
during removal.
with rubbing alcohol.
3. To assemble the RKE transmitter case, snap the two
halves together.
General Information
This device complies with part 15 of FCC rules and with
RS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
Separating RKE Transmitter Halves
2. This device must accept any interference that may be
received including interference that may cause undesired operation.
2
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly ap- NOTE: The vehicle must be equipped with an automatic
proved by the party responsible for compliance could transmission to be equipped with Remote Start.
void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
How To Use Remote Start
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate from a normal
All of the following conditions must be met before the
distance, check for these two conditions:
engine will remote start:
1. Weak battery in the RKE transmitter. The expected life
• Shift lever in PARK
of a battery is five years.
• Doors closed
2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station
tower, airport transmitter, military base, and some • Hood closed
mobile or CB radios.
• Trunk closed
REMOTE START SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED
• Hazard switch off
• Brake switch inactive (brake pedal not pressed)
This system uses the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter to start the engine conve- • Ignition key removed from ignition switch
niently from outside the vehicle while still • Battery at an acceptable charge level
maintaining security. The system has a range of
• RKE PANIC button not pressed
approximately 300 ft (91 m).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
• System not disabled from previous remote start event Remote Start Abort Message On Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC) — If Equipped
• Vehicle theft alarm not active
The following messages will display in the EVIC if the
vehicle fails to remote start or exits remote start premaWARNING!
turely:
• Do not start or run an engine in a closed garage or
confined area. Exhaust gas contains Carbon Mon- • Remote Start Aborted — Door Ajar
oxide (CO) which is odorless and colorless. Carbon • Remote Start Aborted — Hood Ajar
Monoxide is poisonous and can cause serious in• Remote Start Aborted — Trunk Ajar
jury or death when inhaled.
• Keep Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitters • Remote Start Aborted — Fuel Low
away from children. Operation of the Remote Start
System, windows, door locks or other controls • Remote Start Aborted — System Fault
could cause serious injury or death.
The EVIC message stays active until the ignition is cycled
to the ON/RUN position.
2
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Enter Remote Start Mode
Press and release the REMOTE START button
on the RKE transmitter twice within five seconds. The vehicle doors will lock, the parking
lights will flash and the horn will chirp twice (if
programmed). Then, the engine will start and the vehicle
will remain in the Remote Start mode for a 15-minute
cycle.
NOTE:
the ignition switch must be cycled to the ON/RUN
position before you can repeat the start sequence for a
third cycle.
Remote start will also cancel if any of the following occur:
• The engine stalls or RPM exceeds 2500
• Any engine warning lamps come on
• Low Fuel Light turns on
• The hood is opened
• If an engine fault is present the vehicle will start and • The hazard switch is pressed
then shut down 10 seconds later.
• The transmission is moved out of PARK
• For security, power window operation is disabled • The brake pedal is pressed
when the vehicle is in the Remote Start mode.
• The engine can be started two consecutive times (two
15 minute cycles) with the RKE transmitter. However,
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31
To Exit Remote Start Mode Without Driving The
Vehicle
DOOR LOCKS
Manual Door Locks
Press and release the REMOTE START button one time or
To lock each door, push the door lock knob on each door
allow the engine to run for the entire 15 minute cycle.
trim panel downward. To unlock each door, pull the
NOTE: To avoid unintentional shut downs, the system inside door handle.
will disable the one-time press of the Remote Start button
for two seconds after receiving a valid remote start
request.
To Exit Remote Start Mode And Drive The Vehicle
Before the end of the 15 minute cycle, press and release
the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter to unlock
the doors and disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm (if
equipped). Then insert the key into the ignition switch
and turn the switch to the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON/RUN
position in order to drive the vehicle.
Manual Lock Knob
2
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• For personal security and safety in the event of an
collision, lock the vehicle doors as you drive as
well as when you park and leave the vehicle.
• Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the parking
brake, shift the transmission into PARK, and remove the Key Fob from the ignition. When leaving
the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
CAUTION!
An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.
Always remove the key from the ignition and lock all
of the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33
Power Door Locks
Automatic Door Locks — If Equipped
A door lock switch is located on the driver and passenger The auto door lock feature default condition is enabled.
door panel. Press this switch to lock or unlock the doors. When enabled, the door locks will lock automatically
when the vehicle’s speed exceeds 15 mph (24 km/h). The
auto door lock feature can be enabled or disabled by your
authorized dealer. Please see your authorized dealer for
service.
Auto Unlock On Exit
The doors will unlock automatically on vehicles with
power door locks if:
1. The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature is enabled.
Power Door Lock Switch
2. The transmission was in gear and the vehicle speed
returned to 0 mph (0 km/h).
3. The transmission is in NEUTRAL or PARK.
4. The driver door is opened.
2
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
5. The doors were not previously unlocked.
6. The vehicle speed is 0 mph (0 km/h).
Auto Unlock On Exit Programming
3. Press the power door unlock switch to unlock the
doors.
4. A single chime will indicate the completion of the
programming.
The Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature can be
5. Repeat these steps if you want to return this feature to
enabled or disabled as follows:
its previous setting.
• For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
NOTE: Use the Automatic Unlock Doors On Exit feature
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle
Information
Center
(EVIC)/Personal
Settings in accordance with local laws.
(Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understand- Child-Protection Door Lock System — Rear
ing Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Doors
• For vehicles not equipped with the EVIC, perform the To provide a safer environment for children riding in the
rear seat, the rear doors of your vehicle have a Childfollowing procedure:
Protection Door Lock system.
1. Close all doors and place the key in the ignition.
2. Cycle the ignition switch between LOCK and ON/
RUN and then back to LOCK four times, ending up in
the LOCK position.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
2
Child-Protection Door Lock Location
The Child-Protection Door Locks are located inside the
rear edge of the door. Insert the tip of the ignition key or
similar flat-bladed object into the lock and rotate clockwise approximately one-quarter turn to the lock position
or counter clockwise to the unlock position (as indicated
by the stamped icons).
Child Lock Control
WARNING!
Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision.
Remember that the rear doors can only be opened
from the outside when the Child-Protection locks are
engaged.
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: For emergency exit with the system engaged,
pull the lock knob up (UNLOCKED position), roll down
the window, and open the door with the outside door
handle.
POWER WINDOWS
Power Window Switches
The control on the driver’s door has up/down switches
that give you fingertip control of all four power windows.
AUTO Power Window Switch
There is a single window control on the front and rear
passenger’s door trim panel, which operates the front
and rear passenger door windows. The window controls
will operate when the ignition switch is turned to the
ON/RUN or ACC position, and when the accessory
delay feature is active.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37
WARNING!
Never leave children unattended in a vehicle, and do
not let children play with power windows. Do not
leave the key fob in or near the vehicle. Occupants,
particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by the windows while operating the power
window switches. Such entrapment may result in
serious injury or death.
Auto Window Down — If Equipped
The front window controls on the driver and passenger
door trim panels have an Auto-Down feature. These
switches are labeled AUTO to indicate this capability.
Push the window switch past the first detent, release, and
the window will go down automatically.
To open the window part way, push the window switch
to the first detent and release it when you want the
window to stop.
To cancel the Auto-Down movement, operate the switch
either in the up or down direction and release the switch.
For vehicles not equipped with the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC), the power window switches
will remain active for 45 seconds after the ignition switch
is turned to the LOCK position. Opening either door will
cancel this feature.
For vehicles equipped with EVIC, the power window
switches will remain active for up to 10 minutes after the
ignition switch is turned off. Opening either door will
cancel this feature. The time for this feature is programmable. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center
(EVIC)/Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
2
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Auto Window Up With Anti-Pinch Protection — If
Equipped
NOTE:
• If the window runs into any obstacle during autoclosure, anti-pinch protection will reverse the window
direction and then go back down. Remove the obstacle
and use the window switch again to close the window.
To cancel the Auto Up movement, operate the switch
either in the up or down direction and release the switch. • Any impact due to rough road conditions may trigger
the auto reverse function unexpectedly during autoTo close the window part way, lift the window switch to
closure. If this happens, pull the switch lightly to the
the first detent and release it when you want the window
first detent and hold to close window manually.
to stop.
Lift the window switch fully upward to the second
detent, release, and the window will go up automatically.
WARNING!
When the window is almost closed, there is no
anti-pinch protection. To avoid personal injury, be
sure to clear your arms, hands, fingers and all objects
from the window path before closing.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
Reset Auto Up
Should the Auto Up feature stop working, the window
probably needs to be reset. To reactivate the Auto Up
feature, pull the window switch up to close the window
completely and continue to hold the switch up for an
additional two seconds after the window is closed.
2
Window Lockout Switch
The window lockout switch on the driver’s door allows
you to disable the window control on the other doors. To
disable the window controls on the other doors, press the
window LOCK button. To enable the window controls,
press the window control button again.
AUTO Power Window Switch
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the rear windows open, then open the front and rear
windows together to minimize the buffeting. If the
buffeting occurs with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize the buffeting.
TRUNK LOCK AND RELEASE
Use the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
transmitter to open the trunk from
outside the vehicle. From inside the
vehicle the trunk lid can be released by
pressing the TRUNK RELEASE button
located on the instrument panel to the
left of the steering wheel.
NOTE: The shift lever must be in PARK for this button to
operate.
To unlatch the trunk lid from outside the vehicle, press
and release the TRUNK button on the RKE transmitter
two times.
With the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position, the
word “dECK ” will display in place of the odometer
display indicating that the trunk is open. The odometer
display will reappear once the trunk is closed or if the
trip button is depressed.
With the ignition switch in the LOCK position or with the
key out, the word “dECK” will display until the trunk is
closed.
On EVIC-equipped vehicles, the words “Trunk Ajar” will
display.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
TRUNK SAFETY WARNING
WARNING!
2
Do not allow children to have access to the trunk,
either by climbing into the trunk from outside, or
through the inside of the vehicle. Always close the
trunk lid when your vehicle is unattended. Once in
the trunk, young children may not be able to escape,
even if they entered through the rear seat. If trapped
in the trunk, children can die from suffocation or
heat stroke.
Trunk Internal Emergency Release
Trunk Internal Emergency Release
OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS
As a security measure, a Trunk Internal Emergency Release
Some of the most important safety features in your
lever is built into the trunk latching mechanism. In the
vehicle are the restraint systems:
event of an individual being locked inside the trunk, the
trunk can be simply opened by pulling on the glow-in-the- • Three-point lap and shoulder belts for all seating
dark handle attached to the trunk latching mechanism.
positions
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Advanced Front Air Bags for driver and front passenger
all the way out and then adjusting the belt to the
desired length to restrain a child seat or secure a large
item in a seat.
• Supplemental Active Head Restraints (AHR) located
on top of the front seats (integrated into the head
restraint) — if equipped
Please pay close attention to the information in this
section. It tells you how to use your restraint system
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC)
properly, to keep you and your passengers as safe as
for the driver and passengers seated next to a window
possible.
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
If you will be carrying children too small for adult-sized
• An energy-absorbing steering column and steering seat belts, the seat belts or the Lower Anchors and Tether
wheel
for CHildren (LATCH) feature also can be used to hold
infant and child restraint systems. For more information
• Knee bolsters/blockers for front seat occupants
on LATCH, refer to Lower Anchors and Tether for
• Front seat belts incorporate pretensioners that may CHildren (LATCH).
enhance occupant protection by managing occupant
NOTE: The Advanced Front Air Bags have a multistage
energy during an impact event
inflator design. This allows the air bag to have different
• All seat belt systems (except the driver’s) include rates of inflation based on several factors, including the
Automatic Locking Retractors (ALRs), which lock the severity and type of collision.
seat belt webbing into position by extending the belt
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the ride properly buckled up in the rear seat. Never allow
risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
children to slide the shoulder belt behind them or under
their arm. If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a rear
1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride
facing child seat) must ride in the front passenger seat,
buckled up in a rear seat.
move the seat as far back as possible and use the proper
child restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”)
WARNING!
• Never place a rear facing infant seat in front of an
air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front Air
Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child 12
years or younger, including a child in a rearward
facing infant seat.
• Only use a rearward-facing child restraint in a
vehicle with a rear seat.
You should read the instructions provided with your
child restraint to make sure that you are using it properly.
2. All occupants should always wear their lap and
shoulder belts properly.
3. The driver and front passenger seats should be moved
back as far as practical to allow the Advanced Front
Air Bags room to inflate.
Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle seat 4. Do not lean against the door or window. If your
belt properly (see section on Child Restraints) should be
vehicle has side air bags, and deployment occurs, the
secured in the rear seat in child restraints or belt posiside air bags will inflate forcefully into the space
tioning booster seats. Older children who do not use
between you and the door.
child restraints or belt-positioning booster seats should
2
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
5. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be
modified to accommodate a disabled person, contact
the Customer Center. Phone numbers are provided
under “If You Need Assistance”.
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, the air bags won’t deploy at all.
Always wear your seat belts even though you have
air bags.
• Being too close to the steering wheel or instrument
panel during Advanced Front Air Bag deployment
could cause serious injury, including death. Air
bags need room to inflate. Sit back, comfortably
extending your arms to reach the steering wheel or
instrument panel.
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC) and Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
also need room to inflate. Do not lean against the
door or window. Sit upright in the center of the
seat.
(Continued)
(Continued)
WARNING!
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
WARNING! (Continued)
• In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer
much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
• Being too close to the Supplemental Side Air Bag
Inflatable Curtain (SABIC) and/or Seat-Mounted
Side Air Bag (SAB) during deployment could cause
you to be severely injured or killed.
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should
be belted at all times.
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with
lap/shoulder belts.
The belt webbing retractor will lock only during very
sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the belt to move freely with you under normal
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even conditions. However, in a collision the belt will lock and
on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver reduce your risk of striking the inside of the vehicle or
and cause a collision that includes you. This can happen being thrown out.
far away from home or on your own street.
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some
2
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Wearing a seat belt incorrectly is dangerous. Seat
belts are designed to go around the large bones of
your body. These are the strongest parts of your
body and can take the forces of a collision the best.
• Wearing your belt in the wrong place could make
your injuries in a collision much worse. You might
suffer internal injuries, or you could even slide out
of part of the belt. Follow these instructions to wear
your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers
safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted into a single
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one
another in a collision, hurting one another badly.
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt for more
than one person, no matter what their size.
(Continued)
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and
adjust the seat.
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front
seat, next to your arm. Grasp the latch plate and pull
out the belt. Slide the latch plate up the webbing as far
as necessary to allow the belt to go around your lap.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
WARNING!
• A belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle will
not protect you properly. The lap portion could ride
too high on your body, possibly causing internal
injuries. Always buckle your belt into the buckle
nearest you.
• A belt that is too loose will not protect you properly. In a sudden stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of injury. Wear
your seat belt snugly.
Pulling Out The Latch Plate
3. When the belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”
2
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
• A belt that is worn under your arm is dangerous.
Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck
injury. A belt worn under the arm can cause internal injuries. Ribs aren’t as strong as shoulder
bones. Wear the belt over your shoulder so that
your strongest bones will take the force in a collision.
• A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect
you from injury during a collision. You are more
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt
are meant to be used together.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
4. Position the lap belt across your thighs, below your
abdomen. To remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull
up on the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is
too tight, tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap belt. A
snug belt reduces the risk of sliding under the belt in
a collision.
WARNING!
• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of
injury in a collision. The belt forces won’t be at the
strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your abdomen. Always wear the lap part of your seat belt as
low as possible and keep it snug.
• A twisted belt may not protect you properly. In a
collision, it could even cut into you. Be sure the belt
is straight. If you can’t straighten a belt in your
vehicle, take it to your authorized dealer immediately and have it fixed.
5. Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that it is
comfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractor will withdraw any slack in the belt.
Positioning The Lap Belt
2
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
6. To release the belt, push the red button on the buckle. Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
The belt will automatically retract to its stowed posi- Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/
tion. If necessary, slide the latch plate down the shoulder belt.
webbing to allow the belt to retract fully.
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the
anchor point.
WARNING!
A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision and
leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose parts.
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do
not disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt
assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they
have been damaged (bent retractor, torn webbing,
etc.).
2. At about 6 to 12 in (15 to 30 cm) above the latch plate,
grasp and twist the belt webbing 180 degrees to create
a fold that begins immediately above the latch plate.
3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing.
The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of
the latch plate.
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the
folded webbing.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage
As a guide, if you are shorter than average, you will
prefer a lower position, and if you are taller than average,
you will prefer a higher position. When you release the
anchorage, try to move it up or down to make sure that
it is locked in position.
In the front seat, the shoulder belt can be adjusted
upward or downward to position the belt away from
your neck. Push anchorage button to release the anchorage, and move it up or down to the position that serves
you best.
Rear Seat Belts
The shoulder belt anchorages of the rear three-point belts
are nonadjustable for outboard and center rear passengers
on sedans. The center belt is mounted to the rear shelf panel
and exits through a bezel in the panel.
Seat Belts In Passenger Seating Positions
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with Automatic Locking Retractors (ALR)
which are used to secure a child restraint system. For
additional information, refer to “Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt” under the “Child
Adjustable Anchorage
2
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Restraints” section. The chart below defines the type of out only the amount of webbing necessary to comfortfeature for each seating position.
ably wrap around the occupant’s mid-section. Slide the
latch plate into the buckle until you hear a ⬙click.⬙
Driver
Center
Passenger
Automatic Locking Retractor Mode (ALR) — If
First Row
N/A
N/A
ALR
Equipped
Second
ALR
ALR
ALR
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically preRow
locked. The belt will still retract to remove any slack in
• N/A — Not Applicable
the shoulder belt. The Automatic Locking Mode is available on all passenger-seating positions with a combina• ALR — Automatic Locking Retractor
tion lap/shoulder belt. Use the Automatic Locking Mode
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an anytime a child safety seat is installed in a seating
ALR and is being used for normal usage:
position that has a belt with this feature. Children 12
Only pull the belt webbing out far enough to comfortably years old and under should always be properly rewrap around the occupant’s mid-section so as to not strained in a vehicle with a rear seat.
activate the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you will hear a How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode
ratcheting sound as the belt retracts. Allow the webbing
to retract completely in this case and then carefully pull 1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53
2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until
the entire belt is extracted.
3. Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will
hear a clicking sound. This indicates the safety belt is
now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode
WARNING!
• The belt and retractor assembly must be replaced if
the seat belt assembly Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) feature or any other seat belt function is not
working properly when checked according to the
procedures in the Service Manual.
• Failure to replace the belt and retractor assembly
could increase the risk of injury in collisions.
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it
to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking
Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency)
Energy Management Feature
locking mode.
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an Energy
Management feature in the front seating positions to help
further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on
collision.
This safety belt system has a retractor assembly that is
designed to release webbing in a controlled manner. This
feature is designed to help reduce the belt force acting on
the occupant’s chest.
2
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Seat Belt Pretensioners
Supplemental Active Head Restraints (AHR)
The seat belts for both front seating positions are
equipped with pretensioning devices that are designed to
remove slack from the seat belt in the event of a collision.
These devices may improve the performance of the seat
belt by assuring that the belt is tight about the occupant
early in a collision. Pretensioners work for all size occupants, including those in child restraints.
These head restraints are passive, deployable components, and vehicles with this equipment cannot be readily
identified by any markings, only through visual inspection of the head restraint. The head restraint will be split
in two halves, with the front half being soft foam and
trim, the back half being decorative plastic.
How The Active Head Restraints (AHR) Work
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) determines
belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be whether the severity, or type of rear impact will require
worn snugly and positioned properly.
the Active Head Restraints (AHR) to deploy. If a rear
The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Re- impact requires deployment, both the driver and front
straint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the preten- passenger seat AHRs will be deployed.
sioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or When AHRs deploy during a rear impact, the front half
a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.
of the head restraint extends forward to minimize the gap
between the back of the occupant’s head and the AHR.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
This system is designed to help prevent or reduce the
extent of injuries to the driver and front passenger in
certain types of rear impacts.
2
NOTE: The Active Head Restraints (AHR) may or may
not deploy in the event of a front or side impact.
However if during a front impact, a secondary rear
impact occurs, the AHR may deploy based on the severity and type of the impact.
Active Head Restraint (AHR) Components
1 — Head Restraint Front Half
(Soft Foam and Trim)
2 — Seatback
3 — Head Restraint Back Half
(Decorative Plastic Rear Cover)
4 — Head Restraint Guide
Tubes
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
1. Grasp the deployed AHR from the rear seat.
All occupants, including the driver, should not operate a vehicle or sit in a vehicle’s seat until the head
restraints are placed in their proper positions in order
to minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a
collision.
NOTE: For more information on properly adjusting and
positioning the head restraint, refer to “Adjusting Active
Head Restraints” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle”.
Resetting Active Head Restraints (AHR)
Hand Positioning Points On AHR
If the Active Head Restraints are triggered in a collision, 2. Position the hands on the top of the deployed AHR at
you must reset the head restraint on the driver’s and
a comfortable position.
front passenger seat. You can recognize when the Active
Head Restraint has been triggered by the fact that they
have moved forward (as shown in step three of the
resetting procedure).
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
3. Pull down then rearward towards the rear of the
vehicle then down to engage the locking mechanism.
2
3 — Final Downward Movement To Engage Locking Mechanism
1 — Downward Movement
2 — Rearward Movement
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
4. The AHR front soft foam and trim half should lock • For safety reasons, have the Active Head Restraints
into the back decorative plastic half.
checked by a qualified specialist at an authorized
dealer.
Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
(BeltAlert®)
BeltAlert® is a feature intended to remind the driver and
front passenger (if equipped with front passenger
BeltAlert®) to fasten their seat belts. The feature is active
whenever the ignition is on. If the driver or front seat
passenger is unbelted, the Seat Belt Reminder Light will
turn on and remain on until both front seat belts are
fastened.
The BeltAlert® warning sequence begins after the vehicle
speed is over 5 mph (8 km/h), by blinking the Seat Belt
NOTE:
Reminder Light and sounding an intermittent chime.
• If you have difficulties or problems resetting the Active Once the sequence starts, it will continue for the entire
duration or until the respective seatbelts are fastened.
Head Restraints, see an authorized dealer.
After the sequence completes, the Seat Belt Reminder
AHR In Reset Position
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
Light remains illuminated until the respective seat belts
are fastened. The driver should instruct all other occupants to fasten their seat belts. If a front seat belt is
unbuckled while traveling at speeds greater than 5 mph
(8 km/h), BeltAlert® will provide both audio and visual
notification.
The front passenger seat BeltAlert® is not active when
the front passenger seat is unoccupied. BeltAlert® may
be triggered when an animal or heavy object is on the
front passenger seat or when the seat is folded flat (if
equipped). It is recommended that pets be restrained in
the rear seat (if equipped) in pet harnesses or pet carriers
that are secured by seat belts, and cargo is properly
stowed.
NOTE: Although BeltAlert® has been deactivated, the
Seat Belt Reminder Light will continue to illuminate
while the driver’s or front passenger (if equipped with
BeltAlert®) seat belt remains unfastened.
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts
throughout their pregnancy. Keeping the mother safe is
the best way to keep the baby safe.
Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the belt
across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible.
Keep the belt low so that it does not come across the
abdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will take
the force if there is a collision.
BeltAlert® can be enabled or disabled by your autho- Seat Belt Extender
rized dealer. Chrysler Group LLC does not recommend If a seat belt is too short, even when fully extended and
deactivating BeltAlert®.
when the adjustable upper shoulder belt anchorage (if
equipped) is in its lowest position, your authorized
2
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
dealer can provide you with a seat belt extender. This passenger’s Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the
extender should be used only if the existing belt is not instrument panel, above the glove compartment. The
long enough. When it is not required, remove the ex- words SRS AIRBAG are embossed on the air bag covers.
tender and store it.
WARNING!
Using a seat belt extender when not needed can
increase the risk of injury in a collision. Only use
when the lap belt is not long enough when it is worn
low and snug, and in the recommended seating
positions. Remove and store the extender when not
needed.
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) — Air Bags
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the
Advanced Front Air Bag And Knee Bolster Locations
driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat
1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags
belt restraint systems. The driver’s Advanced Front Air 2 — Knee Bolster
Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61
NOTE: The Driver and Passenger Advanced Front Air vehicle is equipped with SABIC, they are located above
Bags are certified to new Federal regulations.
the side windows. The trim covering the side air bags is
labeled SRS AIRBAG.
The Advanced Front Air Bags have a multistage inflator
design. This allows the air bag to have different rates of This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental Seatinflation that are based on several factors, including the Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) to provide enhanced
protection for an occupant during a side impact. The
severity and type of collision.
SABs are located in the outboard side of the front seats.
This vehicle may be equipped with driver and/or front
passenger seat track position sensors that may adjust the NOTE:
inflation rate of the Advanced Front Air Bags based upon
• Air Bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim,
seat position.
but they will open during air bag deployment.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front
passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether • After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an
authorized dealer immediately.
the driver or front passenger seat belt is fastened. The
seat belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the Air Bag System Components
Advanced Front Air Bags.
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag
This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental Side Air Bag system components:
Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) to protect the driver, front,
and rear passengers sitting next to a window. If the • Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
2
62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Air Bag Warning Light
• Steering Wheel and Column
• Instrument Panel
• Knee Impact Bolsters
• Driver Advanced Front Air Bag
• Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC)
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
• Front Seat Belt Pretensioners, Seat Belt Buckle Switch,
and Seat Track Position Sensors
output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as
determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC),
which may receive information from the front impact
sensors.
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an
impact that requires air bag deployment. This low output
is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy output is
used for more severe collisions.
WARNING!
• No objects should be placed over or near the air
bag on the instrument panel, because any such
objects could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
collision severe enough to cause the air bag to
inflate.
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage
driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not put anything on or around the air bag
covers or attempt to open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could be injured
because the air bags may no longer be functional.
The protective covers for the air bag cushions are
designed to open only when the air bags are
inflating.
• Do not drill, cut or tamper with the knee bolster in
any way.
• Do not mount any accessories to the knee bolster
such as alarm lights, stereos, citizen band radios,
etc.
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB)
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) may
provide enhanced protection to help protect an occupant
during a side impact. The SAB is marked with an air bag
label sewn into the outboard side of the front seats.
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag Label
2
64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
When the air bag deploys, it opens the seam between the
front and side of the seat’s trim cover. Each air bag
deploys independently; a left side impact deploys the left
air bag only and a right-side impact deploys the right air
bag only.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC)
SABIC air bags may offer side-impact protection to front
and rear seat outboard occupants in addition to that
provided by the body structure. Each air bag features
inflated chambers placed adjacent to the head of each
Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABIC) Location
outboard occupant that reduce the potential for sideimpact head injuries. The SABIC air bags deploy down- NOTE:
ward, covering both windows on the impact side.
• Air Bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim;
but they will open during air bag deployment.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
• Being too close to the SAB and SABIC air bags during
deployment could cause you to be severely injured or
killed.
The system includes side impact sensors that are calibrated to deploy the side air bags during impacts that
require air bag occupant protection.
WARNING!
• Your vehicle is equipped with left and right
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC), do not stack luggage or other cargo up
high enough to block the location of the SABIC.
The area where the SABIC is located should remain
free from any obstructions.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not use accessory seat covers or place objects
between you and the side air bags; the performance
could be adversely affected and/or objects could be
pushed into you, causing serious injury.
• Your vehicle is equipped with SABIC air bags, do
not have any accessory items installed which will
alter the roof, including adding a sunroof to your
vehicle. Do not add roof racks that require permanent attachments (bolts or screws) for installation
on the vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof of the
vehicle for any reason.
• Do not allow occupants to extend any part of their
body outside of the window.
SAB and SABIC air bags are a supplement to the seat belt
restraint system. Occupants, including children who are
up against or very close to SAB or SABIC air bags can be
2
66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
seriously injured or killed. Occupants, especially chil- Air Bag Deployment Sensors And Controls
dren, should not lean on or sleep against the door, side
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
windows, or area where the SAB or SABIC air bags
The ORC is part of a Federally regulated safety system
inflate, even if they are in an infant or child restraint.
required for this vehicle.
Always sit upright as possible with your back against the
seat back, use the seat belts properly, and use the The ORC determines if deployment of the front and/or
appropriate sized child restraint, infant restraint or side air bags in a frontal or side collision is required.
booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the Based on the impact sensor’s signals, a central electronic
ORC deploys the Advanced Front Air Bags, SABIC air
child.
bags, Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags, and
Knee Impact Bolsters
front seat belt pretensioners, as required, depending on
The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of the the severity and type of impact.
driver and front passengers, and position front occupants
Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide addifor the best interaction with the Advanced Front Air
tional protection by supplementing the seat belts in
Bags.
certain frontal collisions depending on several factors,
Along with seat belts and pretensioners, Advanced Front including the severity and type of collision. Advanced
Air Bags work with the knee impact bolsters to provide Front Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk of
improved protection for the driver and front passenger. injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all
frontal collisions, including some that may produce substantial vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions, truck underrides, and angle offset collisions. On
the other hand, depending on the type and location of
impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a
severe initial deceleration.
The side air bags will not deploy in all side collisions.
Side air bag deployment will depend on the severity and
type of collision.
Because air bag sensors measure vehicle deceleration
over time, vehicle speed and damage by themselves are
not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should
have deployed.
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all collisions, and also are needed to help keep you in position,
away from an inflating air bag.
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of
the air bag system whenever the ignition switch is in the
START or ON/RUN position. If the key is in the OFF
position, in the ACC position, or not in the ignition, the
air bag system is not on and the air bags will not inflate.
The ORC contains a backup power supply system that
may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or
it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.
Also, the ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning
Light in the instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds for a self-check
when the ignition is first turned on. After the
self-check, the Air Bag Warning Light will turn off. If the
ORC detects a malfunction in any part of the system, it
turns on the Air Bag Warning Light, either momentarily
or continuously. A single chime will sound if the light
comes on again after initial startup.
2
68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
It also includes diagnostics that will illuminate the instrument cluster Air Bag Warning Light if a malfunction is
noted that could affect the air bag system. The diagnostics also record the nature of the malfunction.
WARNING!
Ignoring the air bag Warning Light in your instrument panel could mean you won’t have the air bags
to protect you in a collision. If the light does not come
on as a bulb check when the ignition is first turned
on, stays on after you start the vehicle, or if it comes
on as you drive, have an authorized dealer service the
air bag system immediately.
Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
Inflator Units
The Driver and Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
Inflator Units are located in the center of the steering
wheel and on the right side of the instrument panel.
When the ORC detects a collision requiring the Advanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large
quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the
Advanced Front Air Bags. Different air bag inflation rates
are possible, based on several factors, including the
collision type and severity. The steering wheel hub trim
cover and the upper right side of the instrument panel
separate and fold out of the way as the air bags inflate to
their full size. The air bags fully inflate in about 50 to 70
milliseconds. This is about half of the time it takes to
blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while
helping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
The Advanced Front Air Bag gas is vented through the
vent holes in the sides of the air bag. In this way, the air
bags do not interfere with your control of the vehicle.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag (SAB)
Inflator Units
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain
(SABIC) Inflator Units
The Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB) are During collisions where the impact is confined to a
designed to activate only in certain side collisions.
particular area of the side of the vehicle, the ORC may
deploy the SABIC air bags, depending on the severity
The ORC determines if a side collision requires the side
and type of collision. In these events, the ORC will
air bags to inflate, based on the severity and type of
deploy the SABIC only on the impact side of the vehicle.
collision.
A quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the side
Based on the severity and type of collision, the side air
curtain air bag. The inflating side curtain air bag pushes
bag inflator on the crash side of the vehicle may be
the outside edge of the headliner out of the way and
triggered, releasing a quantity of non-toxic gas. The
covers the window. The air bag inflates in about 30
inflating SAB exits through the seat seam into the space
milliseconds (about one-quarter of the time that it takes
between the occupant and the door. The SAB fully
to blink your eyes) with enough force to injure you if you
inflates in about 10 milliseconds. The side air bag moves
are not belted and seated properly, or if items are
at a very high speed and with such a high force that it
positioned in the area where the side curtain air bag
could injure you if you are not seated properly, or if items
inflates. This especially applies to children. The side
are positioned in the area where the side air bag inflates.
curtain air bag is only about 3-1/2 in (9 cm) thick when
This especially applies to children.
it is inflated.
2
70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Because air bag sensors estimate deceleration over time, • Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or
until the ignition key is turned off.
vehicle speed and damage are not good indicators of
whether or not an air bag should have deployed.
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as
the battery has power or until the ignition key is
Front And Side Impact Sensors
removed.
In front and side impacts, impact sensors can aid the
ORC in determining appropriate response to impact • Unlock the doors automatically.
events.
In order to reset the Enhanced Accident Response System
Enhanced Accident Response System
functions after an event, the ignition switch must be
In the event of an impact causing air bag deployment, if changed from IGN ON to IGN OFF.
the communication network remains intact, and the
power remains intact, depending on the nature of the
event the ORC will determine whether to have the
Enhanced Accident Response System perform the following functions:
• Cut off fuel to the engine.
If A Deployment Occurs
The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate
immediately after deployment.
NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all
collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with
the air bag system.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 71
If you do have a collision, which deploys the air bags, any
or all of the following may occur:
throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation
continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on
your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer’s instructions for cleaning.
• The nylon air bag material may sometimes cause
abrasions and/or skin reddening to the driver and
front passenger as the air bags deploy and unfold. The Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have deabrasions are similar to friction rope burns or those ployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air
you might get sliding along a carpet or gymnasium bags will not be in place to protect you.
floor. They are not caused by contact with chemicals.
They are not permanent and normally heal quickly.
WARNING!
However, if you haven’t healed significantly within a
few days, or if you have any blistering, see your doctor Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners cannot
protect you in another collision. Have the air bags,
immediately.
seat belt pretensioners, and the front seat belt retrac• As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like tor assemblies replaced by an authorized dealer imparticles. The particles are a normal by-product of the mediately. Also, have the Occupant Restraint Conprocess that generates the non-toxic gas used for air troller System serviced as well.
bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the
skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye
irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or
2
72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Maintaining Your Air Bag System
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Modifications to any part of the air bag system
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could
be injured if the air bag system is not there to
protect you. Do not modify the components or
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the
upper right side of the instrument panel. Do not
modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or running boards.
• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the air
bag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who
works on your vehicle that it has an air bag system.
(Continued)
• Do not attempt to modify any part of your air bag
system. The air bag may inflate accidentally or may
not function properly if modifications are made.
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat, including your
trim cover and cushion, needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or loosening/tightening of
seat attachment bolts), take the vehicle to your
authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved
seat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to
modify the air bag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73
Air Bag Warning Light
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine
related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. The air bags may
not be ready to inflate for your protection. Promptly check
the fuse block for blown fuses. Refer to the label located on
the inside of the fuse block cover for the proper air bag
fuses. See your authorized dealer if the fuse is good.
You will want to have the air bags ready to
inflate for your protection in a collision. The
Air Bag Warning Light monitors the internal
circuits and interconnecting wiring associated
with air bag system electrical components. While the air
bag system is designed to be maintenance free, if any of Event Data Recorder (EDR)
the following occurs, have an authorized dealer service This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder
the air bag system immediately.
(EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in
certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air
• The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during
bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will
the four to eight seconds when the ignition switch is
assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems perfirst turned to the ON/RUN position.
formed. The EDR is designed to record data related to
• The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
eight-second interval.
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle
is designed to record such data as:
• The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or
remains on while driving.
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
2
74 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
were buckled/fastened;
such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the
vehicle or the EDR.
accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
Child Restraints
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all
These data can help provide a better understanding of
times, including babies and children. Every state in the
the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
United States, and every Canadian province, requires
NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a that small children ride in proper restraint systems. This
non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by is the law, and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it.
the EDR under normal driving conditions and no per- Children 12 years or younger should ride properly
sonal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash
are recorded. However, other parties, such as law en- statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in
forcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of the rear seats rather than in the front.
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a
There are different sizes and types of restraints for
crash investigation.
children from newborn size to the child almost large
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is
required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 75
enough for an adult safety belt. Always check the child
seat Owner’s Manual to make sure you have the correct
seat for your child.
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety
Standards. You should also make sure that you can install
it in the vehicle where you will use it.
NOTE:
• For additional information, refer to www.seatcheck.org
or call 1–866–SEATCHECK. Canadian residents should
refer to Transport Canada’s website for additional information:
• http://www.tc.gc.ca/eng/roadsafety/safedriverschildsafety-index-53.htm
WARNING!
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force required to
hold even an infant on your lap could become so
great that you could not hold the child, no matter
how strong you are. The child and others could be
badly injured. Any child riding in your vehicle
should be in a proper restraint for the child’s size.
2
76 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Summary Of Recommendations For Restraining Children In Vehicles
Infants and Toddlers
Small Children
Larger Children
Children Too Large for
Child Restraints
Child Size, Height, Weight or Age
Children who are two years old or
younger and who have not reached the
height or weight limits of their child
restraint
Children who are at least two years old
or who have out-grown the height or
weight limit of their rear-facing child
restraint
Children who have out-grown their
forward-facing child restraint, but are
too small to properly fit the vehicle’s
seat belt
Children 12 years old or younger, who
have out-grown the height or weight
limit of their booster seat
Recommended Type of Child Restraint
Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible
Child Restraint, facing rearward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Forward-Facing Child Restraint with a
five-point Harness, facing forward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Belt Positioning Booster Seat and the
vehicle seat belt, seated in the rear seat
of the vehicle
Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear seat
of the vehicle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 77
Infants And Child Restraints
Safety experts recommend that children ride rearwardfacing in the vehicle until they are two years old or until
they reach either the height or weight limit of their rear
facing child safety seat. Two types of child restraints can
be used rearward-facing: infant carriers and convertible
child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rearward-facing in the
vehicle. It is recommended for children from birth until
they reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used either rearwardfacing or forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child
seats often have a higher weight limit in the rearwardfacing direction than infant carriers do, so they can be
used rearward-facing by children who have outgrown
their infant carrier but are still less than at least two years
old. Children should remain rearward-facing until they
reach the highest weight or height allowed by their
convertible child seat.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear facing infant seat in front of an
air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front Air
Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child 12
years or younger, including a child in a rearward
facing infant seat.
• Only use a rearward-facing child restraint in a
vehicle with a rear seat.
Older Children And Child Restraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown
their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forwardfacing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who
2
78 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of
their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should
remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for
as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height
allowed by the child seat.
All children whose weight or height is above the
forward-facing limit for the child seat should use a
belt-positioning booster seat until the vehicle’s seat belts
fit properly. If the child cannot sit with knees bent over
the vehicle’s seat cushion while the child’s back is against
the seatback, they should use a belt-positioning booster
seat. The child and belt-positioning booster seat are held
in the vehicle by the seat belt.
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to failure of an
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in a
collision. The child could be badly injured or
killed. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
directions exactly when installing an infant or
child restraint.
• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in
the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Do not leave it
loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident, it
could strike the occupants or seatbacks and cause
serious personal injury.
Children Too Large For Booster Seats
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend
over the front of the seat when their back is against the
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 79
seatback, should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this 5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
simple 5-step test to decide whether the child can use the
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the
vehicle’s seat belt alone:
child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the
1. Can the child sit all the way back against the back of child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check belt fit perithe vehicle seat?
odically. A child’s squirming or slouching can move the
belt out of position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the front
or neck, move the child closer to the center of the vehicle.
of the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the
Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt under an arm
way back?
or behind their back.
3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s shoulder
between their neck and arm?
4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching
the child’s thighs and not their stomach?
2
80 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Recommendations For Attaching Child Restraints
Restraint Type
Combined
Weight of the
Child + Child
Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Use any attachment method shown with an “X” Below
LATCH –
Seat Belt Only
LATCH –
Seat Belt + Top
Lower Anchors
Lower Anchors
Tether Anchor
Only
+ Top Tether
Anchor
X
X
X
X
X
X
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 81
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)
Restraint System
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Lower
Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system
has three vehicle anchor points for installing LATCHequipped child seats. There are two lower anchorages
located at the back of the seat cushion where it meets the
seatback and one top tether anchorage located behind the
seating position. These anchorages are used to install
LATCH-equipped child seats without using the vehicle’s
seat belts. Some seating positions may have a top tether
anchorage but no lower anchorages. In these seating
positions, the seat belt must be used with the top tether
anchorage to install the child restraint. Please see the
following table for more information.
2
82 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
LATCH Positions For Installing Child Restraints In
This Vehicle
•
•
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 83
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
LATCH anchorage system to attach the child
restraint?
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat belt
be used together to attach a rear-facing or
forward-facing child restraint?
Can a child seat be installed in the center
position using the inner LATCH lower anchorages?
No
Yes
Use the LATCH anchorage system until the
combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt
and tether anchor instead of the LATCH anchorage system once the combined weight is
more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg).
Use the seat belt and tether anchor to install
a child seat in the center seating position.
You can install child restraints with flexible
lower anchors in the center position. The
inner anchorages are 15.4 inches (392 mm)
apart. Do not install child restraints with
rigid lower anchors in the center position.
2
84 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Can two child restraints be attached using a
common lower LATCH anchorage?
No
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the
back of the front passenger seat?
Yes
Can the head restraints be removed?
No
Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with two
or more child restraints. If the center position does not have dedicated LATCH lower
anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child
seat in the center position next to a child
seat using the LATCH anchorages in an outboard position.
The child seat may touch the back of the
front passenger seat if the child restraint
manufacturer also allows contact. See your
child restraint owner’s manual for more information.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 85
Locating The LATCH Anchorages
The lower anchorages are round bars that are
found at the rear of the seat cushion where it
meets the seatback, below the anchorage symbols on the seatback. They are just visible when
you lean into the rear seat to install the child restraint.
You will easily feel them if you run your finger along gap
between the seatback and seat cushion.
2
Rear Seat LATCH Anchorages
Locating The LATCH Anchorages
In addition, there are tether strap anchorages
behind each rear seating position located in the
panel between the rear seatback and the rear
86 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
window. These tether strap anchorages are under a anchorage. Forward-facing child restraints and some
plastic cover with the tether anchorage symbol on it.
rear-facing infant restraints will also be equipped with a
tether strap. The tether strap will have a hook at the end
to attach to the top tether anchorage and a way to tighten
the strap after it is attached to the anchorage.
Center Seat LATCH
Do not install child restraints with rigid lower attachments in the center seating position. Only install this type
of child restraint in the outboard seating positions. Child
restraints with flexible, webbing mounted lower attachments can be installed in any rear seating position.
WARNING!
Tether Strap Anchorages
LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be
equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each side.
Each will have a hook or connector to attach to the lower
anchorage and a way to tighten the connection to the
Never use the same lower anchorage to attach more
than one child restraint. If you are installing LATCHcompatible child restraints next to each other, you
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 87
WARNING! (Continued)
must use the seat belt for the center position. You can
then use either the LATCH anchors or the vehicle’s
seat belt for installing child seats in the outboard
positions. Please refer to “Installing The LATCHCompatible Child Restraint System” for typical installation instructions.
2. Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and on the
tether strap of the child seat so that you can more
easily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicle
anchorages.
3. Place the child seat between the lower anchorages for
that seating position. For some second row seats, you
may need to recline the seat and / or raise the head
restraint to get a better fit.
Always follow the directions of the child restraint manu4. Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the child
facturer when installing your child restraint. Not all child
restraint to the lower anchorages in the selected seatrestraint systems will be installed as described here.
ing position.
To Install A LATCH-compatible Child Restraint
5. If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect it to the
top tether anchorage. See the section “Installing Child
1. If the selected seating position has a Switchable AutoRestraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for direcmatic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow the seat
tions to attach a tether anchor.
belt, following the instructions below. See the section
“Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat
Belt” to check what type of seat belt each seating
position has.
2
88 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
6. Tighten all of the straps as you push the child restraint
rearward and downward into the seat. Remove slack
in the straps according to the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
7. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seatbelt
When using the LATCH attaching system to install a
child restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not being
used by other occupants or being used to secure child
restraints. An unused belt could injure a child if they play
with it and accidentally lock the seatbelt retractor. Before
installing a child restraint using the LATCH system,
buckle the seat belt behind the child restraint and out of
the child’s reach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with
the child restraint installation, instead of buckling it
behind the child restraint, route the seat belt through the
child restraint belt path and then buckle it. Do not lock
the seatbelt. Remind all children in the vehicle that the
seat belts are not toys and that they should not play with
them.
WARNING!
Improper installation of a child restraint to the
LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of the restraint. The child could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s directions
exactly when installing an infant or child restraint.
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with either a Switchable Automatic Locking
Retractor (ALR) or a cinching latch plate or both. Both
types of seat belts are designed to keep the lap portion of
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 89
the seat belt tight around the child restraint so that it is Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems for Installing Child
not necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can Restraints in this Vehicle
be “switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the
webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing
retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will
make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
into the retractor. For additional information on ALR,
refer to the “Automatic Locking Mode” description under “Occupant Restraints.” The cinching latch plate is
designed to hold the lap portion of the seatbelt tight
when webbing is pulled tight and straight through a
child restraint’s belt path. Please see the table below and
the following sections for more information about both
types of seat belts.
2
90 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
What is the weight limit (child’s weight
+ weight of the child restraint) for using
the Tether Anchor with the seat belt to
attach a forward facing child restraint?
Weight limit of the Child
Restraint
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch
the back of the front passenger seat?
Yes
Can the head restraints be removed?
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to
tighten the seat belt against the belt
path of the child restraint?
No
Yes
Always use the tether anchor when using the seat belt to install a forward
facing child restraint, up to the recommended weight limit of the child restraint.
Contact between the front passenger
seat and the child restraint is allowed,
if the child restraint manufacturer also
allows contact.
In positions with cinching latch plates
(CINCH), the buckle stalk may be
twisted up to 3 full turns. Do not twist
the buckle stalk in a seating position
with an ALR retractor.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 91
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of
the belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing
out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract
Place the child seat in the center of the seating
back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you
position. For some second row seats, you may need to
will hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is
recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a
now in the Automatic Locking mode.
better fit.
6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is
Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor
locked, you should not be able to pull out any webto pass it through the belt path of the child restraint.
bing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the
Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
lap portion around the child restraint while you push
“click.”
the child restraint rearward and downward into the
vehicle seat.
Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight
against the child seat.
Installing A Child Restraint with a Switchable
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
1.
2.
3.
4.
2
92 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the Installing A Child Restraint With A Cinching
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect Latch Plate (CINCH) — If Equipped
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
1. Place the child seat in the center of the seating
strap. Refer to “Lower Anchors and Tethers for Chilposition. For some second row seats, you may need to
dren (LATCH) Restraint System” for directions to
recline the seat and / or raise the head restraint to get
attach a tether anchor.
a better fit.
9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
2. Next, pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
retractor to pass it through the belt path of the child
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
restraint. Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt
in any direction.
path.
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
“click.”
4. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the
lap portion around the child restraint while you push
the child restraint rearward and downward into the
vehicle seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 93
If the buckle or the cinching latch plate is too close to the
belt path opening of the child restraint, you may have
trouble tightening the seat belt. If this happens, disconnect the latch plate from the buckle and twist the short
buckle-end belt up to three full turns to shorten it. Insert
the latch plate into the buckle with the release button
facing out, away from the child restraint. Repeat steps 4
6. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
to 6, above, to complete the installation of the child
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
restraint.
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
If the belt still cannot be tightened after you shorten the
buckle, disconnect the latch plate from the buckle, turn
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
the buckle around one half turn, and insert the latch plate
belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
into the buckle again. If you still cannot make the child
restraint installation tight, try a different seating position.
5. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
strap. Refer to “Installing Child Restraints Using The
Top Tether Anchorage” for directions to attach a tether
anchor.
2
94 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether
Anchorage
2. Rotate or lift the cover to access the anchor directly
behind the seat where you are placing the child
restraint.
1. Look behind the seating position where you 3. Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path
plan to install the child restraint to find the
for the strap between the anchor and the child seat. If
tether anchorage. You may need to move the
your vehicle is equipped with adjustable rear head
seat forward to provide better access to the
restraints, raise the head restraint, and where possible,
tether anchorage. If there is no top tether
route the tether strap under the head restraint and
anchorage for that seating position (see the
between the two posts. If not possible, lower the head
charts above), move the child restraint to
restraint and pass the tether strap around the outboard
another position in the vehicle if one is
side of the head restraint.
available.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 95
5. Remove slack in the tether strap according to the child
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
Transporting Pets
Air Bags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet.
An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly
injured, or injure a passenger during panic braking or in
a collision.
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses
or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS
Tether Strap Mounting
1 — Cover
3 — Attaching Strap
A — Tether Strap Hook
B — Tether Anchor
A long break-in period is not required for the engine and
drivetrain (transmission and axle) in your vehicle.
Drive moderately during the first 300 miles (500 km).
4. Attach the tether strap hook of the child restraint to After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speeds up to 50 or
55 mph (80 or 90 km/h) are desirable.
the top tether anchorage as shown in the diagram.
2
96 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration within the
limits of local traffic laws contributes to a good break-in.
Wide-open throttle acceleration in low gear can be detrimental and should be avoided.
NOTE: A new engine may consume some oil during its
first few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This
should be considered a normal part of the break-in and
not interpreted as an indication of difficulty.
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is a
high-quality energy conserving type lubricant. Oil
changes should be consistent with anticipated climate
conditions under which vehicle operations will occur. For
the recommended viscosity and quality grades, refer to
“Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle”.
SAFETY TIPS
CAUTION!
Never use Non-Detergent Oil or Straight Mineral Oil
in the engine or damage may result.
Transporting Passengers
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
AREA.
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 97
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
follow these safety tips:
• Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in
confined areas any longer than needed to move
your vehicle in or out of the area.
• If you are required to drive with the trunk/liftgate/
rear doors open, make sure that all windows are
closed and the climate control BLOWER switch is
set at high speed. DO NOT use the recirculation
mode.
• If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running, adjust your heating or cooling
controls to force outside air into the vehicle. Set the
blower at high speed.
Exhaust Gas
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon
monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless.
Breathing it can make you unconscious and can
eventually poison you. To avoid breathing (CO),
(Continued)
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
2
98 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust
system, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the
vehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is
damaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken,
damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open
seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes
to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition,
inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The Vehicle
Seat Belts
a collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor,
torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding belt
or retractor condition, replace the belt.
Air Bag Warning Light
The light should come on and remain on for four
to eight seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first turned ON. If the light is not lit
during starting, see your authorized dealer. If the
light stays on, flickers, or comes on while driving, have the
system checked by an authorized dealer.
Defroster
Inspect the belt system periodically, checking for cuts, Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place
frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced the blower control on high speed. You should be able to
immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the system. feel the air directed against the windshield. See your
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a authorized dealer for service if your defroster is inopercollision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after able.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 99
Floor Mat Safety Information
WARNING! (Continued)
Always use floor mats designed to fit the footwell of your
vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal area
unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that they
cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals
or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.
Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of
vehicle control and increase the risk of serious personal injury.
• Always make sure that floor mats are properly
attached to the floor mat fasteners.
• Never place or install floor mats or other floor
coverings in the vehicle that cannot be properly
secured to prevent them from moving and interfering with the pedals or the ability to control the
vehicle.
• Never put floor mats or other floor coverings on top
of already installed floor mats. Additional floor
mats and other coverings will reduce the size of the
pedal area and interfere with the pedals.
• Check mounting of mats on a regular basis. Always
properly reinstall and secure floor mats that have
been removed for cleaning.
(Continued)
(Continued)
WARNING!
2
100 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the
driver footwell while the vehicle is moving. Objects can become trapped under the brake pedal
and accelerator pedal causing a loss of vehicle
control.
• If required, mounting posts must be properly installed, if not equipped from the factory.
Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or
mounting can cause interference with the brake
pedal and accelerator pedal operation causing loss of
control of the vehicle.
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle
lodged in the tread or sidewall. Inspect the tread for cuts
and cracks. Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks and bulges.
Check the wheel nuts for tightness. Check the tires
(including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and
exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn
signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument
panel.
Door Latches
Check for positive closing, latching, and locking.
Fluid Leaks
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel,
engine coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline
Tires
fumes are detected or if fuel, power steering fluid (if
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear equipped), or brake fluid leaks are suspected, the cause
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects should be located and corrected immediately.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 MIRRORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
▫ Phone Call Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Inside Day/Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
▫ Uconnect® Phone Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
▫ Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . .106
▫ Advanced Phone Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . .127
▫ Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
▫ Things You Should Know About Your
Uconnect® Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
▫ Adjusting Side View Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
▫ Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature . . . . . . . . . . .108
▫ Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .108
▫ Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped . . .109
䡵 Uconnect® Phone — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
䡵 VOICE COMMAND — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . .140
▫ Voice Command System Operation . . . . . . . . .140
▫ Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
▫ Voice Training . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
3
102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
䡵 SEATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
䡵 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
▫ Power Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
▫ Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
▫ Heated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
▫ Headlights And Parking Lights . . . . . . . . . . . .163
▫ Manual Front Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . .151
▫ Automatic Headlights — If Equipped . . . . . . .163
▫ Driver Seat Manual Height Adjuster —
If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
▫ Headlights With Wipers (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Reclining Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
▫ Headlight Time Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Lumbar Support — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .153
▫ Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
▫ Fold-Flat Passenger Seatback . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
▫ Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
▫ Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
▫ High/Low Beam Switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
▫ Folding Rear Seat Center Armrest . . . . . . . . .160
▫ Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
䡵 TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD . . . . . . . . .160
▫ Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103
▫ Daytime Running Lights (DRL) —
If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
▫ Instrument Panel Dimmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
▫ Map/Reading/Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . .168
▫ Battery Saver Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
䡵 WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . .169
▫ Intermittent Wiper System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
▫ Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
▫ Mist Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ Headlights With Wipers Feature (Available With
Automatic Headlights Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
䡵 TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN . . .173
䡵 ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
▫ To Set A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
▫ To Deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
▫ To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
▫ To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
䡵 GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED. . . .177
▫ Before You Begin Programming HomeLink® . .179
▫ Programming A Rolling Code . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
▫ Programming A Non-Rolling Code . . . . . . . . .182
▫ Canadian/Gate Operator Programming . . . . . .183
▫ Using HomeLink®. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
▫ Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
3
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Troubleshooting Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185 䡵 ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS . . . . . . . . . . .189
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186 䡵 CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .186
䡵 CUPHOLDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Opening Sunroof — Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
▫ Front Seat Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode . . . . . . . . .187
▫ Rear Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Closing Sunroof — Express. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
䡵 STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . .188
▫ Glovebox Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . .
▫ Pinch Protect Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
䡵 CONSOLE FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Venting Sunroof — Express . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
▫ Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Sunshade Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
䡵 CARGO AREA FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
▫ Ski Pass-Through. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
䡵 REAR WINDOW FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Ignition Off Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
▫ Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. .193
. .193
. .193
. .193
. .195
. .195
. .195
. .195
. .197
. .199
. .199
. .199
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105
MIRRORS
Inside Day/Night Mirror
A two-point pivot system allows for horizontal and
vertical mirror adjustment. Adjust the mirror to center on
the view through the rear window.
3
Headlight glare can be reduced by moving the small
control under the mirror to the night position (toward the
rear of the vehicle). The mirror should be adjusted while
set in the day position (toward the windshield).
Adjusting Rearview Mirror
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare
from vehicles behind you. You can turn the feature on or
off by pressing the button at the base of the mirror. A light
to the left of the button will illuminate to indicate when
the dimming feature is activated. The sensor to the right
of the button does not illuminate.
NOTE: This feature is disabled when the vehicle is
moving in reverse.
Automatic Dimming Mirror
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning, never
spray any cleaning solution directly onto the mirror.
Apply the solution onto a clean cloth and wipe the
mirror clean.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107
Power Mirrors
The power mirror control is located on the driver’s door
trim panel.
3
Mirror Directions
Power Mirror Control
To adjust a mirror, turn the control wand toward the left
or right mirror positions indicated. Tilt the control wand
in the direction you want the mirror to move.
When you are finished adjusting the mirror, turn the
control to the center position to prevent accidentally
moving a mirror.
108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Adjusting Side View Mirrors
WARNING! (Continued)
Outside Mirror — Driver Side
Adjust the outside mirror to center on the adjacent lane of
traffic, with a slight overlap of the view obtained on the
inside mirror.
Outside Mirror — Passenger Side
collide with another vehicle or other object. Use your
inside mirror when judging the size or distance of a
vehicle seen in the passenger side convex mirror.
Some vehicles will not have a convex passenger side
mirror.
Adjust the convex outside mirror so you can just see the Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature
side of your vehicle in the part of the mirror closest to the All exterior mirrors are hinged and may be moved either
vehicle.
forward or rearward to resist damage. The hinges have
three detent positions: full forward, full rearward and
WARNING!
normal.
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away
than they really are. Relying too much on your
passenger side convex mirror could cause you to
(Continued)
Heated Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice. This
feature can be activated whenever you turn on the
rear window defroster (if equipped). Some vehicles may
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109
not be equipped with rear window defroster, in this case
the heated mirrors will still function as intended. Refer to
“Rear Window Features” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle” for further information.
Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped
3
An illuminated vanity mirror is on each sun visor. To use
the mirror, lower the sun visor and rotate the mirror
cover upward. The lights will turn on automatically.
Closing the mirror cover turns off the lights.
Illuminated Vanity Mirror
Uconnect® Phone — IF EQUIPPED
Uconnect® Phone is a voice-activated, hands-free, invehicle communications system. Uconnect® Phone allows
you to dial a phone number with your mobile phone using
simple voice commands (e.g., “Call” ѧ “Mike” ѧ “Work” or
“Dial” ѧ “248-555-1212”). Your mobile phone’s audio is
110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
transmitted through your vehicle’s audio system; the sys- The Uconnect® Phone is driven through your
tem will automatically mute your radio when using the Bluetooth® “Hands-Free Profile” mobile phone.
Uconnect® Phone.
Uconnect® features Bluetooth® technology - the global
NOTE: The Uconnect® Phone requires a mobile phone standard that enables different electronic devices to conequipped with the Bluetooth® “Hands-Free Profile”, nect to each other without wires or a docking station, so
Version 0.96 or higher. See the Uconnect® website for Uconnect® Phone works no matter where you stow your
mobile phone (be it your purse, pocket, or briefcase), as
supported phones.
long as your phone is turned on and has been paired to
For Uconnect® customer support:
the vehicle’s Uconnect® Phone. The Uconnect® Phone
• U.S. residents - visit www.UconnectPhone.com or call allows up to seven mobile phones to be linked to the
system. Only one linked (or paired) mobile phone can be
1–877–855–8400.
used with the system at a time. The system is available in
• Canadian Residents - visit www.UconnectPhone.com English, Spanish, or French languages.
or call, 1-800-465–2001 (English) or 1-800-387-9983
(French).
WARNING!
Uconnect® Phone allows you to transfer calls between
the system and your mobile phone as you enter or exit
your vehicle and enables you to mute the system’s
microphone for private conversation.
Any voice commanded system should be used only
in safe driving conditions following all applicable
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111
WARNING! (Continued)
laws, including laws regarding phone use. Your attention should be focused on safely operating the
vehicle. Failure to do so may result in a collision
causing serious injury or death.
Voice Command Button
Actual button location may vary with the radio. The individual buttons are described in the
“Operation” section.
The Uconnect® Phone can be used with any Hands-Free
Profile certified Bluetooth® mobile phone. See the
Uconnect® Phone Button
Uconnect® website for supported phones. Refer to your
The radio or steering wheel controls (if mobile service provider or the phone manufacturer for
equipped) will contain the two control buttons details.
button and Voice Com(Uconnect® Phone
The Uconnect® Phone is fully integrated with the vehibutton) that will enable you to
mand
cle’s audio system. The volume of the Uconnect® Phone
access the system. When you press the button you will
can be adjusted either from the radio volume control
hear the word Uconnect® followed by a BEEP. The beep
knob or from the steering wheel radio control (right
is your signal to give a command.
switch), if so equipped.
The radio display will be used for visual prompts from
the Uconnect® Phone such as “CELL” or caller ID on
certain radios.
3
112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Operation
Voice commands can be used to operate the Uconnect®
Phone and to navigate through the Uconnect® Phone
menu structure. Voice commands are required after most
Uconnect® Phone prompts. You will be prompted for a
specific command and then guided through the available
options.
part of the command when you are asked for it. For
example, you can use the compound form voice command “Phonebook New Entry,” or you can break the
compound form command into two voice commands:
“Phonebook” and “New Entry.” Please remember, the
Uconnect® Phone works best when you talk in a
normal conversational tone, as if speaking to someone
sitting a few feet/meters away from you.
• Prior to giving a voice command, one must wait for the
Voice Command Tree
beep, which follows the “Ready” prompt or another
Refer to “Voice Tree” in this section.
prompt.
• For certain operations, compound commands can be
used. For example, instead of saying “Setup” and then
“Pair a Device”, the following compound command
can be said: “Pair a Bluetooth® Device.”
Help Command
If you need assistance at any prompt, or if you want to
know your options at any prompt, say “Help” following
the beep. The Uconnect® Phone will play some of the
• For each feature explanation in this section, only the options at any prompt if you ask for help.
compound form of the voice command is given. You
can also break the commands into parts and say each
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113
To activate the Uconnect® Phone, simply press the The following are general phone to Uconnect® Phone
button and follow the audible prompts for directions. pairing instructions:
Uconnect® Phone sessions begin with a press of the
• Press the
button to begin.
button on the radio control head.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
Cancel Command
“Device Pairing.”
At any prompt, after the beep, you can say “Cancel” and
you will be returned to the main menu. However, in a • When prompted, after the beep, say “Pair a Device”
and follow the audible prompts.
few instances the system will take you back to the
previous menu.
• You will be asked to say a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN), which you will later need to
Pair (Link) Uconnect® Phone To A Mobile Phone
enter into your mobile phone. You can enter any
To begin using your Uconnect® Phone, you must pair
four-digit PIN. You will not need to remember this PIN
your compatible Bluetooth® enabled mobile phone.
after the initial pairing process.
To complete the pairing process, you will need to refer- • For identification purposes, you will be prompted to
ence your mobile phone Owner’s Manual. The
give the Uconnect® Phone a name for your mobile
Uconnect® website may also provide detailed instrucphone. Each mobile phone that is paired should be
tions for pairing.
given a unique phone name.
3
114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• You will then be asked to give your mobile phone a
priority level between one and seven, with one being
the highest priority. You can pair up to seven mobile
phones to your Uconnect® Phone. However, at any
given time, only one mobile phone can be in use,
connected to your Uconnect® System. The priority
allows the Uconnect® Phone to know which mobile
phone to use if multiple mobile phones are in the
vehicle at the same time. For example, if priority three
and priority five phones are present in the vehicle, the
Uconnect® Phone will use the priority three mobile
phone when you make a call. You can select to use a
lower priority mobile phone at any time (refer to
“Advanced Phone Connectivity” in this section).
Dial By Saying A Number
• The system will prompt you to say the number you
want to call.
• For example, you can say “151-1234 -5555.”
• The Uconnect® Phone will confirm the phone number
and then dial. The number will appear in the display
of certain radios.
Call By Saying A Name
• Press the
button to begin.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Call.”
• The system will prompt you to say the name of the
person you want to call.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
the name of the person you want to call. For example,
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
you can say “John Doe,” where John Doe is a previ“Dial.”
ously stored name entry in the Uconnect® phonebook
• Press the
button to begin.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115
or downloaded phonebook. To learn how to store a • Automatic download and update, if supported, begins
as soon as the Bluetooth® wireless phone connection is
name in the phonebook, refer to “Add Names to Your
made to the Uconnect® Phone, for example, after you
Uconnect® Phonebook.”
start the vehicle.
• The Uconnect® system will confirm the name and then
dial the corresponding phone number, which may • A maximum of 1000 entries per phone will be downloaded and updated every time a phone is connected
appear in the display of certain radios.
to the Uconnect® Phone.
Phonebook Download – Automatic Phonebook
• Depending on the maximum number of entries downTransfer From Mobile Phone
loaded, there may be a short delay before the latest
If equipped and specifically supported by your phone,
downloaded names can be used. Until then, if availUconnect® Phone automatically downloads names (text
able, the previously downloaded phonebook is availnames) and number entries from your mobile phone’s
able for use.
phonebook. Specific Bluetooth® Phones with Phone
Book Access Profile may support this feature. See • Only the phonebook of the currently connected mobile
Uconnect® website for supported phones.
phone is accessible.
• To call a name from the Uconnect® Phonebook or • Either the mobile phone’s phonebook or the mobile
downloaded Phonebook, follow the procedure in “Call
phone’s SIM card phonebook is downloaded.
by Saying a Name” section.
3
116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• This downloaded phonebook cannot be edited or • When prompted, enter the number designation (e.g.,
“Home”, “Work”, “Mobile”, or “Other”). This will
deleted on the Uconnect® Phone. These can only be
allow you to store multiple numbers for each phoneedited on the mobile phone. The changes are transbook entry, if desired.
ferred and updated to Uconnect® Phone on the next
phone connection.
• When prompted, recite the phone number for the
phonebook entry that you are adding.
Add Names To Your Uconnect® Phonebook
NOTE: Adding names to the Uconnect® Phonebook is After you are finished adding an entry into the phonebook, you will be given the opportunity to add more
recommended when the vehicle is not in motion.
phone numbers to the current entry or to return to the
button to begin.
• Press the
main menu.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say The Uconnect® Phone will allow you to enter up to 32
“Phonebook New Entry.”
names in the phonebook with each name having up to
• When prompted, say the name of the new entry. Use of four associated phone numbers and designations. Each
long names helps the Voice Command and it is recom- language has a separate 32-name phonebook accessible
mended. For example, say “Robert Smith” or “Robert” only in that language. In addition, if equipped and
supported by your phone, Uconnect® Phone automatiinstead of “Bob.”
cally downloads your mobile phone’s phonebook.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117
After you are finished editing an entry in the phonebook,
you will be given the opportunity to edit another entry in
NOTE: Editing phonebook entries is recommended
the phonebook, call the number you just edited, or return
when the vehicle is not in motion. Automatic downto the main menu.
loaded phonebook entries cannot be deleted or edited.
“Phonebook Edit” can be used to add another phone
button to begin.
• Press the
number to a name entry that already exists in the
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say phonebook. For example, the entry John Doe may have a
“Phonebook Edit.”
mobile and a home number, but you can add “John
Doe’s” work number later using the “Phonebook Edit”
• You will then be asked for the name of the phonebook
feature.
entry that you wish to edit.
Delete Uconnect® Phonebook Entry
• Next, choose the number designation (home, work,
NOTE: Editing phonebook entries is recommended
mobile, or other) that you wish to edit.
when the vehicle is not in motion.
• When prompted, recite the new phone number for the
button to begin.
• Press the
phonebook entry that you are editing.
Edit Uconnect® Phonebook Entries
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Phonebook Delete.”
3
118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• After you enter the Phonebook Delete menu, you will
then be asked for the name of the entry that you wish
to delete. You can either say the name of a phonebook
entry that you wish to delete or you can say “List
Names” to hear a list of the entries in the phonebook
from which you choose. To select one of the entries
button while the
from the list, press the
Uconnect® Phone is playing the desired entry and say
“Delete.”
Delete/Erase “All” Uconnect® Phonebook Entries
• Press the
button to begin.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Phonebook Erase All.”
• The Uconnect® Phone will ask you to verify that you
wish to delete all the entries from the phonebook.
• After confirmation, the phonebook entries will be
deleted.
• After you enter the name, the Uconnect® Phone will
ask you which designation you wish to delete: home, • Note that only the phonebook in the current language
work, mobile, other, or all. Say the designation you
is deleted.
wish to delete.
• Automatic downloaded phonebook entries cannot be
• Note that only the phonebook entry in the current
deleted or edited.
language is deleted.
List All Names In The Uconnect® Phonebook
• Automatic downloaded phonebook entries cannot be
• Press the
button to begin.
deleted or edited.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say mobile service plan. For example, if your mobile service
plan provides three-way calling, this feature can be
“Phonebook List Names.”
accessed through the Uconnect® Phone. Check with your
• The Uconnect® Phone will play the names of all the
mobile service provider for the features that you have.
phonebook entries, including the downloaded phoneAnswer Or Reject An Incoming Call — No Call
book entries, if available.
Currently In Progress
but• To call one of the names in the list, press the
ton during the playing of the desired name, and say When you receive a call on your mobile phone, the
Uconnect® Phone will interrupt the vehicle audio sys“Call.”
tem, if on, and will ask if you would like to answer the
NOTE: The user can also exercise “Edit” or “Delete”
button to accept the call. To reject the
call. Press the
operations at this point.
button until you hear a single
call, press and hold the
• The Uconnect® Phone will then prompt you as to the beep, indicating that the incoming call was rejected.
number designation you wish to call.
Answer Or Reject An Incoming Call — Call
• The selected number will be dialed.
Currently In Progress
If a call is currently in progress and you have another
incoming call, you will hear the same network tones for
The following features can be accessed through the
call waiting that you normally hear when using your
Uconnect® Phone if the feature(s) are available on your
Phone Call Features
3
120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
button to place the current Place/Retrieve A Call From Hold
mobile phone. Press the
call on hold and answer the incoming call.
To put a call on hold, press the
button until you hear
NOTE: The Uconnect® Phone compatible phones in the a single beep. This indicates that the call is on hold. To
butmarket today do not support rejecting an incoming call bring the call back from hold, press and hold the
when another call is in progress. Therefore, the user can ton until you hear a single beep.
only answer an incoming call or ignore it.
Toggling Between Calls
Making A Second Call While Current Call Is In
Progress
If two calls are in progress (one active and one on hold),
press the
button until you hear a single beep, indicatTo make a second call while you are currently on a call, ing that the active and hold status of the two calls have
press the
button and say “Dial” or “Call” followed switched. Only one call can be placed on hold at a time.
by the phone number or phonebook entry you wish to Conference Call
call. The first call will be on hold while the second call is
in progress. To go back to the first call, refer to “Toggling When two calls are in progress (one active and one on
button until you hear a
Between Calls” in this section. To combine two calls, refer hold), press and hold the
double beep indicating that the two calls have been
to “Conference Call” in this section.
joined into one conference call.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121
Three-Way Calling
Redial
To initiate three-way calling, press the
button while • Press the
button to begin.
a call is in progress, and make a second phone call, as
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
described under “Making a Second Call While Current
“Redial.”
Call is in Progress.” After the second call has established,
button until you hear a double • The Uconnect® Phone will call the last number that
press and hold the
beep, indicating that the two calls have been joined into
was dialed from your mobile phone.
one conference call.
NOTE: This may not be the last number dialed from the
Call Termination
Uconnect® Phone.
To end a call in progress, momentarily press the
button. Only the active call(s) will be terminated and if there
is a call on hold, it will become the new active call. If the
active call is terminated by the phone far end, a call on
hold may not become active automatically. This is cell
phone-dependent. To bring the call back from hold, press
button until you hear a single beep.
and hold the
Call Continuation
Call continuation is the progression of a phone call on the
Uconnect® Phone after the vehicle ignition has been
switched to OFF. Call continuation functionality available on the vehicle can be any one of three types:
• After the ignition is switched to OFF, a call can
continue on the Uconnect® Phone either until the call
3
122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
ends, or until the vehicle battery condition dictates • After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
the name of the language you wish to switch to
cessation of the call on the Uconnect® Phone and
English, Espanol, or Francais.
transfer of the call to the mobile phone.
• After the ignition is cycled to OFF, a call can continue • Continue to follow the system prompts to complete the
language selection.
on the Uconnect® Phone for a certain duration, after
which the call is automatically transferred from the
After selecting one of the languages, all prompts and
Uconnect® Phone to the mobile phone.
voice commands will be in that language.
• An active call is automatically transferred to the moNOTE: After every Uconnect® Phone language change
bile phone after the ignition is cycled to OFF.
operation, only the language-specific 32-name phonebook is usable. The paired phone name is not languageUconnect® Phone Features
specific and is usable across all languages.
Language Selection
Emergency Assistance
To change the language that the Uconnect® Phone is
If you are in an emergency and the mobile phone is
using:
reachable:
button to begin.
• Press the
• Pick up the phone and manually dial the emergency
number for your area.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123
If the phone is not reachable and the Uconnect® Phone is • If supported, this number may be programmable on
some systems. To do this, press the
button and say
operational, you may reach the emergency number as
“Setup,” followed by “Emergency.”
follows:
• The Uconnect® Phone does slightly lower your
chances of successfully making a phone call as to that
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
for the mobile phone directly.
“Emergency” and the Uconnect® Phone will instruct
the paired mobile phone to call the emergency number.
WARNING!
This feature is supported in the U.S., Canada, and
Mexico.
To use you Uconnect® Phone System in an emergency, your mobile phone must be:
NOTE:
• turned on,
• The emergency number dialed is based on the country • paired to the Uconnect® System,
where the vehicle is purchased (911 for the U.S. and • and have network coverage.
Canada and 060 for Mexico). The number dialed may
not be applicable with the available mobile service and Roadside Assistance / Towing Assistance
area.
If you need roadside assistance:
• Press the
button to begin.
• Press the
button to begin.
3
124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say Working With Automated Systems
“Towing Assistance.”
This method is used in instances where one generally has
NOTE: You should program the desired Towing Assis- to press numbers on the mobile phone keypad while
tance phone number using the Voice Command system. navigating through an automated telephone system.
To do this, press the button and say “Setup,” followed by You can use your Uconnect® Phone to access a voice mail
“Towing Assistance.” When prompted say 1-800-528- system or an automated service, such as a paging service
2069 for the U.S., say 1-800-363-4869 for Canada, say or automated customer service line. Some services re55-14- 3454 for Mexico City and 1-800-712-3040 for out- quire immediate response selection. In some instances,
side Mexico City in Mexico.
that may be too quick for use of the Uconnect® Phone.
Paging
When calling a number with your Uconnect® Phone that
normally requires you to enter in a touch-tone sequence on
your mobile phone keypad, you can press the
button
and say the sequence you wish to enter, followed by the
word “Send.” For example, if required to enter your PIN
followed with a pound, (3 7 4 6 #), you can press the
Voice Mail Calling
button and say, “3 7 4 6 # Send.” Saying a number,
To learn how to access your voice mail, refer to “Working or sequence of numbers, followed by “Send,” is also to be
with Automated Systems.”
To learn how to page, refer to “Working with Automated
Systems.” Paging works properly except for pagers of
certain companies, which time out a little too soon to
work properly with the Uconnect® Phone.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125
used for navigating through an automated customer • Some paging and voice mail systems have system time
service center menu structure, and to leave a number on
out settings that are too short and may not allow the
a pager.
use of this feature.
You can also send stored Uconnect® phonebook entries
as tones for fast and easy access to voice mail and pager
entries. To use this feature, dial the number you wish to
call and then press the
button and say, “Send.” The
system will prompt you to enter the name or number and
say the name of the phonebook entry you wish to send.
The Uconnect® Phone will then send the corresponding
phone number associated with the phonebook entry, as
tones over the phone.
NOTE:
Barge In — Overriding Prompts
The “Voice Command” button can be used when you
wish to skip part of a prompt and issue your voice
command immediately. For example, if a prompt is
asking “Would you like to pair a phone, clear a...,” you
button and say, “Pair a Phone” to
could press the
select that option without having to listen to the rest of
the voice prompt.
Turning Confirmation Prompts ON/OFF
Turning confirmation prompts off will stop the system
• You may not hear all of the tones due to mobile phone
from confirming your choices (e.g., the Uconnect® Phone
network configurations. This is normal.
will not repeat a phone number before you dial it).
• Press the
button to begin.
3
126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say dialing a number with your paired Bluetooth® mobile
phone, the audio will be played through your vehicle’s
one of the following:
audio system. The Uconnect® Phone will work the same
– “Setup Confirmation Prompts On”
as if you dial the number using Voice Command.
– “Setup Confirmation Prompts Off”
NOTE: Certain brands of mobile phones do not send the
Phone And Network Status Indicators
dial ring to the Uconnect® Phone to play it on the vehicle
If available on the radio and/or on a premium display audio system, so you will not hear it. Under this situasuch as the instrument panel cluster, and supported by tion, after successfully dialing a number the user may feel
your mobile phone, the Uconnect® Phone will provide that the call did not go through even though the call is in
notification to inform you of your phone and network progress. Once your call is answered, you will hear the
status when you are attempting to make a phone call audio.
using Uconnect® Phone. The status is given for network Mute/Un-Mute (Mute ON/OFF)
signal strength, phone battery strength, etc.
When you mute the Uconnect® Phone, you will still be
Dialing Using The Mobile Phone Keypad
able to hear the conversation coming from the other
You can dial a phone number with your mobile phone party, but the other party will not be able to hear you. In
keypad and still use the Uconnect® Phone (while dialing order to mute the Uconnect® Phone:
via the mobile phone keypad, the user must exercise • Press the
button.
caution and take precautionary safety measures). By
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127
• Following the beep, say “Mute.”
In order to un-mute the Uconnect® Phone:
• Press the
button.
• Following the beep, say “Mute off.”
Connect Or Disconnect Link Between The
Uconnect® Phone And Mobile Phone
Your mobile phone can be paired with many different
electronic devices, but can only be actively “connected”
with one electronic device at a time.
If you would like to connect or disconnect the Bluetooth®
connection between your mobile phone and the
Transfer Call To And From Mobile Phone
Uconnect® Phone System, follow the instructions deThe Uconnect® Phone allows ongoing calls to be trans- scribed in your mobile phone User’s Manual.
ferred from your mobile phone to the Uconnect® Phone
List Paired Mobile Phone Names
without terminating the call. To transfer an ongoing call
button to begin.
from your Uconnect® Phone paired mobile phone to the • Press the
button
Uconnect® Phone or vice versa, press the
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
and say “Transfer Call.”
“Setup Phone Pairing.”
Advanced Phone Connectivity
• When prompted, say “List Phones.”
• The Uconnect® Phone will play the phone names of all
paired mobile phones in order from the highest to the
3
128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
lowest priority. To “Select” or “Delete” a paired phone • The selected phone will be used for the next phone
call. If the selected phone is not available, the
button and say “Sebeing announced, press the
Uconnect® Phone will return to using the highest
lect” or “Delete.” Also, see the next two sections for an
priority phone present in or near (approximately
alternate way to “Select” or “Delete” a paired phone.
within 30 ft. (9 m)) the vehicle.
Select Another Mobile Phone
This feature allows you to select and start using another Delete Uconnect® Phone Paired Mobile Phones
phone paired with the Uconnect® Phone.
• Press the
• Press the
button to begin.
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Setup Phone Pairing.”
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Setup Select Phone” and follow the prompts.
• At the next prompt, say “Delete” and follow the
prompts.
button at any time while the
• You can also press the
list is being played, and then choose the phone that • You can also press the
button at any time while the
you wish to select.
list is being played, and then choose the phone you
wish to delete.
button to begin.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129
Things You Should Know About Your Uconnect®
Phone
Uconnect® Phone Tutorial
• Press the
button and say the “Voice Training,”
“System Training,” or “Start Voice Training” command.
You can either press the Uconnect® Phone button to
To hear a brief tutorial of the system features, press the
restore the factory setting or repeat the words and
button and say “Uconnect® Tutorial.”
phrases when prompted by the Uconnect® Phone. For
best results, the Voice Training session should be comVoice Training
pleted when the vehicle is parked with the engine
For users experiencing difficulty with the system recognizing their voice commands or numbers, the Uconnect® running, all windows closed, and the blower fan
Phone Voice Training feature may be used. To enter this switched off.
training mode, follow one of the two following procedures: This procedure may be repeated with a new user. The
From outside the Uconnect® Phone mode (e.g., from system will adapt to the last trained voice only.
radio mode):
• Press and hold the
the session begins, or,
Reset
button for five seconds until • Press the
button.
• After the “Ready” prompt, and the following beep, say
“Setup,” then “Reset.”
3
130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
This will delete all phone pairing, phone book entries,
and other settings in all language modes. The System will
prompt you before resetting to factory settings.
Voice Command
• low road noise,
• smooth road surface,
• fully closed windows,
• dry weather condition.
• For best performance, adjust the rearview mirror to • Even though the system is designed for users speaking
provide at least ½ in (1 cm) gap between the overhead
in North American English, French, and Spanish acconsole (if equipped) and the mirror.
cents, the system may not always work for some.
• Always wait for the beep before speaking.
• When navigating through an automated system such
as voice mail, or when sending a page, at the end of
• Speak normally without pausing, just as you would
speaking the digit string, make sure to say “Send.”
speak to a person sitting a few feet/meters away from
you.
• Storing names in the phonebook when the vehicle is
not in motion is recommended.
• Make sure that no one other than you is speaking
during a Voice Command period.
• It is not recommended to store similar sounding names
in the Uconnect® Phonebook.
• Performance is maximized under:
• low-to-medium blower setting,
• low-to-medium vehicle speed,
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131
• Phonebook (Downloaded and Uconnect® Phone Local)
name recognition rate is optimized when the entries are
not similar.
• Numbers must be spoken in single digits. “800” must
be spoken “eight-zero-zero” not “eight hundred.”
• smooth road surface,
• fully closed windows,
• dry weather conditions, and
• operation from the driver’s seat.
• Performance, such as audio clarity, echo, and loudness
to a large degree rely on the phone and network, and
not the Uconnect® Phone.
• Even though international dialing for most number
combinations is supported, some shortcut dialing • Echo at the phone far end can sometimes be reduced
number combinations may not be supported.
by lowering the in-vehicle audio volume.
• You can say “O” (letter “O”) for “0” (zero).
• In a convertible vehicle, system performance may be • In a convertible vehicle, system performance may be
compromised with the convertible top down.
compromised with the convertible top down.
Far End Audio Performance
Recent Calls
• Audio quality is maximized under:
• low-to-medium blower setting,
• low-to-medium vehicle speed,
• low road noise,
If your phone supports “Automatic Phonebook Download,” Uconnect® Phone can list your Outgoing, Incoming and Missed Calls.
3
132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Voice Text Reply
Send Messages:
Uconnect® Phone can read or send new messages on You can send messages using Uconnect® Phone. To send
your phone.
a new message:
Read Messages:
• Press the
button.
If you receive a new text message while your phone is • After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
connected to Uconnect® Phone, an announcement will
“SMS Send” or “Send Message.”
be made to notify you that you have a new text message.
• You can either say the message you wish to send or say
If you wish to hear the new message:
“List Messages.” There are 20 preset messages.
button.
• Press the
button while the
To send a message, press the
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say system is listing the message and say “Send.”
“SMS Read” or “Read Messages.”
Uconnect® Phone will prompt you to say the name or
• Uconnect® Phone will play the new text message for number of the person you wish to send the message to.
you.
List of Preset Messages:
After reading a message, you can “Reply” or “Forward”
1. Yes
the message using Uconnect® Phone.
2. No
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133
3. Where are you?
16. Can this wait?
4. I need more direction.
17. Bye for now
5. L O L
18. When can we meet?
6. Why
19. Send number to call
7. I love you
20. Start without me
8. Call me
Turn Voice Text Reply Incoming Announcement ON/
OFF
9. Call me later
11. See You in 15 minutes
Turning the Voice Text Reply Incoming Announcement
OFF will stop the system from announcing the new
incoming messages.
12. I am on my way
• Press the
13. I’ll be late
• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say
“Setup, Incoming Message Announcement”, you will
then be given a choice to change it.
10. Thanks
14. Are you there yet?
15. Where are we meeting?
button.
3
134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Bluetooth® Communication Link
Power-Up
Mobile phones have been found to lose connection to the
Uconnect® Phone. When this happens, the connection
can generally be reestablished by switching the phone
off/on. Your mobile phone is recommended to remain in
Bluetooth® ON mode.
After switching the ignition key from OFF to either the
ON or ACC position, or after a language change, you
must wait at least fifteen seconds prior to using the
system.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135
3
136 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 137
3
138 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
zero
one
two
three
four
five
six
seven
eight
nine
star (*)
plus (+)
pound (#)
add location
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
all
call
cancel
confirmation prompts
continue
delete
dial
download
edit
emergency
English
erase all
Espanol
Francais
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 139
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
help
home
language
list names
list phones
mobile
mute
mute off
new entry
no
other
pair a phone
phone pairing
pairing
phonebook
phone book
Voice Commands
Primary
Alternate (s)
previous
record again
redial
return to main menu
return or main menu
select phone
select
send
set up
phone settings or phone
set up
towing assistance
transfer call
Uconnect® Tutorial
voice training
work
yes
3
140 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
General Information
VOICE COMMAND — IF EQUIPPED
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and Voice Command System Operation
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
The Uconnect® Voice Command system allows
you to control your AM, FM radio, disk player,
• Changes or modifications not expressly approved by
USB mass storage class device, iPod® family of
the party responsible for compliance could void the
devices, Bluetooth Streaming Audio Device,
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
satellite radio, disc player, and a memo recorder.
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
NOTE: Take care to speak into the Voice Interface System
• This device must accept any interference received,
as calmly and normally as possible. The ability of the
including interference that may cause undesired opVoice Interface System to recognize user voice commands
eration.
may be negatively affected by rapid speaking or a raised
voice level.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 141
WARNING!
Any voice commanded system should be used only
in safe driving conditions following all applicable
laws. Your attention should be focused on safely
operating the vehicle. Failure to do so may result in a
collision causing serious injury or death.
Pressing the Voice Command
button while the
system is speaking is known as “barging in.” The system
will be interrupted, and after the beep, you can add or
change commands. This will become helpful once you
start to learn the options.
NOTE: At any time, you can say the words “Cancel,”
“Help” or “Main Menu.”
button, you These commands are universal and can be used from any
When you press the Voice Command
will hear a beep. The beep is your signal to give a menu. All other commands can be used depending upon
command.
the active application.
NOTE: If you do not say a command within a few When using this system, you should speak clearly and at
seconds, the system will present you with a list of a normal speaking volume.
options.
The system will best recognize your speech if the winIf you ever wish to interrupt the system while it lists dows are closed, and the heater/air conditioning fan is
button, listen for set to low.
options, press the Voice Command
the beep, and say your command.
3
142 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
At any point, if the system does not recognize one of your 3. Use the ON/OFF VOLUME rotary knob to adjust the
volume to a comfortable level while the Voice Comcommands, you will be prompted to repeat it.
mand system is speaking. Please note the volume
To hear the first available Menu, press the Voice Comsetting for Voice Command is different than the audio
button and say “Help” or “Main Menu.”
mand
system.
Commands
Main Menu
The Voice Command system understands two types of
commands. Universal commands are available at all Start a dialogue by pressing the Voice Command
button. You may say “Main Menu” to switch to the
times. Local commands are available if the supported
main menu.
radio mode is active.
In this mode, you can say the following commands:
Changing the Volume
1. Start a dialogue by pressing the Voice Command • “Radio AM” (to switch to the radio AM mode)
button.
• “Radio FM” (to switch to radio FM mode)
2. Say a command (e.g., “Help”).
• “Sat” (to switch to Satellite radio mode)
• “Disc” (to switch to the disc mode)
• “USB” (to switch to USB mode)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 143
• “Bluetooth Streaming” (to switch to Bluetooth® Radio FM
Streaming mode)
To switch to the FM band, say “FM” or “Radio FM.” In
this mode, you may say the following commands:
• “Memo” (to switch to the memo recorder)
• “System Setup” (to switch to system setup)
• “Frequency #” (to change the frequency)
Radio AM
• “Next Station” (to select the next station)
To switch to the AM band, say “AM” or “Radio AM.” In • “Previous Station” (to select the previous station)
this mode, you may say the following commands:
• “Menu Radio” (to switch to the radio menu)
• “Frequency #” (to change the frequency)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
• “Next Station” (to select the next station)
Satellite Radio
• “Previous Station” (to select the previous station)
To switch to satellite radio mode, say “Sat” or “Satellite
• “Radio Menu” (to switch to the radio menu)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
Radio.” In this mode, you may say the following commands:
• “Channel Number” (to change the channel by its
spoken number)
3
144 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• “Next Channel” (to select the next channel)
USB Mode
• “Previous Channel” (to select the previous channel)
To switch to USB mode, say “USB.” In this mode, you
may say the following commands:
• “List Channel” (to hear a list of available channels)
• “Select Name” (to say the name of a channel)
• “Menu Radio” (to switch to the radio menu)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
• “Next Track” (to play the next track)
• “Previous Track” (to play the previous track)
• “Play” (to play a Artist Name, Playlist Name, Album
Name, Track Name, etc.)
Disc Mode
Bluetooth® Streaming (BT) Mode
To switch to the disc mode, say “Disc.” In this mode, you To switch to Bluetooth® Streaming (BT) mode, say
may say the following commands:
“Bluetooth Streaming.” In this mode, you may say the
following commands:
• “Track” (#) (to change the track)
• “Next Track” (to play the next track)
• “Next Track” (to play the next track)
• “Previous Track” (to play the previous track)
• “Previous Track” (to play the previous track)
• “Main Menu” (to switch to the main menu)
• “List” (to list an Artist, Playlist, Album, Track, etc.)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 145
Memo Mode
– “Delete” (to delete a memo)
To switch to the voice recorder mode, say “Memo.” In • “Delete All” (to delete all memos)
this mode, you may say the following commands:
Setup
• “New Memo” (to record a new memo) — During the
To switch to system setup, you may say one of the
recording, you may press the Voice Command
following:
button to stop recording. You proceed by saying
• “Change to setup”
one of the following commands:
– “Save” (to save the memo)
– “Continue” (to continue recording)
– “Delete” (to delete the recording)
• “Play Memos” (to play previously recorded memos) —
During the playback you may press the Voice Combutton to stop playing memos. You promand
ceed by saying one of the following commands:
– “Repeat” (to repeat a memo)
– “Next” (to play the next memo)
– “Previous” (to play the previous memo)
• “Switch to system setup”
• “Main menu setup” or
• “Switch to setup”
In this mode, you may say the following commands:
• “Language English”
• “Language French”
• “Language Spanish”
• “Tutorial”
3
146 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• “Voice Training”
2. Repeat the words and phrases when prompted by
Uconnect® Voice. For best results, the “Voice Training”
NOTE: Keep in mind that you have to press the Voice
session should be completed when the vehicle is
button first and wait for the beep
Command
parked, engine running, all windows closed, and the
before speaking the “Barge In” commands.
blower fan switched off. This procedure may be repeated with a new user. The system will adapt to the
Voice Training
last trained voice only.
For users experiencing difficulty with the system recognizing their voice commands or numbers the Uconnect® SEATS
Voice “Voice Training” feature may be used.
Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the
button, say “System vehicle.
1. Press the Voice Command
Setup” and once you are in that menu then say “Voice
Training.” This will train your own voice to the system
WARNING!
and will improve recognition.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 147
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
3
Power Seats — If Equipped
The power seat switches are located on the outboard side
of the seat near the floor. Use the bottom switch to move
the seat up, down, forward, rearward, or to tilt the seat.
The top switch controls the seatback recliner.
Power Seat Switches
148 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
CAUTION!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
Do not place any article under a power seat or impede
its ability to move as it may cause damage to the seat
controls. Seat travel may become limited if movement
is stopped by an obstruction in the seat’s path.
Adjusting The Seat Forward Or Rearward
The seat can be adjusted both forward and rearward.
Push the seat switch forward or rearward, the seat will
move in the direction of the switch. Release the switch
when the desired position has been reached.
Adjusting The Seat Up Or Down
The height of the seats can be adjusted up or down. Pull
upward or push downward on the seat switch, the seat
will move in the direction of the switch. Release the
switch when the desired position is reached.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 149
Tilting The Seat Up Or Down
The angle of the seat cushion can be adjusted in four
directions. Pull upward or push downward on the front
or rear of the seat switch, the front or rear of the seat
cushion will move in the direction of the switch. Release
the switch when the desired position has been reached.
Reclining The Seatback
The angle of the seatback can be adjusted forward or
rearward. Push the seatback switch forward or rearward,
the seat will move in the direction of the switch. Release
the switch when the desired position is reached.
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
3
150 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not place any article under a power seat or impede
its ability to move as it may cause damage to the seat
controls. Seat travel may become limited if movement
is stopped by an obstruction in the seat’s path.
Heated Seats — If Equipped
You can choose from HIGH, LOW or OFF heat settings.
Amber indicator lights in each switch indicate the level of
heat in use. Two indicator lights will illuminate for
HIGH, one for LOW and none for OFF.
Press the switch once to select HIGH-level
heating. Press the switch a second time to select
LOW-level heating. Press the switch a third
time to shut the heating elements OFF.
There are two heated seat switches that allow the driver and
passenger to operate the seats independently. The controls NOTE: Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt
for each heater are located on the center of the instrument within two to five minutes.
panel (above the climate controls).
When the HIGH-level setting is selected, the heater will
provide a boosted heat level during the first four minutes of
operation. Then, the heat output will drop to the normal
HIGH-level. If the HIGH-level setting is selected, the system will automatically switch to LOW-level after approximately 30 minutes of continuous operation. At that time, the
number of illuminated LEDs changes from two to one,
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 151
indicating the change. The LOW-level setting will turn OFF Manual Front Seat Adjustment
automatically after approximately 30 minutes.
The manual seat adjustment bar is at the front of the seat,
near the floor.
WARNING!
• Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion or other physical condition must exercise care
when using the seat heater. It may cause burns
even at low temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
• Do not place anything on the seat or seatback that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion.
This may cause the seat heater to overheat. Sitting
in a seat that has been overheated could cause
serious burns due to the increased surface temperature of the seat.
3
Manual Seat Adjusting Bar
152 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Pull the bar upward to move the seat forward or rear- mechanism, located on the outboard side of the seat,
ward. Release the bar once the seat is in the position raises and lowers it. Total travel is 2.2 in (56 mm).
desired. Then, using body pressure, move forward and
rearward on the seat to be sure that the seat adjusters
have latched.
WARNING!
Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is
dangerous. The sudden movement of the seat could
cause you to lose control. The seat belt might not be
properly adjusted and you could be injured. Adjust
the seat only while the vehicle is parked.
Driver Seat Manual Height Adjuster — If
Equipped
Seat Height Adjustment Lever
Reclining Seats
A lever style height adjustment feature enhances comfort
for petite as well as tall drivers. A lever with a ratcheting The recline lever is located on the side of the seat. To
recline, lean forward slightly before lifting the lever, then
lean back to the desired position and release the lever.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 153
Lean forward and lift the lever to return the seatback to
its normal position.
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is
dangerous. The sudden movement of the seat could
cause you to lose control. The seat belt might not be
properly adjusted and you could be injured. Adjust
the seat only while the vehicle is parked.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your
chest. In a collision you could slide under the seat
belt and be seriously or even fatally injured. Use
the recliner only when the vehicle is parked.
Lumbar Support — If Equipped
Recline Lever
This feature allows you to increase or decrease the
amount of lumbar support. The control lever is located
on the outboard side of the driver’s seatback. Turn the
control lever downward to increase and upward to
decrease the desired amount of lumbar support.
3
154 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
The head restraints for all occupants must be properly adjusted prior to operating the vehicle or occupying a seat. Head restraints should never be adjusted while the vehicle is in motion. Driving a
vehicle with the head restraints improperly adjusted
or removed could cause serious injury or death in the
event of a collision.
Active Head Restraints — Front Seats
Active Head Restraints are passive, deployable components, and vehicles with this equipment cannot be readily
Head Restraints
identified by any markings, only through visual inspecHead restraints are designed to reduce the risk of injury tion of the head restraint. The head restraint will be split
by restricting head movement in the event of a rear in two halves, with the front half being soft foam and
impact. Head restraints should be adjusted so that the top trim, the back half being decorative plastic.
of the head restraint is located above the top of your ear.
Lumbar Support Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 155
When AHRs deploy during a rear impact, the front half
of the head restraint extends forward to minimize the gap
between the back of the occupant’s head and the AHR.
This system is designed to help prevent or reduce the
extent of injuries to the driver and front passenger in
certain types of rear impacts. Refer to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head
restraint. To lower the head restraint, press the push
button, located at the base of the head restraint, and push
downward on the head restraint.
3
Push Button
For comfort the Active Head Restraints can be tilted
forward and rearward. To tilt the head restraint closer to
the back of your head, pull forward on the bottom of the
head restraint. Push rearward on the bottom of the head
restraint to move the head restraint away from your
head.
156 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Active Head Restraint (Normal Position)
Active Head Restraint (Tilted)
NOTE:
• The head restraints should only be removed by qualified technicians, for service purposes only. If either of
the head restraints require removal, see your authorized dealer.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 157
• In the event of deployment of an Active Head Restraint, refer to “Occupant Restraints/Resetting Active
Head Restraints (AHR)” in “Things to Know Before
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
WARNING!
• Do not place items over the top of the Active Head
Restraint, such as coats, seat covers or portable
DVD players. These items may interfere with the
operation of the Active Head Restraint in the event
of a collision and could result in serious injury or
death.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Active Head Restraints may be deployed if they are
struck by an object such as a hand, foot or loose
cargo. To avoid accidental deployment of the Active Head Restraint ensure that all cargo is secured,
as loose cargo could contact the Active Head Restraint during sudden stops. Failure to follow this
warning could cause personal injury if the Active
Head Restraint is deployed.
Head Restraints — Rear Seats
The rear seat head restraints are fixed and cannot be
adjusted. For proper routing of a Child Seat Tether refer
to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things to Know Before
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
3
158 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The hard seatback features a work surface and a molded
The recline handle on the front passenger seat also rim for retaining items stored on the seatback panel.
releases the seatback to fold forward.
Fold-Flat Passenger Seatback
Fold-Flat Front Passenger Seat
Recline Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 159
When returning the rear seatback to the upright position,
To provide additional storage area, the rear seatback can be sure the seatback is latched.
be folded forward. Pull on the loops to fold down either
WARNING!
or both seatbacks.
Folding Rear Seat
• Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into
position. If the seatback is not securely locked into
position the seat will not provide the proper stability for child seats and/or passengers. An improperly latched seat could cause serious injury.
• The rear cargo area of the vehicle (with the rear
seatbacks in the locked-up or folded down position) should not be used as a play area by children.
They could be seriously injured in a collision.
Children should be seated and using the proper
restraint system.
Rear Seat Release Loops
3
160 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Folding Rear Seat Center Armrest
TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD
The rear seat is equipped with a folding armrest with To open the hood, two latches must be released.
cupholders.
1. Pull the hood release lever located under the left side
of the instrument panel.
Folding Rear Seat Armrest
Hood Release Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 161
2. Then lift the secondary latch located under the front
edge of the hood, near the center and raise the hood.
3
Prop Rod Location
Hood Safety Latch Location
Use the hood prop rod to secure the hood in the open
position. Place the upper end of the prop rod in the hole
on the left underside of the hood.
NOTE: Before closing the hood, make sure to stow the
prop rod in its proper location.
162 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood to
close it. Use a firm downward push at the center of
the hood to ensure that both latches engage.
passing light, fog lights, instrument panel light dimming
and turn signals. The multifunction lever is located on
the left side of the steering column.
WARNING!
Be sure the hood is fully latched before driving your
vehicle. If the hood is not fully latched, it could open
when the vehicle is in motion and block your vision.
Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
injury or death.
LIGHTS
Multifunction Lever
The multifunction lever controls the operation of the
parking lights, headlights, headlight beam selection,
Multifunction Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 163
Headlights And Parking Lights
Automatic Headlights — If Equipped
Turn the end of the multifunction lever to the first detent Turning the end of the multifunction lever to the third
for parking light operation. Turn to the second detent for detent (AUTO), will activate the automatic headlight
headlight operation.
system.
3
Headlight Switch
Headlight Switch
164 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
With the engine running and the multifunction lever in Headlight Time Delay
the AUTO position, the headlights will turn on and turn There is also a feature that delays turning off the vehicle
off based on the surrounding light levels.
lights for 30, 60 or 90 seconds after the ignition switch is
Headlights With Wipers (Available With Automatic turned OFF. To activate the headlight delay, the multifunction lever must be rotated to the off position after the
Headlights Only)
ignition switch is turned OFF. Only the headlights will
When this feature is active, the headlights will turn on
illuminate during this time. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle
approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on
Information Center (EVIC)/Customer-Programmable
if the multifunction lever is placed in the AUTO position.
Features” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
In addition, the headlights will turn off when the wipers
further information.
are turned off if they were turned on by this feature.
Lights On Reminder
The Headlights with Wipers feature can be turned on or
off through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center If the headlights or parking lights are on after the ignition
(EVIC) — if equipped. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Infor- is turned OFF, a chime will sound to alert the driver
mation Center (EVIC)/Customer-Programmable Fea- when the driver’s door is opened.
tures” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 165
NOTE: If either light remains on and does not flash, or
Move the multifunction lever up or down and the arrows there is a very fast flash rate, check for a defective outside
on each side of the instrument cluster flash to show light bulb. If an indicator fails to light when the lever is
moved, it would suggest that the indicator bulb is
proper operation of the front and rear turn signal lights.
defective.
Turn Signals
Lane Change Assist
Tap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond
the detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash
three times then automatically turn off.
High/Low Beam Switch
Push the multifunction lever away from you to switch
the headlights to high beam. Pull the lever toward you, to
switch the headlights back to low beam.
Turn Signal Control
3
166 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Flash-To-Pass
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by
lightly pulling the multifunction lever toward you. This
will turn on the high beam headlights until the lever is
released.
NOTE: If the multifunction lever is held in the flash-topass position for more than 15 seconds, the high beams
will shut off. If this occurs, wait 30 seconds for the next
flash-to-pass operation.
Fog Lights — If Equipped
Front Fog Light Operation
The front fog light switch is on the multifunction NOTE: The front fog lights will only operate with the
lever. To activate the front fog lights, turn on the headlights on low beam. Selecting high beam headlights
parking lights or the low beam headlights and pull out will turn off the front fog lights.
the end of the multifunction lever.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 167
Rotate the center portion of the lever upward to the next
detent position to brighten the odometer and radio when
The front turn signal lamps will turn on as Daytime
the parking lights or headlights are on.
Running Lights (DRL) whenever the ignition is ON, the
engine is running, the headlight switch is off, the parking Rotate the center portion of the lever upward to the last
brake is released and the shift lever is in any position detent to turn on the interior lighting.
except PARK.
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) — If Equipped
NOTE: The Daytime Running Lights will flash when a
turn signal is in operation and return to DRL mode when
the turn signal is not operating.
Instrument Panel Dimmer
Rotate the center portion of the lever to the extreme
bottom position to fully dim the instrument panel lights
and prevent the interior lights from illuminating when a
door is opened.
Rotate the center portion of the lever up to increase the
brightness of the instrument panel lights when the parking lights or headlights are on.
Dimmer Control
3
168 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Map/Reading/Interior Lights
These lights are mounted between the sun visors above
the rearview mirror. Each light can be turned on by
pressing the barrel. Press the barrel a second time to turn
the light off. Both of these lights can swivel so that the
light can be aimed at a specific spot, if desired. The lights
will remain on until the switch is pressed a second time,
so be sure they have been turned off before leaving the
vehicle. They will not turn off automatically. Interior
lighting also comes on when a door is opened or the
dimmer control is turned fully upward, past the second
detent.
Map/Reading Lights
There is a second light located midway back in the
headliner.
To protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
automatically 10 minutes after the ignition switch is
moved to the LOCK position. This will occur if the
interior lights were switched on manually or are on
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 169
because a door is open. To restore interior light operation,
either turn the ignition switch ON or cycle the light
switch.
Battery Saver Feature
To protect the battery, the interior lights will turn off
automatically 10 minutes after the ignition switch is
moved to the LOCK position. This will occur if the
interior lights were switched on manually or are on
because a door is open.
3
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
Windshield Wiper/Washer Lever
The wipers and washers are operated by a switch Rotate the end of the lever to the LO position for
on the control lever. The lever is located on the low-speed wiper operation, or to the HI position for
high-speed wiper operation.
right side of the steering column.
170 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• Turn the windshield wipers off when driving
through an automatic car wash. Damage to the
windshield wipers may result if the wiper control
is left in any position other than off.
• Always remove any buildup of snow that prevents
the windshield wiper blades from returning to the
off position. If the windshield wiper control is
turned off and the blades cannot return to the off
position, damage to the wiper motor may occur.
Changing Wiper Speeds
NOTE: The wipers will automatically return to the park
position if you turn the ignition switch OFF while they
are operating. The wipers will resume operation when
you turn the ignition switch to the ON position again.
Intermittent Wiper System
Use the intermittent wiper system when weather conditions make a single wiping cycle with a variable pause
between cycles desirable. Rotate the end of the windshield wiper/washer control lever to the first detent, and
then turn the end of the lever to select the desired delay
interval. There are five delay settings, which allow you to
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 171
regulate the wipe interval from a minimum of one cycle Windshield Washers
every second to a maximum of approximately 18 seconds To use the washer, pull the windshield wiper/washer
between cycles.
control lever toward you and hold it for as long as
washer spray is desired.
If you activate the washer while the wiper control is in
the delay range, the wipers will operate in low-speed for
two wipe cycles after releasing the lever and then resume
the intermittent interval previously selected.
If you activate the washer while the wiper control is in
the off position, the wipers will operate for two wipe
cycles and then turn off.
WARNING!
Changing Intermittent Settings
NOTE: The wiper delay times depend on vehicle speed.
If the vehicle is moving less than 10 mph (16 km/h),
delay times will be doubled.
Sudden loss of visibility through the windshield
could lead to a collision. You might not see other
vehicles or other obstacles. To avoid sudden icing of
(Continued)
3
172 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
the windshield during freezing weather, warm the
windshield with defroster before and during windshield washer use.
Mist Feature
Push down on the wiper control lever to activate a single
wipe to clear the windshield of road mist or spray from
a passing vehicle. As long as the lever is held down, the
wipers will continue to operate.
NOTE: The mist feature does not activate the washer
Mist Control
pump; therefore, no washer fluid will be sprayed on the
Headlights With Wipers Feature (Available With
windshield. The wash function must be used in order to
Automatic Headlights Only)
spray the windshield with washer fluid.
When this feature is active, the headlights will turn on
approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on
if the multifunction lever (on the left side of the steering
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 173
column) is placed in the AUTO position. In addition, the
headlights will turn off when the wipers are turned off if
they were turned on by this feature.
The headlights with wipers feature can be turned on or
off through the Electronic Vehicle Information Center
(EVIC) — if equipped. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)/Personal Settings (CustomerProgrammable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
3
TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
upward or downward. It also allows you to lengthen or
shorten the steering column. The tilt/telescoping lever is
located below the steering wheel at the end of the
steering column.
Tilt/Telescoping Lever
To unlock the steering column, push the lever downward. To tilt the steering column, move the steering
wheel upward or downward as desired. To lengthen or
shorten the steering column, pull the steering wheel
outward or push it inward as desired. To lock the steering
174 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
column in position, pull the lever upward until fully
engaged.
WARNING!
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious injury or
death.
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
Electronic Speed Control Buttons
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over 1 — ON/OFF
accelerator operations at speeds greater than 25 mph 4 — CANCEL
(40 km/h).
The Electronic Speed Control buttons are located on the
right side of the steering wheel.
2 — RES +
3 — SET -
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 175
NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the Electronic Speed Control System has been designed to shut
down if multiple Speed Control functions are operated at
the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control
System can be reactivated by pushing the Electronic
Speed Control ON/OFF button and resetting the desired
vehicle set speed.
WARNING!
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
You could lose control and have an accident. Always
leave the system OFF when you are not using it.
To Activate
To Set A Desired Speed
Push the ON/OFF button. The Cruise Indicator Light in
the instrument cluster will illuminate. To turn the system
off, push the ON/OFF button a second time. The Cruise
Indicator Light will turn off. The system should be
turned off when not in use.
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle
has reached the desired speed, press the SET (-) button
and release. Release the accelerator and the vehicle will
operate at the selected speed.
NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady speed
and on level ground before pressing the SET (-) button.
To Deactivate
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the CANCEL
button, or normal brake pressure while slowing the
3
176 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
vehicle will deactivate Electronic Speed Control without
erasing the set speed memory. Pressing the ON/OFF
button or turning the ignition switch OFF erases the set
speed memory.
Pressing the RES (+) button once will result in a 1 mph
(1.6 km/h) increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of
the button results in an increase of 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
To decrease speed while the Electronic Speed Control is
set, push the SET (-) button. If the button is continually
held in the SET (-) position, the set speed will continue to
To resume a previously set speed, push the RES (+)
decrease until the button is released. Release the button
button and release. Resume can be used at any speed
when the desired speed is reached, and the new set speed
above 20 mph (32 km/h).
will be established.
To Vary The Speed Setting
Pressing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 mph
To Resume Speed
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can increase speed by pushing the RES (+) button. If the button
is continually pressed, the set speed will continue to
increase until the button is released, then the new set
speed will be established.
(1.6 km/h) decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of
the button results in a decrease of 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
To Accelerate For Passing
Press the accelerator as you would normally. When the
pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 177
Using Electronic Speed Control On Hills
The transmission may downshift on hills to maintain the
vehicle set speed.
NOTE: The Electronic Speed Control system maintains
speed up and down hills. A slight speed change on
moderate hills is normal.
WARNING!
Electronic Speed Control can be dangerous where the
system cannot maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle could go too fast for the conditions, and you
could lose control and have an accident. Do not use
Electronic Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads
that are winding, icy, snow-covered or slippery.
On steep hills, a greater speed loss or gain may occur so
it may be preferable to drive without Electronic Speed
GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPED
Control.
HomeLink® replaces up to three hand-held transmitters
that operate devices such as garage door openers, motorized gates, lighting or home security systems. The
HomeLink® unit is powered by your vehicles 12 Volt
battery.
3
178 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The HomeLink® buttons, located on either the overhead
console, headliner or sunvisor, designate the three different HomeLink® channels.The HomeLink® indicator is
located above the center button.
HomeLink® Buttons/Sunvisor/Headliner
NOTE: HomeLink® is disabled when the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
HomeLink® Buttons/Overhead Consoles
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 179
Before You Begin Programming HomeLink®
NOTE:
Be sure that your vehicle is parked outside of the garage • Erasing all channels should only be performed when
before you begin programming.
programming HomeLink® for the first time. Do not
erase channels when programming additional buttons.
For more efficient programming and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal it is recommended that • If you have any problems, or require assistance, please
a new battery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of
call toll-free 1–800–355–3515 or, on the Internet at
the device that is being programmed to the HomeLink®
www.HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
system.
Programming A Rolling Code
Erase all channels before you begin programming. To
erase the channels place the ignition in the ON/RUN For programming garage door openers that were manuposition and press and hold the two outside HomeLink® factured after 1995. These garage door openers can be
buttons (I and III) for up 20 seconds or until the red identified by the “LEARN” or “TRAIN” button located
where the hanging antenna is attached to the garage door
indicator flashes.
opener. It is NOT the button that is normally used to
open and close the door. The name and color of the
button may vary by manufacturer.
3
180 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 in (3 to 8 cm)
away from the HomeLink® button you wish to program while keeping the HomeLink® indicator light in
view.
3. Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink®
button you want to program and the hand-held transmitter button.
Training The Garage Door Opener
1 — Door Opener
2 — Training Button
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
4. Continue to hold both buttons and observe the indicator light. The Homelink® indicator will flash slowly
and then rapidly after Homelink® has received the
frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons after the indicator light changes
from slow to rapid.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 181
5. At the garage door opener motor (in the garage),
locate the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. This can
usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is
attached to the garage door opener/device motor.
Firmly press and release the “LEARN” or “TRAINING” button. On some garage door openers/devices
there may be a light that blinks when the garage door
opener/device is in the LEARN/TRAIN mode.
To program the remaining two HomeLink® buttons,
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
erase the channels.
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained,
follow these steps:
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: You have 30 seconds in which to initiate the next 2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button until
step after the LEARN button has been pressed.
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do
not release the button.
6. Return to the vehicle and press the programmed
HomeLink® button twice (holding the button for two 3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Programseconds each time). If the garage door opener/device
ming A Rolling Code” Step 2 and follow all remaining
activates, programming is complete.
steps.
NOTE: If the garage door opener/device does not activate, press the button a third time (for two seconds) to
complete the training.
3
182 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Programming A Non-Rolling Code
For programming Garage Door Openers manufactured
before 1995.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position.
5. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink® button
and observe the indicator light.
• If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and the garage door/device should
activate when the HomeLink® button is pressed.
• To program the two remaining HomeLink® buttons,
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
erase the channels.
2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 in (3 to 8 cm)
away from the HomeLink® button you wish to program while keeping the HomeLink® indicator light in
view.
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button
3. Simultaneously press and hold both the Homelink® To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained,
button you want to program and the hand-held trans- follow these steps:
mitter button.
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
4. Continue to hold both buttons and observe the indicator light. The Homelink® indicator will flash slowly 2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button until
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do
and then rapidly after HomeLink® has received the
not release the button.
frequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons after the indicator light changes
from slow to rapid.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 183
3. Without releasing the button proceed with “Program- 2. Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to 3 in (3 to 8 cm)
away from the HomeLink® button you wish to proming A Non-Rolling Code” Step 2 and follow all
gram while keeping the HomeLink® indicator light in
remaining steps.
view.
Canadian/Gate Operator Programming
For programming transmitters in Canada/United States 3. Continue to press and hold the HomeLink® button,
while you press and release (“cycle”), your hand-held
that require the transmitter signals to “time-out” after
transmitter every two seconds until HomeLink® has
several seconds of transmission.
successfully accepted the frequency signal. The indiCanadian radio frequency laws require transmitter sigcator light will flash slowly and then rapidly when
nals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds of transfully trained.
mission – which may not be long enough for HomeLink®
to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this 4. Watch for the HomeLink® indicator to change flash
rates. When it changes, it is programmed. It may take
Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to
up to 30 seconds or longer in rare cases. The garage
time-out in the same manner.
door may open and close while you are programming.
It may be helpful to unplug the device during the cycling
process to prevent possible overheating of the garage 5. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink® button
and observe the indicator light.
door or gate motor.
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
3
184 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• If the indicator light stays on constantly, program- 3. Without releasing the button proceed with
“Canadian/Gate Operator Programming” Step 2 and
ming is complete and the garage door/device should
follow all remaining steps.
activate when the HomeLink® button is pressed.
• To program the two remaining HomeLink® buttons, Using HomeLink®
repeat each step for each remaining button. DO NOT
To operate, press and release the programmed
erase the channels.
HomeLink® button. Activation will now occur for the
If you unplugged the garage door opener/device for programmed device (i.e., garage door opener, gate operaprogramming, plug it back in at this time.
tor, security system, entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.,). The hand-held transmitter of the device may
Reprogramming A Single HomeLink® Button
also be used at any time.
To reprogram a channel that has been previously trained,
Security
follow these steps:
1. Cycle the ignition to the ON/RUN position.
It is advised to erase all channels before you sell or turn
in your vehicle.
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button until
the indicator light begins to flash after 20 seconds. Do To do this, press and hold the two outside buttons for 20
seconds until the red indicator flashes. Note that all
not release the button.
channels will be erased. Individual channels cannot be
erased.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 185
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver is disabled when
the Vehicle Security Alarm is active.
Troubleshooting Tips
If you are having trouble programming HomeLink®,
here are some of the most common solutions:
• Replace the battery in the original hand-held transmitter.
• Press the LEARN button on the Garage Door Opener
to complete the training for a Rolling Code.
• Did you unplug the device for programming and
remember to plug it back in?
If you have any problems, or require assistance, please
call toll-free 1–800–355–3515 or, on the Internet at
www.HomeLink.com for information or assistance.
WARNING!
• Your motorized door or gate will open and close
while you are programming the universal transceiver. Do not program the transceiver if people,
pets or other objects are in the path of the door or
gate. Only use this transceiver with a garage door
opener that has a “stop and reverse” feature as
required by Federal safety standards. This includes
most garage door opener models manufactured
after 1982. Do not use a garage door opener without
these safety features. Call toll-free 1–800–355–3515
or, on the Internet at www.HomeLink.com for
safety information or assistance.
• Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide, a dangerous gas. Do not run your vehicle in the garage
while programming the transceiver. Exhaust gas
can cause serious injury or death.
3
186 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
General Information
POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED
This device complies with FCC rules Part 15 and Industry The sunroof controls are mounted between the dome/
Canada RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following reading lights.
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference that may be
received including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
• The transmitter has been tested and it complies with FCC
and IC rules. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could
void the user’s authority to operate the device.
• The term IC before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.
Power Sunroof Switch
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 187
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Never leave the key
fob in or near the vehicle. Occupants, particularly
unattended children, can become entrapped by the
power sunroof while operating the power sunroof
switch. Such entrapment may result in serious
injury or death.
• In a collision, there is a greater risk of being thrown
from a vehicle with an open sunroof. You could
also be seriously injured or killed. Always fasten
your seat belt properly and make sure all passengers are properly secured.
• Do not allow small children to operate the sunroof.
Never allow your fingers, other body parts, or any
object to project through the sunroof opening.
Injury may result.
Opening Sunroof — Express
Press the switch rearward and release it within one-half
second. The sunroof and sunshade will open automatically from any position. The sunroof and sunshade will
open fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express
Open”. During Express Open operation, any movement
of the sunroof switch will stop the sunroof.
Opening Sunroof — Manual Mode
To open the sunroof, press and hold the switch rearward
to full open. Any release of the switch will stop the
movement. The sunroof and sunshade will remain in a
partially opened condition until the switch is pushed and
held rearward again.
Closing Sunroof — Express
Press the switch forward and release it within one-half
second and the sunroof will close automatically from any
3
188 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
position. The sunroof will close fully and stop automatically. This is called “Express Close”. During Express
Close operation, any movement of the switch will stop
the sunroof.
NOTE: If three consecutive sunroof close attempts result in Pinch Protect reversals, the fourth close attempt
will be a Manual Close movement with Pinch Protect
disabled.
Closing Sunroof — Manual Mode
Venting Sunroof — Express
To close the sunroof, press and hold the switch in the
forward position. Any release of the switch will stop the
movement and the sunroof will remain in a partially
closed condition until the switch is pushed and held
forward again.
Press and release the Vent button within one half second
and the sunroof will open to the vent position. This is
called “Express Vent”, and it will occur regardless of
sunroof position. During Express Vent operation, any
movement of the switch will stop the sunroof.
Pinch Protect Feature
Sunshade Operation
This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of
the sunroof during Express Close operation. If an obstruction in the path of the sunroof is detected, the
sunroof will automatically retract. Remove the obstruction if this occurs. Next, press the switch forward and
release to Express Close.
The sunshade can be opened manually. However, the
sunshade will open automatically as the sunroof opens.
NOTE: The sunshade cannot be closed if the sunroof is
open.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 189
Wind Buffeting
Ignition Off Operation
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to
minimize the buffeting or open any window.
For Vehicles Not Equipped With The Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC)
Sunroof Maintenance
The power sunroof switch will remain active for 45
seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
position. Opening either front door will cancel this
feature.
For Vehicles Equipped With The EVIC
The power sunroof switch will remain active for up to
approximately ten minutes after the ignition switch is
turned to the LOCK position. Opening either front door
will cancel this feature.
Use only a non-abrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to clean
the glass panel.
ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS
There are two 12 Volt (13 Amp) electrical power outlets
on this vehicle. Both of the power outlets are protected by
a fuse.
3
190 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The instrument panel power outlet, located below the A second power outlet is located inside the center conclimate control knobs, has power available only when the sole.
ignition is ON. This power outlet will also operate a
conventional cigar lighter unit.
Center Console Power Outlet
The center console power outlet is powered directly from
the battery (power available at all times). Items plugged
NOTE: To preserve the heating element, do not hold the into this power outlet may discharge the battery and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
lighter in the heating position.
Instrument Panel Power Outlet
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 191
NOTE: To ensure proper operation a MOPAR® knob
and element must be used.
CAUTION!
• Do not exceed the maximum power of 160 Watts (13
Amps) at 12 Volts. If the 160 Watt (13 Amp) power
rating is exceeded the fuse protecting the system
will need to be replaced.
• Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs
only. Do not insert any other object in the power
outlets as this will damage the outlet and blow the
fuse. Improper use of the power outlet can cause
damage not covered by your New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
3
Power Outlet Fuse Locations
1 — #16 Fuse 15 A Blue Cigar Lighter Instrument Panel
2 — #11 Fuse 15 A Blue Power Outlet Inside Arm Rest
192 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
CAUTION!
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this type of outlet
should be inserted into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lid when not in use and while driving the
vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an electric
shock and failure.
• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw
power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not in
use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers,
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.) will degrade the battery even more quickly. Only use these intermittently and with greater caution.
• After the use of high power draw accessories, or
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the
generator to recharge the vehicle’s battery.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 193
CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF
EQUIPPED
An optional ash receiver is available from your authorized dealer and will fit in the center console front
cupholder.
3
The optional ash receiver also comes with a cigar lighter
that can be used with the power outlets. Refer to “Power
Outlets” in “Understanding the Features of Your Vehicle”
for further information.
CUPHOLDERS
Front Cupholders
Front Seat Cupholders
Rear Cupholders
The cupholders in the center console will accommodate
either two large size cups or two 20 oz (.5 L) bottles or The rear seat cupholders are located in the armrest
cans. The one-peice insert can be easily removed for between the rear seats. Pull down the armrest to use the
cleaning. An optional removable ashtray may be located cupholders.
in one of the cupholders.
194 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Rear Cupholders
Rear Seat Bottle Holder
There are built-in bottle holders located in both rear door
trim panels.
Rear Bottle Holder
WARNING!
If containers of hot liquid are placed in the bottle
holder, they can spill when the door is closed, burning the occupants. Be careful when closing the doors
to avoid injury.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 195
STORAGE
CONSOLE FEATURES
Glovebox Storage Compartment
Storage
The glovebox storage compartment is located on the right
side of the instrument panel. To open the glovebox, pull
outward on the latch handle located on the front of the
glovebox.
The center console is located between the front driver
and passenger seats. The center console armrest slides
forward from design position to provide added user
comfort. The center console can be used for storage and
is also equipped with an electrical power outlet. Refer to
“Power Outlets” in “Understanding The Feature of Your
Vehicle” for further information.
Glovebox Storage Compartment
3
196 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Center Console Armrest
Center Console Storage
Two separate storage compartments are also located The top compartment holds small items, such as a pen
underneath the armrest.
and note pad, while the larger bottom compartment will
hold CDs and alike. The bottom compartment also contains a 12 Volt power outlet. The console’s front opening
lid allows for easy access to these compartments.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 197
NOTE:
CARGO AREA FEATURES
• A notch in the front of the console base allows for use The 60/40 split-folding rear seat provides cargo-carrying
of a cellular phone while it is plugged into the power versatility. The seatbacks fold down easily by pulling
nylon tabs between the seatbacks and the bolsters. When
outlet with the armrest latched down.
the seats are folded down, they provide a continuous,
• The power outlet can also energize the cigar lighter in nearly flat extension of the load floor.
the optional cup holder ash receiver.
When the seatback is folded to the upright position, make
sure it is latched by strongly pulling on the top of the
WARNING!
seatback above the seat strap.
Do not operate this vehicle with a console compartment lid in the open position. Cellular phones, music
players, and other handheld electronic devices
should be stowed while driving. Use of these devices
while driving can cause an accident due to distraction, resulting in death or injury.
3
198 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Be certain that the seatback is securely locked into
position. If the seatback in not securely locked into
position, the seat will not provide the proper stability for child seats and/or passengers. An improperly latched seat could cause serious injury.
• The cargo area in the rear of the vehicle (with the
rear seatbacks in the locked-up or folded down
position) should not be used as a play area by
children when the vehicle is in motion. They could
be seriously injured in a collision. Children should
be seated and using the proper restraint system.
• To help protect against personal injury, passengers
should not be seated in the rear cargo area. The rear
cargo space is intended for load carrying purposes
only, not for passengers, who should sit in seats
and use seat belts.
• The weight and position of cargo and passengers
can change the vehicle center of gravity and vehicle
handling. To avoid loss of control resulting in
personal injury, follow these guidelines for loading
your vehicle:
(Continued)
Always place cargo evenly on the cargo floor. Put heavier
objects as low and as far forward as possible. Place as
much cargo as possible in front of the rear axle. Too much
weight or improperly placed weight over or behind the
rear axle can cause the rear of the vehicle to sway.
Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the top of the
seatback. This could impair visibility or become a dangerous projectile in a sudden stop or collision.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 199
Ski Pass-Through
REAR WINDOW FEATURES
There is a ski pass-through door located behind the rear seat Rear Window Defroster
armrest that allows longer items, such as snow skis, to be
stored in the rear cargo area. Lower the armrest and pull
The rear window defroster button is located on
downward on the latch to open the ski pass-through door.
the climate control (Mode) knob. Press this button
to turn on the rear window defroster and the heated
outside mirrors (if equipped). An indicator in the button
will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The
rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately 10 minutes. For an additional five minutes of
operation, press the button a second time.
NOTE: To prevent excessive battery drain, use the rear
window defroster only when the engine is operating.
Ski Pass-Through
3
200 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
䡵 INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES . . . . . . . . . .204
▫ EVIC Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
▫ Compass Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS . . . . .206
▫ Average Fuel Economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
䡵 MINI-TRIP COMPUTER — IF EQUIPPED . . . . .220
▫ Distance To Empty (DTE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
▫ Control Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
▫ Tire PSI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
䡵 ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC) — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
▫ Elapsed Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
▫ Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
▫ Oil Change Required — If Equipped . . . . . . .225
▫ EVIC Units Selection (UNITS IN Display) . . . .231
▫ System Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
▫ Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable
Features) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
4
202 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
䡵 SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK . . . . . . . . . . .234
▫ Operating Instructions — Radio Mode. . . . . . .244
䡵 Uconnect® 730N/430/430N CD/DVD/HDD/NAV
— IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
▫ Operation Instructions — CD MODE for CD and
MP3 Audio Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
▫ Operating Instructions (Voice Command System)
— If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
▫ Notes On Playing MP3 Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
▫ Operating Instructions (Uconnect® Phone) — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
䡵 Uconnect® 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
▫ Operating Instructions — Radio Mode. . . . . . .235
▫ Operation Instructions — CD MODE For CD And
MP3 Audio Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
▫ Notes on Playing MP3 Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
▫ Operation Instructions - Auxiliary Mode . . . . .244
䡵 Uconnect® 130 WITH SATELLITE RADIO . . . . .244
▫ LIST Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play) . . . . . . .256
▫ INFO Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play) . . . . . .256
▫ Uconnect® (Satellite Radio) — If Equipped . . .257
䡵 iPod®/USB/MP3 CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED . . .261
▫ Connecting The iPod® Or External USB
Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
▫ Using This Feature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
▫ Controlling The iPod® Or External USB Device
Using Radio Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
▫ Play Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 203
▫ List Or Browse Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265 䡵 RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES . .270
▫ Bluetooth Streaming Audio (BTSA) . . . . . . . . .267 䡵 CLIMATE CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
䡵 STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
▫ Manual Heating And Air Conditioning . . . . . .270
▫ Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
▫ Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) —
If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
▫ CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
▫ Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
䡵 CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . .269
4
204 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES
1
2
3
4
5
— Air Outlet
— Side Window Demister Outlet
— Instrument Cluster
— Ignition Switch
— Analog Clock
6 — Radio
7 — Passenger Airbag
8 — Glove Compartment
9 — Heated Seat Switch – If Equipped
10 — Hazard Switch
11 — Storage Compartment
12 — Climate Control
13 — Trunk Release Button
14 — Power Outlet
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 205
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
4
206 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
removes this heat. You can also turn the Temperature
control to maximum heat, the Mode control to Floor and
1. Temperature Gauge
the Fan control to High. This allows the heater core to act
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant tempera- as a supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat
ture. Any reading below the red mark of the gauge shows from the engine cooling system.
that the engine cooling system is operating properly. The
2. Fuel Door Reminder
gauge pointer may show a higher than normal temperature when driving in hot weather, up mountain grades, in
This is a reminder that the Fuel Filler Door is
heavy stop and go traffic, or when towing a trailer.
located on the left side of the vehicle.
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS
If the pointer rises to the H (red) mark, the instrument
cluster will sound a chime. Pull over and stop the vehicle.
Idle the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until
the pointer drops back into the normal range. If the
pointer remains on the H (red) mark, turn the engine off
immediately and call for service.
3. Fuel Gauge
When the ignition switch is in the ON/RUN position, the
pointer will show the level of fuel remaining in the fuel
tank.
There are steps that you can take to slow down an 4. Speedometer
impending overheat condition. If your air conditioning is Indicates the vehicle speed in miles per hour (MPH) and
on, turn it off. The air conditioning system adds heat to kilometers per hour (km/h).
the engine cooling system and turning off the A/C
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 207
5. Low Fuel Light
If jump starting is required, refer to “Jump Starting
Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies”.
When the fuel level drops to approximately 2.0
gallons (7.6 Liters), the fuel symbol will light and 7. Air Bag Warning Light
a single chime will sound.
This light will turn on for four to eight seconds
as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first
NOTE: This light will remain on until a minimum of
turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on
approximately 3.0 gallons of fuel is added.
during starting, stays on, or turns on while
6. Charging System Light
driving, have the system inspected at an authorized
This light shows the status of the electrical charg- dealer as soon as possible. Refer to “Occupant Restraints”
ing system. The light should come on briefly in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
when the ignition is first turned on and remain on briefly further information.
as a bulb check. If the light stays on or comes on while 8. Seat Belt Reminder Light
driving, turn off some of the vehicle’s electrical devices,
When the ignition switch is first turned to ON/
such as the Front Fog Lights or Rear Window Defroster.
RUN, this light will turn on for four to eight
If the Charging System Light remains on, it means that
seconds as a bulb check. During the bulb check, if
the vehicle is experiencing a problem with the charging
system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY. See your local the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled, a chime will sound.
After the bulb check or when driving, if the driver seat
authorized dealer.
belt remains unbuckled, the Seat Belt Warning Light will
4
208 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
flash or remain on continuously. Refer to “Occupant 10. Engine Temperature Warning Light
Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your
This light warns of an overheated engine condiVehicle” for further information.
tion. As engine coolant temperatures rise and the
9. Oil Pressure Warning Light
gauge approaches H, this indicator will illuminate and a
single chime will sound after reaching a set threshold.
This light indicates low engine oil pressure. The
Further overheating will cause the temperature gauge to
light will come on and remain on when the ignition
pass H, and a continuous chime will occur until the
switch is turned from the OFF to the ON/RUN position,
engine is allowed to cool or the 4 minutes duration is
and the light will turn off after the engine is started. If the
expired, whichever come first.
bulb does not come on during starting, have the system
If the light turns on while driving, safely pull over and
checked by an authorized dealer.
stop the vehicle. If the A/C system is on, turn it off. Also,
If the light comes on and remains on while driving, stop
shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and idle the vethe vehicle and shut off the engine. DO NOT OPERATE
hicle. If the temperature reading does not return to
THE VEHICLE UNTIL THE CAUSE IS CORRECTED.
normal, turn the engine off immediately and call for
The light does not show the quantity of oil in the engine. service. Refer to “If Your Engine Overheats” in “What To
This can be determined using the procedure shown in Do In Emergencies” for further information.
“Maintaining Your Vehicle”.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 209
11. Brake Warning Light
This light monitors various brake functions,
including brake fluid level and parking brake
application. If the brake light turns on it may
indicate that the parking brake is applied, that
the brake fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with
the anti-lock brake system.
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
system. Failure of either half of the dual brake system is
indicated by the Brake Warning Light which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder has
dropped below a specified level.
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necessary.
WARNING!
Driving a vehicle with the brake light on is dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed. It will
take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have a
collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
Vehicles equipped with Anti-Lock brakes (ABS), are also
equipped with Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD).
In the event of an EBD failure, the Brake Warning Light
will turn on along with the ABS Light. Immediate repair
to the ABS system is required.
The operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp by turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to
cornering maneuvers which change fluid level condi- the ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for
tions. The vehicle should have service performed, and approximately three seconds. The light should then turn
the brake fluid level checked.
4
210 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
off unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is NOTE: You must apply the brakes before shifting from
detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light PARK.
inspected by an authorized dealer.
14. Odometer Display/Trip Odometer Display
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
The odometer display shows the total distance the veapplied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN posihicle has been driven.
tion.
U.S. Federal regulations require that upon transfer of
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is vehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application. correct mileage that the vehicle has been driven. If your
odometer needs to be repaired or serviced, the repair
12. Tachometer
technician should leave the odometer reading the same
The silver area of the scale shows the permissible engine as it was before the repair or service. If s/he cannot do so,
revolutions-per-minute (RPM x 1000) for each gear range. then the odometer must be set at zero, and a sticker must
Before reaching the red area, ease up on the accelerator to be placed in the door jamb stating what the mileage was
prevent engine damage.
before the repair or service. It is a good idea for you to
13. Shift Lever Indicator
make a record of the odometer reading before the repair/
service, so that you can be sure that it is properly reset, or
The Shift Lever Indicator is self-contained within the
that the door jamb sticker is accurate if the odometer
instrument cluster. It displays the gear position of the
must be reset at zero.
automatic transmission.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 211
The two trip odometers show individual trip mileage. To
switch from odometer to trip odometers, press and
release the Trip Odometer button. To reset a trip odometer, display the desired trip odometer to be reset then
push and hold the button until the display resets (approximately 2 seconds). Refer to “Trip Odometer Button”
for additional information.
gASCAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Cap Fault
HOTOIL . Engine Oil Temperature Exceeds Safe Threshold
NOTE: If the instrument cluster is equipped with the
optional Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC),
then warnings such as ”Low Tire,” “Door Ajar” and
Vehicle Odometer Messages
“Trunk Ajar” will display in the EVIC. (Refer to “ElecWhen the appropriate conditions exist, the odometer will tronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” for specific
display the following messages:
messages).
door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Door Ajar LoW tirE
When the appropriate condition exists, the odometer
dECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Trunk Ajar display will toggle between LoW and tirE for three
cycles.
LoW tirE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low Tire Pressure
CHANgE OIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Change Required
4
212 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
HOTOIL
the problem continues, the message will appear the next
time the vehicle is started. See your authorized dealer
service center as soon as possible.
When this message is displayed there is a engine oil
over-temperature condition. When this condition occurs,
the “HOTOIL” message will be displayed in the odom- CHANgE OIL
eter along with a chime.
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change
Refer to “If Your Engine Overheats” in “What To Do In indicator system. The “CHANgE OIL” message will flash
Emergencies”.
in the instrument cluster odometer for approximately 12
seconds after a single chime has sounded to indicate the
gASCAP
next scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change
If the vehicle diagnostic system detects a leak or change indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the
in the evaporative system, or the fuel filler cap is loose, engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon
improperly installed, or damaged, the words “gASCAP” your personal driving style.
will display in the odometer display area. If this occurs,
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each time
tighten the fuel filler cap properly and press the odomyou turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position. To turn
eter reset button to turn off the “gASCAP” message.
off the message temporarily, press and release the Trip
(Refer to “Onboard Diagnostic System — OBDII” in
Odometer button on the instrument cluster. To reset the oil
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information). If
change indicator system (after performing the scheduled
maintenance) perform the following procedure:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 213
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position (do 16. Odometer/Trip Odometer Reset Button
not start the engine).
Trip Odometer
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal slowly 3 times Press and release this button to change the display from
within 10 seconds.
odometer to “Trip A.” Press and release it a second time
3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
to change the display to “Trip B.” Press and release it a
third time to change the display back to the odometer.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you
start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not To reset the trip odometer, first display the trip mileage
that you want to reset, “Trip A” or “Trip B.” Then push
reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
and hold the button (approximately 2 seconds) until the
4. For vehicles equipped with the Electronic Vehicle display resets to 0 miles (km). The odometer must be in
Information Center (EVIC), refer to “Electronic Vehicle Trip Mode to reset the trip odometer.
Information Center (EVIC)”.
17. Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) Indicator Light
15. Cruise Indicator — If Equipped
This light informs you of a problem with the
This indicator shows that the Electronic Speed
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. If a
Control System is ON.
problem is detected, the light will come on
while the engine is running. If the light remains
lit with the engine running, your vehicle will usually be
4
214 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
drivable and not need towing, however see your autho- 19. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator
rized dealer for service as soon as possible.
Light — If Equipped
If the light is flashing when the engine is running you
may experience power loss, an elevated/rough idle, and
increased brake pedal effort, and your vehicle may
require towing. Immediate service is required.
This light indicates the Electronic Stability Control system (ESC) has been turned off by the
driver.
20. Turn Signal Indicators
The light will come on when the ignition switch is first
The arrows will flash in unison with the exterior
turned on and remain briefly as a bulb check. This is
turn signal, when using the turn signal lever. A
normal. If the light does not come on during starting,
chime will sound if the vehicle is driven more than 1 mile
have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
(1.6 km) with either turn signal on.
18. Park/Headlight ON Indicator — If Equipped
NOTE: If either indicator flashes at a rapid rate, check
This indicator will illuminate when the park for a defective outside light bulb.
lights or headlights are turned on.
21. Front Fog Light Indicator — If Equipped
This indicator will illuminate when the front fog
lights are on.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 215
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced
as soon as possible to restore the benefit of Anti-Lock
This light will flash rapidly for approximately
Brakes.
16 seconds when the alarm system is arming.
The light will begin to flash slowly indicating The ABS warning light should be checked frequently to
that the system is armed. The light will stop assure that it is operating properly. Turn the ignition key
to the on position, but do not start the vehicle. The light
flashing when the vehicle is disarmed.
should come on. If the light does not come on, have the
23. Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light — If Equipped
system inspected by an authorized dealer.
This light monitors the ABS. This light will
24. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Activation/
come on when the ignition key is turned to the
Malfunction Indicator Light — If Equipped
ON/RUN position and may stay on for apThe “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
proximately three seconds.
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on
If the ABS light remains on or comes on during driving, it
when the ignition switch is turned to the
indicates that the Anti-Lock portion of the brake system is
ON/RUN position. It should go out with the
not functioning and that service is required, however, the
engine
running.
If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Inconventional brake system will continue to operate nordicator
Light”
comes
on continuously with the engine
mally provided that the BRAKE warning light is not on.
running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC
system. If this light remains on after several ignition
22. Vehicle Security Light — If Equipped
4
216 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles 25. Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
(kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
your authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the
should be checked monthly when cold and
problem diagnosed and corrected.
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended
NOTE:
by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle
• The “ESC Off Indicator Light” and the “ESC
has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” come on movehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
mentarily each time the ignition switch is turned to
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those
ON/RUN.
tires.)
• Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the ESC As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been
system will be ON, even if it was turned off previously. equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System
• The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds
when it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop
when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver
that caused the ESC activation.
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when
one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving
on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 217
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after
the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle, to
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels
tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to
allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.
maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS
CAUTION!
low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunc- The TPMS has been optimized for the original equiption indicator to indicate when the system is not operating ment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and warning
properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined have been established for the tire size equipped on
with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor
a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one damage may result when using replacement equipment
minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This that is not of the same size, type, and/or style. Aftersequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups market wheels can cause sensor damage. Do not use tire
as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction sealant from a can or balance beads if your vehicle is
indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to equipped with a TPMS, as damage to the sensors may
detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS mal- result.
functions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on
4
218 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
26. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) is part of
an onboard diagnostic system called OBD that
monitors emissions, engine, and automatic transmission control systems. The light will illuminate when
the key is in the ON/RUN position before engine start. If
the bulb does not come on when turning the key from
LOCK to ON/RUN, have the condition checked
promptly.
Certain conditions, such as a loose or missing gas cap,
poor fuel quality, etc., may illuminate the light after
engine start. The vehicle should be serviced if the light
stays on through several of your typical driving cycles. In
most situations, the vehicle will drive normally and will
not require towing.
CAUTION!
Prolonged driving with the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) on could cause damage to the engine
control system. It also could affect fuel economy and
driveability. If the MIL is flashing, severe catalytic
converter damage and power loss will soon occur.
Immediate service is required.
WARNING!
A malfunctioning catalytic converter, as referenced
above, can reach higher temperatures than in normal
operating conditions. This can cause a fire if you
drive slowly or park over flammable substances such
as dry plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could result
in death or serious injury to the driver, occupants or
others.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 219
27. Transmission Temperature Warning Light — If
Equipped
WARNING!
This light indicates that the transmission fluid If you continue operating the vehicle when the
temperature is running hot. This may occur Transmission Temperature Warning Light is illumiwith severe usage, such as trailer towing. If this nated you could cause the fluid to boil over, come in
light turns on while driving, safely pull over contact with hot engine or exhaust components and
and stop the vehicle. Then, shift the transmission into cause a fire.
NEUTRAL and run the engine at idle or faster until the 28. High Beam Indicator
light turns off.
This light indicates that the headlights are on high
beam. Pull the turn signal lever toward the steerCAUTION!
ing wheel to switch the headlights to low beam.
Continuous driving with the Transmission Tempera29. Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Disture Warning Light illuminated will eventually cause
play — If Equipped
severe transmission damage or transmission failure.
This display shows the EVIC messages when the appropriate conditions exist. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” for further information.
4
220 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
MINI-TRIP COMPUTER — IF EQUIPPED
Control Buttons
The Mini-Trip Computer is located in the instrument
cluster and features a driver-interactive trip information
and temperature display.
NOTE: The system will display the last known outside
temperature when starting the vehicle and may need to
be driven several minutes before the updated temperature is displayed. Engine temperature can also affect the
displayed temperature; therefore, temperature readings
are not updated when the vehicle is not moving.
Mini-Trip Control Buttons
STEP Button
Press the STEP button located on the steering wheel to
scroll through sub menus (i.e., Temperature, Trip Functions: Odometer, Trip A, Trip B).
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 221
RESET Button
To reset the display shown, turn the ignition switch to the
ON position, then press and hold the RESET button
located on the steering wheel.
The following displays can be reset or changed:
• Trip A
• Trip B
Trip Odometer (ODO)
This display shows the distance traveled since the last reset.
Press and release the STEP button on the instrument cluster
to switch from odometer, to Trip A or Trip B.
Trip A
Shows the total distance traveled for Trip A since the last
reset.
Trip B
Shows the total distance traveled for Trip B since the last
reset.
4
222 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC) — IF EQUIPPED
The EVIC consists of the following:
•
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display that is located in the
•
instrument cluster.
•
Compass Heading Display (N, S, E, W, NE, NW, SE,
SW)
Mileage (Avg/MPG)
Miles To Empty
• Low Tire Information (Tire Pressure Monitor System
(TPMS) Displays) — if equipped
• Timer
• Units
• System Warnings (Door Ajar, etc.)
• Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)
• Outside Temperature Display (°F or °C)
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
• Audio Mode Displays – 12 preset Radio Stations or CD
Title and Track number when playing
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 223
The system allows the driver to select information by MENU Button
pressing the following buttons on the instrument panel
Press and release the MENU button to advance
switch bank located below the climate controls:
the display to each of the EVIC Main Menu
features. Upon reaching the last item in the
Main Menu the EVIC will advance to the first
item in the Main Menu with the next MENU button press
and release.
DOWN Button
Press and release the DOWN button to advance
the display through the various Trip Functions
or Personal Settings.
COMPASS Button
EVIC Steering Wheel Buttons
Press and release the COMPASS button to
display the compass heading, the outside temperature, and Audio Info (when the radio is on)
screen when the current screen is not the
compass, outside temp, audio info screen.
4
224 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
SELECT Button
• RKE (Remote Keyless Entry) Battery Low (with a
single chime)
Press and release the SELECT Button to accept
a selection. The SELECT Button also resets •
various Trip Functions.
•
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
•
Displays
When the appropriate conditions exist, the EVIC displays
the following messages:
• Turn Signal On (with a continuous warning chime
after one mile traveled)
Personal Settings Not Avail – Vehicle Not In PARK
Personal Settings Not Avail – Vehicle in Motion
Door Ajar (with vehicle graphic showing which door is
open. A single chime sounds if the vehicle is in
motion).
• Doors Ajar (with vehicle graphic showing which doors
are open. A single chime sounds if the vehicle is in
motion).
• Left Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime) • Trunk Open (with vehicle graphic showing and open
trunk and A single chime )
• Left Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime)
• Lights On
• Right Front Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single
• Key In Ignition
chime)
• Right Rear Turn Signal Lamp Out (with a single chime) • Remote start aborted — Door ajar
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 225
• Remote start aborted — Hood ajar
• Remote start aborted — Trunk ajar
• Remote start aborted — Fuel low
• Remote start disabled — System fault
• Oil Change Required (with a single chime)
• Low Tire (with a graphic of the car showing which
tire(s) is/are low - with a single chime and ⬙Inflate to
XX⬙). Refer to ⬙Tire Pressure Monitoring System⬙ in
⬙Starting and Operating⬙.
flash in the EVIC display for approximately five seconds
after a single chime has sounded to indicate the next
scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change
indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the
engine oil change interval may fluctuate dependent upon
your personal driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each
time you turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN
position. To turn off the message temporarily, press and
release the MENU button. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled maintenance),
perform the following procedure:
• Check TPM System (with a single chime) Refer to ⬙Tire
Pressure Monitoring System⬙ in ⬙Starting and Operat- 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not
start the engine.)
ing⬙.
Oil Change Required — If Equipped
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal slowly three times
within 10 seconds.
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change
indicator system. The Oil Change Required message will 3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
4
226 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you • Elapsed Time
start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not
• EVIC Units Selection
reset. If necessary repeat this procedure.
• System Status
EVIC Main Menu
To step to each main menu feature press and release the • Personal Settings
MENU button once for each step. A step from the last
item in the list will cause the first item in the feature list
to be displayed. The following features are in the Main
menu:
NOTE: For features in the EVIC that can be reset (Average Fuel Economy and Elapsed Time), the EVIC prompts
a reset with a SELECT button graphic and the word
RESET next to it.
• Compass
When the SELECT button is pressed, the selected feature
will reset and RESET ALL will display next to the
SELECT button graphic. Pressing SELECT a second time
will reset both Average Fuel Economy and Elapsed Time.
After three seconds without pressing SELECT, RESET
ALL will return to RESET and only the selected feature
will have been reset.
• Outside Temperature
• Audio Information (if radio is on) display
• Average Fuel Economy
• Distance to Empty
• Tire Pressure Status display
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 227
Compass Display
COMPASS Button
The compass heading indicates the direction
the vehicle is facing. Press and release the
compass button to display one of eight compass headings, the outside temperature, and
audio information (if the radio is on) if the EVIC display
is not already displaying this screen.
Automatic Compass Calibration
This compass is self-calibrating, which eliminates the
need to calibrate the compass manually. When the vehicle is new, the compass may appear erratic and the
EVIC will flash the “CAL” indicator until the compass is
calibrated. You may calibrate the compass by completing
one or more 360–degree turns (in an area free from large
metal or metallic objects) until the CAL indicator in the
EVIC turns off. The compass will now function normally.
NOTE: The system will display the last known outside NOTE: A good calibration requires a level surface and an
temperature when starting the vehicle and may need to environment free from large metallic objects such as buildbe driven several minutes before the updated tempera- ings, bridges, underground cables, railroad tracks, etc.
ture is displayed. Engine temperature can also affect the
displayed temperature; therefore, temperature readings
are not updated when the vehicle is not moving.
4
228 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Manual Compass Calibration
Compass Variance
If the compass appears erratic or inaccurate, and the vari- Compass Variance is the difference between Magnetic
ance has been properly set, you may wish to manually North and Geographic North. To compensate for the
recalibrate the compass. To manually calibrate the compass: differences, the variance should be set for the zone where
1. Start the engine. Leave the shift lever in PARK in order the vehicle is driven, per the zone map. Once properly
set, the compass will automatically compensate for the
to enter the EVIC Programming Menus.
differences and provide the most accurate compass head2. Press and release the MENU button until “Personal ing.
Settings” displays in the EVIC.
NOTE: Magnetic and battery powered devices, (such as
3. Press and release the DOWN button until “Calibrate cell phones, iPod’s, radar detectors, PDA’s and laptops)
Compass Yes” displays in the EVIC.
should be kept away from the top of the instrument
4. Press and release the SELECT button and the “CAL” panel. This is where the compass module is located and
such devices may interfere and cause false compass
indicator will start flashing.
readings.
5. Drive the vehicle slowly (under 5 mph / 8 km/h),
completing one or more circles (in an area free from
large metal or metallic objects) until the “CAL” indicator turns off. The compass will now function normally.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 229
3. Press and release the DOWN button until “Compass
Variance” and the current Variance Value displays in
the EVIC.
4. Press and release the SELECT button to increment the
Variance Value by one, (one button press per update),
until the proper variance zone is selected according to
the map.
NOTE: The Variance Values will wrap around from 15
back to 1. The Default Variance is Zone 8.
Average Fuel Economy
Shows the average fuel economy since the last reset.
Average Fuel Economy can be reset by pressing and
holding the SELECT button (as prompted in the EVIC
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Leave the
display). Upon reset, the history information will be
shift lever in PARK.
erased, and the averaging will continue from the last fuel
2. Press and release the MENU button until “Personal average reading before the reset.
Settings” displays in the EVIC.
Compass Variance Map
To Change Compass Variance:
4
230 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Distance To Empty (DTE)
Tire PSI
Shows the estimated distance that can be traveled with
the fuel remaining in the tank. This estimated distance is
determined by a weighted average of the instantaneous
and average fuel economy, according to the current fuel
tank level. DTE cannot be reset.
Press and release the MENU button until ⬙Tire PSI⬙ is
displayed.
Tire pressure information is displayed as follows:
• If tire pressure is OK for all tires, TIRE and a vehicle
graphic are displayed with tire pressure values in each
NOTE: Significant changes in driving style or vehicle
corner or the graphic.
loading will greatly affect the actual drivable distance of
• If one or more tires have low pressure, LOW TIRE,
the vehicle, regardless of the DTE display value.
⬙Inflate to XX” and a vehicle graphic are displayed
When the DTE value is less than 30 miles (48 km)
with tire pressure values in each corner of the graphic.
estimated driving distance, the DTE display will change
Tire pressure values that are too low will be flashing.
to a text display of ⬙LOW FUEL”. This display will
continue until the vehicle runs out of fuel. Adding a • If the Tire Pressure System requires service, ⬙Check
significant amount of fuel to the vehicle will turn off the
TPM System⬙ is displayed. Tire PSI is an information
LOW FUEL text and a new DTE value will display.
only function and cannot be reset.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 231
Elapsed Time
Pressure features. Press and Release the SELECT button
to toggle units between ⬙U.S.⬙ and ⬙METRIC⬙.
Shows the total elapsed time of travel since the last reset.
Elapsed time will increment when the ignition switch is System Status
in the RUN or START position.
Displays SYSTEM OK if there are no active Warning
Elapsed time is displayed as follows:
Messages stored. Pressing and releasing the DOWN
button when SYSTEM OK is displayed will do nothing.
• Hours
Displays SYSTEM WARNINGS PRESENT if there are
• Minutes
active Warning Messages stored. Pressing and releasing
the DOWN button when SYSTEM WARNINGS PRES• Seconds
ENT is displayed will display each stored warning for
Elapsed time can be reset by pressing and holding the each button press. Press and Release the MENU button to
SELECT button (as prompted in the EVIC display). Upon return to the Main Menu.
reset all digits will change to zeros and time will start
incrementing again if the ignition switch is in RUN or Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable
Features)
START.
Personal Settings allows the driver to set and recall
EVIC Units Selection (UNITS IN Display)
features when the automatic transaxle is in PARK.
Displays the units used for the Outside Temperature,
Average Fuel Economy, Distance to Empty and Tire
4
232 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Press and release the MENU button until “Personal RKE Unlock
Settings” displays in the EVIC.
When “Driver Door 1st Press” is selected, only the
Press and release the DOWN button to display the driver’s door will unlock on the first press of the Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter UNLOCK button. When
following programmable features:
Driver Door 1st Press is selected, you must press the RKE
Language
transmitter UNLOCK button twice to unlock the passenWhen in this display you may select different languages ger’s doors. When “All Doors 1st Press” is selected, all of
for all display nomenclature, including the trip functions. the doors will unlock on the first press of the RKE
Pressing the SELECT button while in this display selects transmitter UNLOCK button. To make your selection,
English, Spanish, French, German, Italian, or Dutch de- press and release the SELECT button until “Driver Door
pending on availability. As you continue, the displayed 1st Press” or “All Doors 1st Press” appears.
information will be shown in the selected language.
Sound Horn with Lock
Auto Unlock on Exit
When ON is selected, a short horn sound will occur when
When ON is selected and the transaxle is in the PARK or the RKE transmitter LOCK button is pressed. This feature
NEUTRAL position, all doors will unlock when the may be selected with or without the Flash Lamp with
driver’s door is opened. To make your selection, press the Lock feature. To make your selection, press and release
SELECT button until ON or OFF appears.
the SELECT button until ON or OFF appears.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 233
headlights will also turn off when the wipers are turned
off if they were turned on by this feature. To make your
When ON is selected, the front and rear turn signals will
selection, press the SELECT button until ON or OFF
flash when the doors are locked or unlocked with the
appears.
RKE transmitter. This feature may be selected with or
without the Sound Horn on lock feature selected. To NOTE: Turning the headlights on during the daytime
make your selection, press and release the SELECT causes the instrument panel lights to dim. To increase the
button until ON or OFF appears.
brightness, refer to “Lights” in “Understanding The
Features Of Your Vehicle.”
Headlamp Off Delay
When this feature is selected, the driver can choose to Key-Off Power Delay
Flash Lamp with Lock
have the headlights remain on for 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds When this feature is selected, the power window
when exiting the vehicle. To make your selection, press switches, radio, Uconnect® phone (if equipped), and
the SELECT button until 0, 30, 60, or 90 seconds appears. power outlets will remain active for up to 10 minutes
after the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK position.
Headlamps With Wipers (Available with Auto
Opening either front vehicle door will cancel this feature.
Headlights Only)
To make your selection, press the SELECT button until
When ON is selected, and the headlight switch is in the Off, 45 sec., 5 min., or 10 min. appears.
AUTO position, the headlights will turn on approximately 10 seconds after the wipers are turned on. The
4
234 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Illumin. Approach
SETTING THE ANALOG CLOCK
When this feature is selected, the headlights will activate
and remain on for up to 90 seconds when the doors are
unlocked with the remote keyless entry transmitter. To
make your selection, press the SELECT button until
“OFF,” “30 sec,” “60 sec,” or “90 sec” appears.
To set the analog clock, located at the top center of the
instrument panel, press and hold the button in until the
setting is correct. The clock will adjust slowly at first and
then quicker the longer the button is held.
Display Units In
The EVIC and odometer can be changed between English
and Metric units of measure. To make your selection,
press and release the SELECT button until “U.S.” or
“METRIC” appears.
Compass Variance
Refer to “Compass Display” for more information.
Calibrate Compass
Refer to “Compass Display” for more information.
Setting The Analog Clock
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 235
Uconnect® 730N/430/430N CD/DVD/HDD/NAV —
IF EQUIPPED
Uconnect® 130
Refer to your Uconnect® Supplement Manual for detailed operating instructions.
Operating Instructions (Voice Command System)
— If Equipped
4
Refer to “Voice Command” for further details.
Operating Instructions (Uconnect® Phone) — If
Equipped
Refer to “Uconnect® Phone” for further details.
Uconnect® 130
Operating Instructions — Radio Mode
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC
position to operate the radio.
236 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Power Switch/Volume Control (Rotary)
another selection. Holding either button will bypass
stations without stopping, until you release it.
Push the ON/VOLUME control knob to turn on the
radio. Push the ON/VOLUME control knob a second TIME Button
time to turn off the radio.
Press the TIME button to alternate display of the time
and radio frequency.
Electronic Volume Control
The electronic volume control turns continuously (360 Clock Setting Procedure
degrees) in either direction, without stopping. Turning
1. Press and hold the TIME button until the hours blink.
the ON/VOLUME control knob to the right increases the
volume, and to the left decreases it.
2. Adjust the hours by turning the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob.
When the audio system is turned on, the sound will be
set at the same volume level as last played.
3. After adjusting the hours, press the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob to set the minutes. The minutes
SEEK Buttons
will begin to blink.
Press and release the SEEK buttons to search for the next
listenable station in AM/FM mode. Press the right switch 4. Adjust the minutes using the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob. Press the TUNE/SCROLL conto seek up and the left switch to seek down. The radio
trol knob to save time change.
will remain tuned to the new station until you make
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 237
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a second
time and MID will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL
RW/FF
control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
Pressing the RW (Rewind) or FF (Fast Forward) buttons mid-range tones.
causes the tuner to search for the next frequency in the
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a third
direction of the arrows. This feature operates in either
time and TREBLE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL
AM or FM frequencies.
control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
TUNE Control
treble tones.
5. To exit, press any button/knob, or wait five seconds.
Turn the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob clockwise Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fourth
to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the frequency. time and BALANCE will display. Turn the TUNE/
SCROLL control knob to the right or left to adjust the
Setting the Tone, Balance, and Fade
sound level from the right or left side speakers.
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob and BASS
will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fifth time
and FADE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control
the right or left to increase or decrease the bass tones.
knob to the left or right to adjust the sound level between
the front and rear speakers.
4
238 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob again to display window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and
SET 2 in both AM and FM. This allows a total of 12 AM
exit setting tone, balance, and fade.
and 12 FM stations to be stored into pushbutton memory.
AM/FM Button
The stations stored in SET 2 memory can be selected by
Press the buttons to select either AM or FM mode.
pressing the pushbutton twice.
SET/RND Button — To Set the Pushbutton
Memory
Every time a preset button is used, a corresponding
button number will display.
When you are receiving a station that you wish to
commit to pushbutton memory, press the SET/RND
button. The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display
window. Select the button (1 to 6) you wish to lock onto
this station and press and release that button. If a button
is not selected within five seconds after pressing the
SET/RND button, the station will continue to play but
will not be stored into pushbutton memory.
Buttons 1 - 6
You may add a second station to each pushbutton by
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press
the SET/RND button twice and SET 2 will show in the
These buttons tune the radio to the stations that you
commit to pushbutton memory (12 AM and 12 FM
stations).
DISC Button
Pressing the DISC button will allow you to switch from
AM/FM modes to Disc modes.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 239
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio
ON, the unit will switch from radio to CD mode and
begin to play when you insert the disc. The display will
NOTE:
show the track number, and index time in minutes and
• The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC position seconds. Play will begin at the start of track 1.
to operate the radio.
Operation Instructions — CD MODE For CD And
MP3 Audio Play
• This radio is capable of playing compact discs (CD),
recordable compact discs (CD-R), rewritable compact
discs (CD-RW), compact discs with MP3 tracks and
multisession compact discs with CD and MP3 tracks.
Inserting Compact Disc(s)
Gently insert one CD into the CD player with the CD
label facing up. The CD will automatically be pulled into
the CD player and the CD icon will illuminate on the
radio display. If a CD does not go into the slot more than
1.0 in (2.5 cm), a disc may already be loaded and must be
ejected before a new disc can be loaded.
CAUTION!
• This CD player will accept 4–3/4 in (12 cm) discs
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the
CD player mechanism.
• Do not use adhesive labels. These labels can peel
away and jam the player mechanism.
• The Uconnect® 130 is a single CD player. Do not
attempt to insert a second CD if one is already
loaded.
(Continued)
4
240 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Dual-media disc types (one side is a DVD, the
other side is a CD) should not be used, and they can
cause damage to the player.
EJECT Button - Ejecting a CD
Press the EJECT button to eject the CD.
SEEK Button
Press the right SEEK button for the next selection on the
CD. Press the left SEEK button to return to the beginning
of the current selection, or return to the beginning of the
previous selection if the CD is within the first second of
the current selection. Pressing and holding the SEEK
button will allow faster scrolling through the tracks in
CD and MP3 modes.
TIME Button
Press this button to change the display from a large CD
If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within playing time display to a small CD playing time display.
10 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,
RW/FF
the radio will reinsert the CD but will not play it.
Press and hold the FF (Fast Forward) button and the CD
A disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.
player will begin to fast forward until FF is released, or
NOTE: Ejecting with the ignition OFF is not allowed on RW or another CD button is pressed. The RW (Reverse)
convertible or soft-top models (if equipped).
button works in a similar manner.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 241
AM/FM Button
Supported Media (Disc Types)
Press the button to select either AM or FM mode.
The MP3 file recording media supported by the radio are
CDDA, CD-R, CD-RW, MP3, and CDDA+MP3.
SET/RND Button (Random Play Button)
Supported Medium Formats (File Systems)
Press this button while the CD is playing to activate
Random Play. This feature plays the selections on the The medium formats supported by the radio are ISO 9660
compact disc in random order to provide an interesting Level 1 and Level 2 and includes the Joliet extension.
change of pace.
When reading discs recorded using formats other than
ISO 9660 Level 1 and Level 2, the radio may fail to read
Press the right SEEK button to move to the next ranfiles properly and may be unable to play the file nordomly selected track.
mally. UDF and Apple HFS formats are not supported.
Press the RND button a second time to stop Random
The radio uses the following limits for file systems:
Play.
• Maximum number of folder levels: 8
Notes on Playing MP3 Files
The radio can play MP3 files; however, acceptable MP3 • Maximum number of files: 255
file recording media and formats are limited. When • Maximum number of folders. (The radio display of file
writing MP3 files, pay attention to the following restricnames and folder names is limited. For large numbers of
tions.
files and/or folders, the radio may be unable to display
4
242 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
the file name and folder name, and will assign a number Supported MP3 File Formats
instead. With a maximum number of files, exceeding 20
The radio will recognize only files with the *.MP3 extenfolders will result in this display. With 200 files, exceedsion as MP3 files. Non-MP3 files named with the *.MP3
ing 50 folders will result in this display.)
extension may cause playback problems. The radio is
• Maximum number of characters in file/folder names: designed to recognize the file as an invalid MP3 and will
• Level 1: 12 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a three- not play the file.
character extension)
When using the MP3 encoder to compress audio data to
• Level 2: 31 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a three- an MP3 file, the bit rate and sampling frequencies in the
character extension)
following table are supported. In addition, variable bit
Multisession disc formats are supported by the radio. rates (VBR) are also supported. The majority of MP3 files
Multisession discs may contain combinations of normal use a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and a 192, 160, 128, 96 or
CD audio tracks and computer files (including MP3 files). VBR bit rate.
Discs created with an option such as ⬙keep disc open after
writing⬙ are most likely multisession discs. The use of
multisession for CD audio or MP3 playback may result in
longer disc loading times.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 243
MPEG
Specification
MPEG-1 Audio
Layer 3
Sampling Frequency (kHz)
48, 44.1, 32
MPEG-2 Audio
Layer 3
24, 22.05, 16
Bit Rate (kbps)
320, 256, 224,
192, 160, 128,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32
160, 128, 144,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32,
24, 16, 8
Playback of MP3 Files
When a medium containing MP3 data is loaded, the radio
checks all files on the medium. If the medium contains a lot
of folders or files, the radio will take more time to start
playing the MP3 files.
Loading times for playback of MP3 files may be affected
by the following:
• Media - CD-RW media may take longer to load than
CD-R media
• Medium formats - Multisession discs may take longer
ID3 Tag information for artist, song title, and album title
to load than non-multisession discs
are supported for version 1 ID3 tags. ID3 version 2 is not
• Number of files and folders - Loading times will
supported by the radios.
increase with more files and folders
Playlist files are not supported. MP3 Pro files are not
To increase the speed of disc loading, it is recommended
supported.
to use CD-R media and single-session discs. To create a
single-session disc, enable the “Disc at Once” option
before writing to the disc.
4
244 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Operation Instructions - Auxiliary Mode
Uconnect® 130 WITH SATELLITE RADIO
The auxiliary (AUX) jack is an audio input jack, which
allows the user to plug in a portable device, such as an
MP3 player, or iPod®, and utilize the vehicle’s audio
system to amplify the source and play through the
vehicle speakers.
Pressing the DISC/AUX button will change the mode to
auxiliary device if the AUX jack is connected.
NOTE: The AUX device must be turned on and the
device’s volume set to proper level. If the AUX audio is
not loud enough, turn the device’s volume up. If the AUX
audio sounds distorted, turn the device’s volume down.
Uconnect® 130
TIME Button (Auxiliary Mode)
Press this button to change the display to time of day. The Operating Instructions — Radio Mode
time of day will display for five seconds (when ignition is NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC
OFF).
position to operate the radio.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 245
Power Switch/Volume Control (Rotary)
another selection. Holding either button will bypass
stations without stopping, until you release it.
Push the ON/VOLUME control knob to turn on the
radio. Push the ON/VOLUME control knob a second Voice Command System (Radio) — If Equipped
time to turn off the radio.
Refer to “Voice Command” in “Understanding The Features If Your Vehicle.”
Electronic Volume Control
The electronic volume control turns continuously (360 Voice Command Button Uconnect® Phone — If
degrees) in either direction, without stopping. Turning Equipped
the ON/VOLUME control knob to the right increases the
Press this button to operate the Uconnect® Phone feature
volume, and to the left decreases it.
(if equipped). Refer to “Uconnect® Phone” in “UnderWhen the audio system is turned on, the sound will be standing The Features If Your Vehicle.”
set at the same volume level as last played.
If your vehicle is not equipped with or this feature is not
SEEK Buttons
available on your vehicle, a “Not Equipped With
Press and release the SEEK buttons to search for the next Uconnect Phone” message will display on the radio
listenable station in AM/FM mode. Press the right switch screen.
to seek up and the left switch to seek down. The radio
will remain tuned to the new station until you make
4
246 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
3. After adjusting the hours, press the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob to set the minutes. The minutes
Press this button to operate the Uconnect® Phone feature
will begin to blink.
(if equipped). Refer to “Uconnect® Phone” in “Understanding The Features Of Your Vehicle.”
4. Adjust the minutes using the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob. Press the TUNE/SCROLL conIf your vehicle is not equipped with or this feature is not
trol knob to save time change.
available on your vehicle, a “Not Equipped With
Uconnect Phone” message will display on the radio 5. To exit, press any button/knob or wait five seconds.
screen.
The clock can also be set by pressing the SETUP button.
For vehicles equipped with satellite radio, press the
TIME Button
SETUP button, use the TUNE/SCROLL control to select
Press the TIME button to alternate display of the time
SET CLOCK, and then follow the above procedure,
and radio frequency.
starting at Step 2. For vehicles not equipped with satellite
Clock Setting Procedure
radio, press the SETUP button and then follow the above
procedure, starting at Step 2.
1. Press and hold the TIME button until the hours blink.
Phone Button Uconnect® Phone — If Equipped
2. Adjust the hours by turning the right side TUNE/
SCROLL control knob.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 247
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a second
time and MID will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL
Press the INFO button for an RDS station (one with call
control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
letters displayed). The radio will return a Radio Text
mid-range tones.
message broadcast from an FM station (FM mode only).
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a third
RW/FF
time and TREBLE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL
Pressing the RW (Rewind) or FF (Fast Forward) buttons control knob to the right or left to increase or decrease the
causes the tuner to search for the next frequency in the treble tones.
direction of the arrows. This feature operates in either
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fourth
AM or FM frequencies.
time and BALANCE will display. Turn the TUNE/
TUNE Control
SCROLL control knob to the right or left to adjust the
Turn the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob clockwise sound level from the right or left side speakers.
INFO Button
to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the frequency. Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob a fifth time
and FADE will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control
Setting the Tone, Balance, and Fade
knob to the left or right to adjust the sound level between
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob and BASS the front and rear speakers.
will display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to
the right or left to increase or decrease the bass tones.
4
248 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Push the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob again to
exit setting tone, balance, and fade.
MUSIC TYPE Button
Pressing this button once will turn on the Music Type
mode for five seconds. Pressing the MUSIC TYPE button
or turning the TUNE/SCROLL control knob within five
seconds will allow the program format type to be selected. Many radio stations do not currently broadcast
Music Type information.
Toggle the MUSIC TYPE button to select the following
format types:
Program Type
No program type or undefined
Adult Hits
16-Digit Character
Display
None
Adlt Hit
Program Type
Classical
Classic Rock
College
Country
Foreign Language
Information
Jazz
News
Nostalgia
Oldies
Personality
Public
Rhythm and Blues
Religious Music
16-Digit Character
Display
Classicl
Cls Rock
College
Country
Language
Inform
Jazz
News
Nostalga
Oldies
Persnlty
Public
R&B
Rel Musc
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 249
Program Type
Religious Talk
Rock
Soft
Soft Rock
Soft Rhythm and Blues
Sports
Talk
Top 40
Weather
16-Digit Character
Display
Rel Talk
Rock
Soft
Soft Rck
Soft R&B
Sports
Talk
Top 40
Weather
If a preset button is activated while in the Music Type
(Program Type) mode, the Music Type mode will be
exited and the radio will tune to the preset station.
SETUP Button
Pressing the SETUP button allows you to select between
the following items:
• Set Clock — Pressing the SELECT button will allow
you to set the clock. Adjust the hours by turning the
TUNE/SCROLL control knob. After adjusting the
hours, press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to set
the minutes. The minutes will begin to blink. Adjust
the minutes using the right side TUNE/SCROLL control knob. Press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob to
By pressing the SEEK button when the Music Type icon
save time change.
is displayed, the radio will be tuned to the next frequency
station with the same selected Music Type name. The AM/FM Button
Music Type function only operates when in the FM
Press the button to select either AM or FM mode.
mode.
4
250 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
SET/RND Button — To Set the Pushbutton
Memory
Every time a preset button is used, a corresponding
button number will display.
When you are receiving a station that you wish to
commit to pushbutton memory, press the SET/RND
button. The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display
window. Select the button (1–6) you wish to lock onto this
station and press and release that button. If a button is
not selected within five seconds after pressing the SET/
RND button, the station will continue to play but will not
be stored into pushbutton memory.
Buttons 1 - 6
You may add a second station to each pushbutton by
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press
the SET/RND button twice and SET 2 will show in the
display window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and
SET 2 in both AM and FM. This allows a total of 12 AM
and 12 FM stations to be stored into pushbutton memory.
The stations stored in SET 2 memory can be selected by
pressing the pushbutton twice.
These buttons tune the radio to the stations that you
commit to pushbutton memory (12 AM and 12 FM
stations).
DISC/AUX Button
Pressing the DISC/AUX button will allow you to switch
from AM/FM modes to DISC/AUX mode.
Operation Instructions — CD MODE for CD and
MP3 Audio Play
NOTE:
• The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC position
to operate the radio.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 251
• This radio is capable of playing compact discs (CD),
recordable compact discs (CD-R), rewritable compact
discs (CD-RW), compact discs with MP3 tracks and
multisession compact discs with CD and MP3 tracks.
Inserting Compact Disc(s)
Gently insert one CD into the CD player with the CD
label facing up. The CD will automatically be pulled into
the CD player and the CD icon will illuminate on the
radio display. If a CD does not go into the slot more than
1.0 in (2.5 cm), a disc may already be loaded and must be
ejected before a new disc can be loaded.
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio
ON, the unit will switch from radio to CD mode and
begin to play when you insert the disc. The display will
show the track number, and index time in minutes and
seconds. Play will begin at the start of track 1.
CAUTION!
• This CD player will accept 4–3/4 in (12 cm) discs
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the
CD player mechanism.
• Do not use adhesive labels. These labels can peel
away and jam the player mechanism.
• The Uconnect® 130 is a single CD player. Do not
attempt to insert a second CD if one is already
loaded.
• Dual-media disc types (one side is a DVD, the
other side is a CD) should not be used, and they can
cause damage to the player.
4
252 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
EJECT Button - Ejecting a CD
Press the EJECT button to eject the CD.
the current selection. Pressing and holding the SEEK
button will allow faster scrolling through the tracks in
CD and MP3 modes.
TIME Button
Press this button to change the display from a large CD
If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within playing time display to a small CD playing time display.
10 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,
RW/FF
the radio will reinsert the CD but will not play it.
Press and hold FF (Fast Forward) and the CD player will
A disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.
begin to fast forward until FF is released or RW or
NOTE: Ejecting with the ignition OFF is not allowed on another CD button is pressed. The RW (Reverse) button
convertible or soft-top models (if equipped).
works in a similar manner.
SEEK Button
AM/FM Button
Press the right SEEK button for the next selection on the Press the button to select either AM or FM mode.
CD. Press the left SEEK button to return to the beginning
of the current selection, or return to the beginning of the
previous selection if the CD is within the first second of
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 253
SET/RND Button (Random Play Button)
Supported Media (Disc Types)
Press this button while the CD is playing to activate The MP3 file recording media supported by the radio are
Random Play. This feature plays the selections on the CDDA, CD-R, CD-RW, MP3, and CDDA+MP3.
compact disc in random order to provide an interesting
Supported Medium Formats (File Systems)
change of pace.
The medium formats supported by the radio are ISO 9660
Press the right SEEK button to move to the next ran- Level 1 and Level 2 and includes the Joliet extension.
domly selected track.
When reading discs recorded using formats other than
Press the SET/RND button a second time to stop Ran- ISO 9660 Level 1 and Level 2, the radio may fail to read
files properly and may be unable to play the file nordom Play.
mally. UDF and Apple HFS formats are not supported.
Notes On Playing MP3 Files
The radio uses the following limits for file systems:
The radio can play MP3 files; however, acceptable MP3
file recording media and formats are limited. When • Maximum number of folder levels: 8
writing MP3 files, pay attention to the following restric• Maximum number of files: 255
tions.
• Maximum number of folders. (The radio display of file
names and folder names is limited. For large numbers
of files and/or folders, the radio may be unable to
4
254 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
display the file name and folder name, and will assign
a number instead. With a maximum number of files,
exceeding 20 folders will result in this display. With
200 files, exceeding 50 folders will result in this display.)
• Maximum number of characters in file/folder names:
• Level 1: 12 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a threecharacter extension)
• Level 2: 31 (including a separator ⬙.⬙ and a threecharacter extension)
Supported MP3 File Formats
The radio will recognize only files with the *.MP3 extension as MP3 files. Non-MP3 files named with the *.MP3
extension may cause playback problems. The radio is
designed to recognize the file as an invalid MP3 and will
not play the file.
When using the MP3 encoder to compress audio data to
an MP3 file, the bit rate and sampling frequencies in the
following table are supported. In addition, variable bit
rates (VBR) are also supported. The majority of MP3 files
use a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and a 192, 160, 128, 96 or
Multisession disc formats are supported by the radio.
VBR bit rates.
Multisession discs may contain combinations of normal
CD audio tracks and computer files (including MP3 files).
Discs created with an option such as ⬙keep disc open after
writing⬙ are most likely multisession discs. The use of
multisession for CD audio or MP3 playback may result in
longer disc loading times.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 255
MPEG
Specification
MPEG-1 Audio
Layer 3
Sampling Frequency (kHz)
48, 44.1, 32
MPEG-2 Audio
Layer 3
24, 22.05, 16
Bit Rate (kbps)
320, 256, 224,
192, 160, 128,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32
160, 128, 144,
112, 96, 80, 64,
56, 48, 40, 32,
24, 16, 8
Playback of MP3 Files
When a medium containing MP3 data is loaded, the
radio checks all files on the medium. If the medium
contains a lot of folders or files, the radio will take more
time to start playing the MP3 files.
Loading times for playback of MP3 files may be affected
by the following:
• Media - CD-RW media may take longer to load than
CD-R media
ID3 Tag information for artist, song title, and album title • Medium formats - Multisession discs may take longer
to load than non-multisession discs
are supported for version 1 ID3 tags. ID3 version 2 is not
supported by the radios.
• Number of files and folders - Loading times will
increase with more files and folders
Playlist files are not supported. MP3 Pro files are not
supported.
4
256 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
To increase the speed of disc loading, it is recommended
to use CD-R media and single-session discs. To create a
single-session disc, enable the “Disc at Once” option
before writing to the disc.
Press the INFO button once more to return to ⬙elapsed
time⬙ priority mode.
LIST Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play)
Press and hold the INFO button again for three seconds
to return to ⬙elapsed time⬙ display.
Pressing the LIST button will bring up a list of all folders
on the disc. Scrolling up or down the list is done by
turning the TUNE/SCROLL control knob. Selecting a
folder by pressing the TUNE/SCROLL control knob will
begin playing the files contained in that folder (or the
next folder in sequence if the selection does not contain
playable files).
The folder list will time out after five seconds.
INFO Button (CD Mode for MP3 Play)
Pressing the INFO button repeatedly will scroll through
the following TAG information: Song Title, Artist, File
Name, and Folder Name (if available).
Press and hold the INFO button for three seconds or
more and the radio will display song titles for each file.
Operation Instructions - Auxiliary Mode
The auxiliary (AUX) jack is an audio input jack which
allows the user to plug in a portable device such as an
MP3 player or iPod® and utilize the vehicle’s audio
system to amplify the source and play through the
vehicle speakers.
Pressing the AUX button will change the mode to auxiliary device if the AUX jack is connected.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 257
NOTE: The AUX device must be turned on and the
device’s volume set to the proper level. If the AUX audio
is not loud enough, turn the device’s volume up. If the
AUX audio sounds distorted, turn the device’s volume
down.
NOTE: Sirius service is not available in Hawaii and has
limited coverage in Alaska.
System Activation
Sirius Satellite Radio service is pre-activated, and you may
begin listening immediately to the one year of audio service
TIME Button (Auxiliary Mode)
that is included with the factory-installed satellite radio
Press this button to change the display to time of day. The system in your vehicle. Sirius will supply a welcome kit that
time of day will display for five seconds (when the contains general information, including how to setup your
on-line listening account. For further information, call the
ignition is OFF).
toll-free number 888-539-7474, or visit the Sirius web site at
Uconnect® (Satellite Radio) — If Equipped
www.sirius.com, or at www.siriuscanada.ca for Canadian
residents.
Satellite radio uses direct satellite-to-receiver broadcasting technology to provide clear digital sound, coast to Electronic Serial Number/Sirius Identification
coast. The subscription service provider is Sirius Satellite Number (ESN/SID)
Radio. This service offers over 130 channels of music,
Please have the following information available when
sports, news, entertainment, and programming for chilcalling:
dren, directly from its satellites and broadcasting studios.
1. The Electronic Serial Number/Sirius Identification
Number (ESN/SID).
4
258 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
2. Your Vehicle Identification Number.
Satellite Antenna
To access the ESN/SID, refer to the following steps:
To ensure optimum reception, do not place items on the
roof around the rooftop antenna location. Metal objects
placed within the line of sight of the antenna will cause
decreased performance. Larger luggage items such as
bikes should be placed as far rearward as possible, within
the loading design of the rack. Do not place items directly
on or above the antenna.
ESN/SID Access
With the ignition switch in the ON/RUN or ACC position and the radio on, press the SETUP button and scroll
using the TUNE/SCROLL control knob until Sirius ID is
selected. Press the TUNE/SCROLL control knob and the
Sirius ID number will display. The Sirius ID number
Reception Quality
display will time out in two minutes. Press any button on
Satellite reception may be interrupted due to one of the
the radio to exit this screen.
following reasons:
Selecting Uconnect® (Satellite) Mode
• The vehicle is parked in an underground parking
Press the SAT button until ⬙SAT⬙ appears in the display. A
structure or under a physical obstacle.
CD may remain in the radio while in the Satellite radio
mode.
• Dense tree coverage may interrupt reception in the
form of short audio mutes.
• Driving under wide bridges or along tall buildings can
cause intermittent reception.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 259
• Placing objects over or too close to the antenna can SCAN Button
cause signal blockage.
Pressing the SCAN button causes the tuner to search for
the next channel, pausing for eight seconds before conOperating Instructions - Uconnect® (Satellite)
tinuing to the next. To stop the search, press the SCAN
Mode
button a second time.
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON/RUN or
INFO Button
ACC position to operate the radio.
SEEK Buttons
Pressing the INFO button will cycle the display information between Artist, Song Title, and Composer (if available). Also, pressing and holding the INFO button for an
additional three seconds will make the radio display the
Song Title all of the time (press and hold again to return
to normal display).
Press and release the SEEK buttons to search for the next
channel in Satellite mode. Press the right switch to seek
up and the left switch to seek down. The radio will
remain tuned to the new channel until you make another
selection. Holding either button will bypass channels
RW/FF
without stopping until you release it.
Pressing the RW (Rewind) or FF (Fast Forward) buttons
causes the tuner to search for the next channel in the
direction of the arrows.
4
260 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
TUNE Control (Rotary)
SETUP Button
Turn the rotary TUNE/SCROLL control knob clockwise Pressing the SETUP button allows you to select the
to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the channel. following items:
• Display Sirius ID number — Press the AUDIO/
SELECT button to display the Sirius ID number. This
Pressing this button once will turn on the Music Type
number is used to activate, deactivate, or change the
mode for five seconds. Pressing the MUSIC TYPE button
Sirius subscription.
or turning the TUNE/SCROLL control knob within five
seconds will allow the program format type to be se- SET Button – To Set the Pushbutton Memory
lected.
When you are receiving a channel that you wish to
Toggle the MUSIC TYPE button again to select the music commit to pushbutton memory, press the SET button.
The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display window.
type.
Select the button (1-6) you wish to lock onto this channel
By pressing the SEEK button when the Music Type
and press and release that button. If a button is not
function is active, the radio will be tuned to the next
selected within five seconds after pressing the SET butchannel with the same selected Music Type name.
ton, the channel will continue to play but will not be
If a preset button is activated while in the Music Type stored into pushbutton memory.
(Program Type) mode, the Music Type mode will be
exited and the radio will tune to the preset channel.
MUSIC TYPE Button
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 261
You may add a second channel to each pushbutton by
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press
the SET button twice and SET 2 will show in the display
window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and SET 2. This
allows a total of 12 Satellite channels to be stored into
pushbutton memory. The channels stored in SET 2
memory can be selected by pressing the pushbutton
twice.
iPod®/USB/MP3 CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
This feature allows an iPod® or external USB device to be
plugged into the USB port, located in the center of the
instrument panel below the climate controls.
iPod® control supports Mini, 4G, Photo, Nano, 5G iPod®
and iPhone® devices. Some iPod® software versions
may not fully support the iPod® control features. Please
visit Apple’s website for software updates.
Every time a preset button is used, a corresponding
NOTE:
button number will display.
• If the radio has a USB port, refer to the appropriate
Uconnect® Multimedia radio User’s Manual for
These buttons tune the radio to the channels that you
iPod® or external USB device support capability.
commit to pushbutton memory (12 Satellite stations).
• Connecting an iPod® or consumer electronic audio
Operating Instructions - Uconnect® Phone (If
device to the AUX port located in the radio faceplate,
Equipped)
plays media, but does not use the iPod® /MP3 control
Refer to “Uconnect® Phone” in “Understanding The
feature to control the connected device.
Features Of Your Vehicle.”
Buttons 1 - 6
4
262 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Once the audio device is connected and synchronized to
Use the connection cable to connect an iPod® or external the vehicle’s iPod®/USB/MP3 control system (iPod® or
USB device to the vehicle’s USB connector port which is external USB device may take a few minutes to connect),
the audio device starts charging and is ready for use by
located in the center of the instrument panel below the
pressing radio switches, as described below.
climate controls.
Connecting The iPod® Or External USB Device
NOTE: If the audio device battery is completely discharged, it may not communicate with the iPod®/USB/
MP3 control system until a minimum charge is attained.
Leaving the audio device connected to the iPod®/USB/
MP3 control system may charge it to the required level.
Using This Feature
By using an iPod® cable, or an external USB device to
connect to the USB port:
USB Connector Port
• The audio device can be played on the vehicle’s sound
system, providing metadata (artist, track title, album,
etc.) information on the radio display.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 263
• The audio device can be controlled using the radio mode. In Play mode, the following buttons on the radio
buttons to Play, Browse, and List the iPod® contents. faceplate may be used to control the iPod® or external
USB device and display data:
• The audio device battery charges when plugged into
the USB/AUX connector (if supported by the specific • Use the TUNE control knob to select the next or
previous track.
audio device).
•
Turning it clockwise (forward) by one click, while
Controlling The iPod® Or External USB Device
playing a track, skips to the next track or press the
Using Radio Buttons
VR button and say ⬙Next Track.⬙
To get into the iPod®/USB/MP3 control mode and
• Turning it counterclockwise (backward) by one click,
access a connected audio device, either press the “AUX”
will jump to the previous track in the list or press the
button on the radio faceplate or press the VR button and
VR button and say ⬙Previous Track.⬙
say ⬙USB⬙ or ⬙Switch to USB.⬙ Once in the iPod®/USB/
MP3 control mode, audio tracks (if available from audio • Jump backward in the current track by pressing and
holding the << RW button. Holding the << RW button
device) start playing over the vehicle’s audio system.
long enough will jump to the beginning of the current
Play Mode
track.
When switched to iPod®/USB/MP3 control mode, the
• Jump forward in the current track by pressing and
iPod® or external USB device automatically starts Play
holding the FF>> button.
4
264 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• A single press backward << RW or forward FF>> will • Press the SCAN button to use iPod®/USB/MP3 dejump backward or forward respectively, for five secvice scan mode, which will play the first 10 seconds of
each track in the current list and then forward to the
onds.
next song. To stop SCAN mode and start playing the
• Use the << SEEK and SEEK>> buttons to jump to the
desired track, when it is playing the track, press the
previous or next track. Pressing the SEEK>> button
SCAN button again. During Scan mode, pressing the
during play mode will jump to the next track in the
<< SEEK and SEEK>> buttons will select the previous
list, or press the VR button and say ⬙Next or Previous
and next tracks.
Track.⬙
• RND button (available on sales code RES radio only):
• While a track is playing, press the INFO button to see
Pressing this button toggles between Shuffle ON and
the associated metadata (artist, track title, album, etc.)
Shuffle OFF modes for the iPod® or external USB
for that track. Pressing the INFO button again jumps
device, or press the VR button and say ⬙Shuffle ON⬙ or
to the next screen of data for that track. Once all
⬙Shuffle Off.⬙ If the RND icon is showing on the radio
screens have been viewed, the last INFO button press
display, then the shuffle mode is ON.
will go back to the play mode screen on the radio.
• Pressing the REPEAT button will change the audio
device mode to repeat the current playing track or
press the VR button and say ⬙Repeat ON⬙ or ⬙Repeat
Off.⬙
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 265
List Or Browse Mode
During Play mode, pressing any of the buttons described
below, will bring up List mode. List mode enables
scrolling through the list of menus and tracks on the
audio device.
• TUNE control knob: The TUNE control knob functions
in a similar manner as the scroll wheel on the audio
device or external USB device.
• Turning it clockwise (forward) and counterclockwise
(backward) scrolls through the lists, displaying the
track detail on the radio display. Once the track to be
played is highlighted on the radio display, press the
TUNE control knob to select and start playing the
track. Turning the TUNE control knob fast will scroll
through the list faster. During fast scroll, a slight
delay in updating the information on the radio
display may be noticeable.
• During all List modes, the iPod® displays all lists in
“wrap-around” mode. So if the track is at the bottom
of the list, just turn the wheel backward (counterclockwise) to get to the track faster.
• In List mode, the radio PRESET buttons are used as
shortcuts to the following lists on the iPod® or
external USB device.
• Preset 1 – Playlists
• Preset 2 – Artists
• Preset 3 – Albums
• Preset 4 – Genres
• Preset 5 – Audiobooks
• Preset 6 – Podcasts
• Pressing a PRESET button will display the current
list on the top line and the first item in that list on the
second line.
4
266 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• To exit List mode without selecting a track, press the
same PRESET button again to go back to Play mode.
• LIST button: The LIST button will display the top
level menu of the iPod® or external USB device. Turn
the TUNE control knob to list the top-menu item to be
selected and press the TUNE control knob. This will
display the next sub-menu list item on the audio
device, then follow the same steps to go to the desired
track in that list. Not all iPod® or external USB device
sub-menu levels are available on this system.
• MUSIC TYPE button: The MUSIC TYPE button is
another shortcut button to the genre listing on your
audio device.
CAUTION!
• Leaving the iPod® or external USB device (or any
supported device) anywhere in the vehicle in extreme heat or cold can alter the operation or damage the device. Follow the device manufacturer’s
guidelines.
• Placing items on the iPod® or external USB device,
or connections to the iPod® or external USB device
in the vehicle, can cause damage to the device
and/or to the connectors.
WARNING!
Do not plug in or remove the iPod® or external USB
device while driving. Failure to follow this warning
could result in an accident.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 267
2. After the ⬙Ready⬙ prompt and following the beep, say
⬙Setup⬙, then say ⬙Select Audio Devices.⬙
Music can be streamed from your cellular phone to the
Uconnect® phone system.
3. Say the name of the audio device or ask the
Uconnect® phone system to list the audio devices.
Controlling BTSA Using Radio Buttons
To enter BTSA mode, press either “AUX” button on the Next Track
Bluetooth Streaming Audio (BTSA)
radio or press the VR button and say “Bluetooth Stream- Use the SEEK UP button, or press the VR button on the
ing Audio.”
radio and say “Next Track,” to jump to the next music
track on your cellular phone.
Play Mode
When switched to BTSA mode, some audio devices can
start playing music over the vehicle’s audio system, but
some devices require the music to be initiated on the device
first, then it will get streamed to the Uconnect® phone
system. Seven devices can be paired to the Uconnect®
phone system, but just one can be selected and played.
Previous Track
Selecting A Different Audio Device
Browsing is not available on a Bluetooth Streaming
Audio (BTSA) device. Only the current song that is
playing will display info.
1. Press the PHONE button to begin.
Use the SEEK DOWN button, or press the VR button on
the radio and say “Previous Track,” to jump to the
previous music track on your cellular phone.
Browse
4
268 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS — IF
EQUIPPED
The right-hand rocker switch has a pushbutton in the
center, and controls the volume and mode of the sound
system. Pressing the top of the rocker switch will increase
the volume. Pressing the bottom of the rocker switch will
decrease the volume. Pressing the center button changes
the operation of the radio from AM to FM, or to CD
mode, depending on which radio is in the vehicle.
The left-hand rocker switch has a pushbutton in the
center. The function of the left-hand switch is different,
depending on which mode you are in.
The following describes the left-hand rocker switch operation in each mode.
Radio Operation
Remote Sound System Controls
(Back View Of Steering Wheel)
Pressing the top of the switch will SEEK up for the next
listenable station, and pressing the bottom of the switch
The remote sound system controls are located on the rear will SEEK down for the next listenable station.
surface of the steering wheel, at the three and nine
o’clock positions.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 269
The button located in the center of the left-hand switch CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE
will tune to the next preset station that you have pro- To keep a CD/DVD in good condition, take the following
grammed in the radio preset pushbutton.
precautions:
CD Player
1. Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching the
Pressing the top of the switch once will go to the next
surface.
track on the CD. Pressing the bottom of the switch once
2. If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth,
will go to the beginning of the current track, or to the
wiping from center to edge.
beginning of the previous track if it is within one second
after the current track begins to play.
3. Do not apply paper or tape to the disc; avoid scratching the disc.
If you press the switch up or down twice it plays the
second track; three times, it will play the third, etc.
The button in the center of the left-hand switch has no
function in this mode.
4. Do not use solvents such as benzene, thinner, cleaners,
or anti-static sprays.
5. Store the disc in its case after playing.
6. Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.
7. Do not store the disc where temperatures may become
too high.
4
270 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: If you experience difficulty in playing a particular
disc, it may be damaged (i.e., scratched, reflective coating
removed, a hair, moisture or dew on the disc) oversized,
or have protection encoding. Try a known good disc
before considering disc player service.
CLIMATE CONTROLS
The air conditioning and heating system is designed to
make you comfortable in all types of weather.
Manual Heating And Air Conditioning
RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in
your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from
your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
turned down or off during mobile phone operation when
not using Uconnect® (if equipped).
Manual Temperature Control
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 271
The Manual Temperature Controls consist of a series of Temperature Control
outer rotary dials and inner push knobs.
Blower Control
Rotate this control to regulate the temperature of the air inside the passenger
compartment. Rotating the dial left
into the blue area of the scale indicates
cooler temperatures, while rotating
right into the red area indicates
warmer temperatures.
Rotate this control to regulate the
amount of air forced through the ventilation system in any mode. The
blower speed increases as you move
the control to the right from the “O”
(OFF) position. There are four blower NOTE: If your air conditioning performance seems lower
speeds.
than expected, check the front of the A/C condenser
located in front of the radiator for an accumulation of dirt
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Remote Start, the
or insects. Clean with a gentle water spray from behind
climate controls will not function during Remote Start
the radiator and through the condenser. Fabric front
operation if the blower control is left in the “O” (Off)
fascia protectors may reduce airflow to the condenser,
position.
reducing air conditioning performance.
4
272 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Air Conditioning Control
Press this button to engage the Air Conditioning. A light will illuminate when
the Air Conditioning system is engaged.
Rotating the dial left into the blue area
of the scale indicates cooler temperatures, while rotating right into the red
area indicates warmer temperatures.
• ECONOMY MODE
If economy mode is desired, press the A/C button to turn
OFF the indicator light and the A/C compressor. Then,
select Panel, Bi-Level or Floor mode and move the
temperature control to the desired temperature.
Mode Control (Air Direction)
Rotate this control to choose from several patterns of air distribution. You
can select either a primary mode as
identified by the symbols on the con• MAX A/C
trol, or a blend of two of these modes.
For maximum cooling use the A/C and recirculation
The closer the setting is to a particular
buttons at the same time.
symbol, the more air distribution you
receive from that mode.
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor will not engage
until the engine has been running for about 10 seconds.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 273
• Panel
• Floor
Air is directed through the floor outlets with a
Air is directed through the outlets in the instrusmall amount flowing through the defrost and
ment panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct
side window demist outlets.
airflow.
NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed • Mix
so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side
for maximum airflow to the rear.
window demist outlets. This setting works best in
cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat to the
• Bi-Level
windshield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
while reducing moisture on the windshield.
NOTE: For all settings, except full cold or full hot, there • Defrost
is a difference in temperature between the upper and
Air is directed through the windshield and side
lower outlets. The warmer air flows to the floor outlets.
window demist outlets. Use this mode with maxiThis feature gives improved comfort during sunny but
mum
blower
and temperature settings for best windcool conditions.
shield and side window defrosting.
4
274 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor operates in Mix, • The use of the Recirculation mode in cold or damp
Defrost, or a blend of these modes, even if the Air
weather will cause windows to fog on the inside,
because of moisture buildup inside the vehicle. Select
Conditioning (A/C) button is not pressed. This dehuthe outside air position for maximum defogging.
midifies the air to help dry the windshield. To improve
fuel economy, use these modes only when necessary.
• The A/C will engage automatically to prevent fogging
• Recirculation Control
when the recirculation button is pressed and the mode
control is set to panel or Bi-Level.
Pressing the Recirculation Control button will
temporarily put the system in recirculation • Recirculated air is not allowed in Defrost modes. If the
mode. This can be used when outside condiRecirculation button is pressed while in Defrost mode,
tions such as smoke, odors, dust, or high
the LED indicator will flash several times then go out.
humidity are present. Activating recirculation will cause
Recirculation will be disabled automatically when
the LED in the control button to illuminate.
Defrost mode is selected.
NOTE:
• The A/C can be deselected manually without disturbing the mode control selection.
• Continuous use of the Recirculation mode may make
the inside air stuffy and window fogging may occur. • When the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
Extended use of this mode is not recommended.
position, the recirculation feature will be cancelled.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 275
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) — If
Equipped
the comfort levels desired by the driver and passenger.
Operation of the system is quite simple.
1. Turn the Mode Control knob (on the right) and the
Blower Control knob (on the left) to AUTO
NOTE: The AUTO position performs best for front seat
occupants only.
Automatic Temperature Control
Automatic Operation
Dial in the temperature you would like the system to
maintain by rotating the Temperature
Control knob. Once the comfort level is
selected, the system will maintain that
level automatically using the heating
system. Should the desired comfort level
require air conditioning, the system will
automatically make the adjustment.
You will experience the greatest efficiency by simply
The Automatic Temperature Control system automati- allowing the system to function automatically. Selecting
cally maintains the climate in the cabin of the vehicle at
4
276 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
the “O” (OFF) position on the blower control stops the
system completely and closes the outside air intake.
the radiator and through the condenser. Fabric front
fascia protectors may reduce airflow to the condenser,
reducing air conditioning performance.
72°F (22°C) is the recommended setting for maximum
comfort for the average person; however, this may vary. • While operating in AUTO, the system will not automatically sense the presence of fog, mist or ice on the
NOTE:
windshield. The defrost mode must be manually se• The temperature setting can be adjusted at anytime
lected to clear the windshield and side glass.
without affecting automatic operation.
Manual Operation
• Pressing the Air Conditioning Control button while in This system offers a full complement of manual override
AUTO mode will cause the LED in the control button features, which consist of Blower Preferred Automatic,
to flash three times and then turn off. This indicates Mode Preferred Automatic, or Blower and Mode Preferred
that the system is in AUTO mode and requesting the Automatic. This means the operator can override the
air conditioning is not necessary.
blower, the mode, or both. There is a manual blower range
• If your air conditioning performance seems lower than for times when the AUTO setting is not desired. The blower
expected, check the front of the A/C condenser located can be set to any fixed blower speed by rotating the Blower
in front of the radiator for an accumulation of dirt or Control knob (on the left).
insects. Clean with a gentle water spray from behind NOTE: Please read the Automatic Temperature Control
Operation Chart that follows for details.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 277
4
278 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The operator can override the AUTO mode setting to • Floor
change airflow distribution by rotating the Mode Control
Air is directed through the floor outlets with a
knob (on the right) to one of the following positions.
small amount flowing through the defrost and
• Panel
side window demist outlets.
Air is directed through the outlets in the instru- • Mix
ment panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side
airflow.
window demist outlets. This setting works best in
NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat to the
so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers windshield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort
for maximum airflow to the rear.
while reducing moisture on the windshield.
• Bi-Level
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
• Defrost
Air is directed through the windshield and side
window demist outlets. Use this mode with maxiNOTE: For all settings, except full cold or full hot, there
mum blower and temperature settings for best windis a difference in temperature between the upper and
shield and side window defrosting.
lower outlets. The warmer air flows to the floor outlets.
This feature gives improved comfort during sunny but
cool conditions.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 279
• Air Conditioner Control
NOTE:
Press this button to turn on the air • When the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK
position, the recirculation feature will be cancelled.
conditioning during manual operation
only. When the air conditioning is
• In cold weather, use of the Recirculation mode may
turned on, cool dehumidified air will
lead to excessive window fogging. The Recirculation
flow through the outlets selected with
mode is not allowed in defrost, in order to improve
the Mode control dial. Press this butwindow clearing. Recirculation will be disabled autoton a second time to turn OFF the air
matically if Defrost is selected.
conditioning. An LED in the button illuminates when
• Extended use of recirculation may cause the windows to
manual compressor operation is selected.
fog. If the interior of the windows begins to fog, press the
• Recirculation Control
Recirculation button to return to outside air. Some temp/
humidity conditions will cause captured interior air to
The system will automatically control recircucondense on windows and hamper visibility. For this
lation. However, pressing the Recirculation
reason, the system will not allow Recirculation to be
Control button will temporarily put the system
selected while in defrost. Attempting to use the recircuin recirculation mode. This can be used when
lation while in Defrost will cause the LED in the control
outside conditions such as smoke, odors, dust, or high
button to blink and then turn off.
humidity are present. Activating recirculation will cause
the LED in the control button to illuminate.
4
280 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Most of the time, when in Automatic Operation, you
can temporarily put the system into Recirculation
Mode by pressing the Recirculation button. However,
under certain conditions, while in Automatic Mode,
the system is blowing air out the defrost vents. When
these conditions are present, and the Recirculation
button is pressed, the indicator will flash and then turn
off. This tells you that you are unable to go into
Recirculation Mode at this time. If you would like the
system to go into Recirculation Mode, you must first
move the Mode knob to Panel, Mix and then press the
Recirculation button. This feature reduces the possibility of window fogging.
Blower Control
For full automatic operation or for
automatic blower operation, turn the
knob to the AUTO position. In manual
mode there are seven blower speeds
that can be individual selected. In off
position the blower will shut off.
Operating Tips
NOTE: Refer to the chart at the end of this section for
suggested control settings for various weather conditions.
Summer Operation
The engine cooling system must be protected with a
high-quality antifreeze coolant to provide proper corrosion protection and to protect against engine overheating.
A solution of 50% OAT (Organic Additive Technology)
coolant that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 281
Standard MS-12106 and 50% water is recommended. Window Fogging
Refer to “Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Interior fogging on the windshield can be quickly reVehicle” for proper coolant selection.
moved by turning the mode selector to Defrost. The Mix
mode can be used to maintain a clear windshield and
Winter Operation
provide sufficient heating. If side window fogging beUse of the air Recirculation Mode during winter months
comes a problem, increase blower speed. Vehicle winis not recommended because it may cause window
dows tend to fog on the inside in mild but rainy or humid
fogging.
weather.
Vacation Storage
NOTE: Recirculate without A/C should not be used for
Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of service long periods as fogging may occur.
(i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air
Side Window Demisters
conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the
fresh air and high blower settings. This will ensure A side window demister outlet is located at each end of
adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility the instrument panel. These non-adjustable outlets direct
of compressor damage when the system is started again. air toward the side windows when the system is in the
FLOOR, MIX, or DEFROST mode. The air is directed at
the area of the windows through which you view the
outside mirrors.
4
282 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Outside Air Intake
A/C Air Filter — If Equipped
Make sure the air intake, located directly in front of the
windshield, is free of obstructions such as leaves. Leaves
collected in the air intake may reduce airflow, and if they
enter the plenum, they could plug the water drains. In
winter months, make sure the air intake is clear of ice,
slush, and snow.
The A/C Filter prevents most dust and pollen from
entering the cabin. The filter acts on air coming from
outside the vehicle and recirculated air within the passenger compartment. Refer to “Maintenance Procedures”
in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for A/C Air Filter service
information or see your authorized dealer for service.
Refer to “Maintenance Schedules” for filter service intervals.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 283
Control Setting Suggestions for Various Weather Conditions
4
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
䡵 STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
▫ Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System . . .296
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
▫ Four-Speed Automatic Transmission —
If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
▫ Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
▫ Extreme Cold Weather
(Below –20°F Or −29°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
▫ If Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
▫ After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
䡵 ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED . . .293
䡵 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . .293
▫ Key Ignition Park Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
▫ Six-Speed Automatic Transmission (62TE) —
If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
䡵 AUTOSTICK® – IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
▫ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
䡵 DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES . . . . . . . . .314
▫ Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
▫ Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
5
286 STARTING AND OPERATING
䡵 DRIVING THROUGH WATER . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
▫ Flowing/Rising Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
▫ Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
䡵 POWER STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
▫ Power Steering Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
䡵 PARKING BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
䡵 ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) . . . . . . . . .321
䡵 ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM . . . .323
▫ Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . .324
▫ Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . .324
▫ Brake Assist System (BAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
▫ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . .325
▫ ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
ESC OFF Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
䡵 TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN). . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Tire Terminology And Definitions . . . . . . . . . .335
▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . .336
䡵 TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . .341
▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .342
▫ Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation . . . .343
▫ Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
▫ Tire Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
STARTING AND OPERATING 287
▫ Run Flat Tires – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
▫ Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
▫ Spare Tires – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
▫ Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
▫ E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles . . . . . . .364
▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
▫ MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
▫ Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
▫ Fuel System Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
䡵 TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) . . . . . . .352
▫ Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
䡵 TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS . . . . .353 䡵 FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
䡵 TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS) . .354
▫ E-85 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
▫ Base System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
▫ Ethanol Fuel (E-85) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
▫ Premium System – If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . .359
▫ Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .362
▫ Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel Vehicles
䡵 FUEL REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
(E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
5
288 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370 䡵 TRAILER TOWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
▫ Cruising Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
▫ Common Towing Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
▫ Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
▫ Trailer Hitch Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
▫ Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
▫ Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer
Weight Ratings) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
䡵 ADDING FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
▫ Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
▫ Loose Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
䡵 VEHICLE LOADING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
▫ Vehicle Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
▫ Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) . . . . . . .374
▫ Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) . . . . . . . . .374
▫ Overloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
▫ Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
▫ Trailer And Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
▫ Towing Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
▫ Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
䡵 RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
▫ Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle . .388
▫ Recreational Towing – All Models . . . . . . . . . .389
STARTING AND OPERATING 289
STARTING PROCEDURES
WARNING! (Continued)
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust the
inside and outside mirrors, fasten your seat belt, and if
present, instruct all other occupants to buckle their seat
belts.
WARNING!
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
(Continued)
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children, and do not
leave the ignition of a vehicle equipped with
Keyless Enter-N-Go™ in the ACC or ON/RUN
mode. A child could operate power windows, other
controls, or move the vehicle.
Automatic Transmission
The shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL or PARK
position before you can start the engine. Apply the brakes
before shifting into any driving gear.
5
290 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
• Do not shift from REVERSE, PARK, or NEUTRAL
into any forward gear when the engine is above
idle speed.
• Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to
a complete stop.
• Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the vehicle
has come to a complete stop and the engine is at
idle speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly on the brake pedal.
Normal Starting
NOTE: Normal starting of either a cold or a warm
engine is obtained without pumping or pressing the
accelerator pedal.
For vehicles not equipped with Tip Start (Four-Speed
Transmission), turn the ignition switch to the START
position and release it when the engine starts. If the
engine fails to start within 10 seconds, turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then
repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
For vehicles equipped with Tip Start (Six-Speed Transmission), turn the ignition switch to the START position
and release it as soon as the starter engages. The starter
motor will continue to run, and it will disengage automatically when the engine is running. If the engine fails
to start, the starter will disengage automatically in 10
seconds. If this occurs, turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then repeat the
“Normal Starting” procedure.
STARTING AND OPERATING 291
Extreme Cold Weather (Below –20°F Or −29°C)
To ensure reliable starting at these temperatures, use of
an externally powered electric engine block heater (available from your authorized dealer) is recommended.
If Engine Fails To Start
WARNING!
• Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into the
throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to start
the vehicle. This could result in flash fire causing
serious personal injury.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it
started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel
could enter the catalytic converter and once the
engine has started, ignite and damage the converter
and vehicle.
• If the vehicle has a discharged battery, booster
cables may be used to obtain a start from a booster
battery or the battery in another vehicle. This type
of start can be dangerous if done improperly. Refer
to “Jump Starting” in “What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
Without Tip Start
If the engine fails to start after you have followed the
“Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather” procedures, it may be flooded. Push the accelerator pedal all
5
292 STARTING AND OPERATING
the way to the floor and hold it there while cranking the With Tip Start
engine. This should clear any excess fuel in case the If the engine fails to start after you have followed the
engine is flooded.
“Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather” procedures, it may be flooded. To clear any excess fuel, push
CAUTION!
the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it.
Then, turn the ignition switch to the START position and
To prevent damage to the starter, do not crank the
release it as soon as the starter engages. The starter motor
engine for more than 15 seconds at a time. Wait 10 to
will disengage automatically in 10 seconds. Once this
15 seconds before trying again.
occurs, release the accelerator pedal, turn the ignition
If the engine is flooded, it may start to run, but not have switch to the LOCK position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then
enough power to continue running when the key is repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
released. If this occurs, continue cranking up to 15
seconds with the accelerator pedal pushed all the way to
CAUTION!
the floor.
To prevent damage to the starter, wait 10 to 15
If the engine shows no sign of starting after two 15- seconds before trying again.
second periods of cranking with the accelerator pedal
held to the floor, repeat the “Normal Starting” or “Extreme Cold Weather” procedures.
STARTING AND OPERATING 293
After Starting
The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will
decrease as the engine warms up.
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER — IF EQUIPPED
WARNING!
Remember to disconnect the engine block heater
cord before driving. Damage to the 110-115 Volt
electrical cord could cause electrocution.
The engine block heater warms the engine, and permits
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
quicker starts in cold weather. Connect the cord to a
standard 110-115 Volt AC electrical outlet with a
CAUTION!
grounded, three-wire extension cord.
The engine block heater must be plugged in at least one Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
hour to have an adequate warning effect on the engine.
• Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to
The engine block heater cord is bundled under the hood
a complete stop.
between the headlight assembly and the Totally Inte- • Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the vehicle
grated Power Module (Fuse Box) on the driver’s side of
has come to a complete stop and the engine is at
the vehicle.
idle speed.
(Continued)
5
294 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Do not shift between PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL,
or DRIVE when the engine is above idle speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
NOTE: You MUST press and hold the brake pedal while
shifting out of PARK.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 295
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in and near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
Once the key is removed, the transmission is
locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle,
or in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
Key Ignition Park Interlock
This vehicle is equipped with a Key Ignition Park Interlock which requires the transmission to be in PARK
before the ignition switch can be turned to the LOCK
position. The key can only be removed from the ignition
5
296 STARTING AND OPERATING
when the ignition is in the LOCK position, and once Four-Speed Automatic Transmission — If
removed, the transmission is locked in PARK.
Equipped
NOTE: If a malfunction occurs, the system will trap the
key in the ignition switch to warn you that this safety
feature is inoperable. The engine can be started and
stopped but the key cannot be removed until you obtain
service.
Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System
This vehicle is equipped with a Brake Transmission Shift
Interlock system (BTSI) that holds the shift lever in PARK
unless the brakes are applied. To shift the transmission
out of PARK, the ignition switch must be turned to the
ON/RUN position (engine running or not) and the brake
pedal must be pressed.
The transmission gear position display (located in the
instrument cluster) indicates the transmission gear range.
You must press the brake pedal to move the shift lever
out of PARK (refer to “Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System” in this section). To drive, move the shift
lever from PARK or NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position.
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a
precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are
self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal
condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few
hundred miles (kilometers).
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the
accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped.
Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when
shifting between these gears.
STARTING AND OPERATING 297
the transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or
precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a
NEUTRAL into another gear range.
downhill grade and away from the curb on an uphill
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to grade.
allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating.
This is especially important when the engine is cold.
WARNING!
Gear Ranges
PARK (P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the
transmission. The engine can be started in this range.
Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in
motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this range.
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the
transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking
brake.
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
shifting the transmission to PARK, otherwise the load on
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not completely in PARK. Check by trying to
move the shift lever out of PARK with the brake
pedal released. Make sure the transmission is in
PARK before leaving the vehicle.
(Continued)
5
298 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
Once the key is removed, the transmission is
locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
(Continued)
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 299
WARNING! (Continued)
CAUTION!
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle. Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to be in a
vehicle unattended is dangerous for a number of
reasons. A child or others could be seriously or
fatally injured. Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake, brake pedal or the shift
lever.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle,
or in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
• Before moving the shift lever out of PARK, you
must turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the ON/RUN position, and also press the
brake pedal. Otherwise, damage to the shift lever
could result.
• DO NOT race the engine when shifting from
PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range, as this
can damage the drivetrain.
The following indicators should be used to ensure that you
have engaged the transmission into the PARK position:
• When shifting into PARK, firmly move the shift lever
all the way forward and to the left until it stops and is
fully seated.
• Look at the transmission gear position display and
verify that it indicates the PARK position.
5
300 STARTING AND OPERATING
• With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever
will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE (R)
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
stop.
NEUTRAL (N)
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
periods with the engine running. The engine may be
started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift
the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE (D)
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
(Continued)
This range should be used for most city and highway
driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission
STARTING AND OPERATING 301
automatically upshifts through all forward gears. The achieve maximum efficiency. Engagement of the torque
DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteris- converter clutch is inhibited until the transmission fluid
is warm (refer to the “Note” under “Torque Converter
tics under all normal operating conditions.
Clutch” in this section). During extremely cold temperaWhen frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as
tures (-16°F [-27°C] or below), operation may briefly be
when operating the vehicle under heavy loading condilimited to second gear only. Normal operation will retions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or
sume once the transmission temperature has risen to a
while towing heavy trailers), select the ⬙3⬙ range. Under
suitable level.
these conditions, using the ⬙3⬙ range will improve performance and extend transmission life by reducing exces- DRIVE 3 (3)
sive shifting and heat buildup.
This range eliminates shifts into fourth gear. The transmission will operate normally in first and second gear.
Shifts into third may be delayed to provide second gear
operation at higher speeds. Using the ⬙3⬙ range while
operating the vehicle under heavy operating conditions
will improve performance and extend transmission life
During cold temperatures, transmission operation may by reducing excessive shifting and heat build-up. The ⬙3⬙
be modified depending on engine and transmission range should also be used when descending steep grades
temperature as well as vehicle speed. This feature im- to avoid brake system distress.
proves warm up time of the engine and transmission to
If the transmission temperature exceeds normal operating limits, the powertrain controller will modify the
DRIVE and “3” range shift points. This is done to prevent
transmission damage due to overheating.
5
302 STARTING AND OPERATING
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission
can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the
Use this range for engine braking when descending very
following steps:
steep grades. In this range, the transmission will downshift for maximum engine braking, and upshifts will 1. Stop the vehicle.
occur only to prevent engine overspeed.
2. Shift the transmission into PARK.
Transmission Limp Home Mode
3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Transmission function is monitored electronically for
abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could 4. Wait approximately 10 seconds.
result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home 5. Restart the engine.
Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains
in third gear regardless of which forward gear is selected. 6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no
longer detected, the transmission will return to normal
PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operoperation.
ate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recomdriven to an authorized dealer for service without dam- mend that you visit your authorized dealer at your
aging the transmission.
earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has
diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could
recur.
LOW (L)
STARTING AND OPERATING 303
If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer Torque Converter Clutch
service is required.
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has been
included in the automatic transmission on your vehicle.
Overdrive Operation
A clutch within the torque converter engages automatiThe automatic transmission includes an electronically
cally at calibrated speeds. This may result in a slightly
controlled Overdrive (fourth gear). The transmission will
different feeling or response during normal operation in
automatically shift into Overdrive if the following conthe upper gears. When the vehicle speed drops or during
ditions are present:
some accelerations, the clutch automatically disengages.
• the shift lever is in the DRIVE position,
• the transmission fluid has reached an adequate temperature,
• the engine coolant has reached an adequate temperature,
• vehicle speed is sufficiently high, and
• the driver is not heavily pressing the accelerator.
5
304 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: The torque converter clutch will not engage until
the transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm
[usually after 1 to 3 miles (2 to 5 km) of driving]. Because
the engine speed is higher when the torque converter
clutch is not engaged, it may seem as if the transmission
is not shifting into Overdrive when cold. This is normal.
Shifting between the DRIVE and 3 ranges, when the
transmission is sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that
the transmission is able to shift into and out of Overdrive.
Six-Speed Automatic Transmission (62TE) — If
Equipped
The transmission gear position display (located in the
instrument cluster) indicates the transmission gear range.
You must press the brake pedal to move the shift lever
out of PARK (refer to “Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System” in this section). To drive, move the shift
lever from PARK or NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position.
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a
precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are
self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal
condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few
hundred miles (kilometers).
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the
accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped.
Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when
shifting between these gears.
The transmission shift lever has PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, DRIVE, and AutoStick® shift positions. Manual
shifts can be made using the AutoStick® shift control
(refer to “AutoStick®” in this section for further information). Moving the shift lever into the AutoStick® position
(below the Drive position) activates AutoStick® mode,
providing manual shift control and displaying the current gear in the instrument cluster.
STARTING AND OPERATING 305
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to
allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating.
This is especially important when the engine is cold.
PARK (P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the
transmission. The engine can be started in this range.
Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in
motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this range.
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the
transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking
Shift Lever
brake.
Gear Ranges
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or shifting the transmission to PARK, otherwise the load on
NEUTRAL into another gear range.
the transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult
5
306 STARTING AND OPERATING
to move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill
grade and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
WARNING!
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not completely in PARK. Check by trying to
move the shift lever out of PARK with the brake
pedal released. Make sure the transmission is in
PARK before leaving the vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 307
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
Once the key is removed, the transmission is
locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle. Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to be in a
vehicle unattended is dangerous for a number of
reasons. A child or others could be seriously or
fatally injured. Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake, brake pedal or the shift
lever.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle,
or in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
5
308 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
• Before moving the shift lever out of PARK, you
must turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the ON/RUN position, and also press the
brake pedal. Otherwise, damage to the shift lever
could result.
• DO NOT race the engine when shifting from
PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range, as this
can damage the drivetrain.
• Look at the transmission gear position display and
verify that it indicates the PARK position.
• With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever
will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE (R)
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
stop.
NEUTRAL (N)
The following indicators should be used to ensure that
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
you have engaged the transmission into the PARK posiperiods with the engine running. The engine may be
tion:
started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift
• When shifting into PARK, firmly move the shift lever the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
all the way forward and to the left until it stops and is
fully seated.
STARTING AND OPERATING 309
WARNING!
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE (D)
This range should be used for most city and highway
driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission
automatically upshifts through underdrive first, second,
third, and fourth gears, direct fifth gear and overdrive
sixth gear. The DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as
when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, traveling into strong head winds, or
while towing heavy trailers), use the AutoStick® shift
control (refer to “AutoStick®” in this section for further
information) to select a lower gear. Under these conditions, using a lower gear will improve performance and
extend transmission life by reducing excessive shifting
and heat buildup.
5
310 STARTING AND OPERATING
During cold temperatures, transmission operation may
be modified depending on engine and transmission
temperature as well as vehicle speed. This feature improves warm up time of the engine and transmission to
achieve maximum efficiency. Engagement of the torque
converter clutch is inhibited until the transmission fluid
is warm (refer to the “Note” under “Torque Converter
Clutch” in this section). During extremely cold temperatures (-16°F [-27°C] or below), operation may briefly be
limited to third gear only. Normal operation will resume
once the transmission temperature has risen to a suitable
level.
Transmission Limp Home Mode
PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be
driven to an authorized dealer for service without damaging the transmission.
In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission
can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the
following steps:
1. Stop the vehicle.
2. Shift the transmission into PARK.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position.
Transmission function is monitored electronically for 4. Wait approximately 10 seconds.
abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could 5. Restart the engine.
result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home
Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains 6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no
longer detected, the transmission will return to normal
in third gear regardless of which forward gear is selected.
operation.
STARTING AND OPERATING 311
NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recom- • The engine coolant has reached an adequate temperamend that you visit your authorized dealer at your
ture.
earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has
• The vehicle speed is sufficiently high.
diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could
recur.
• The driver is not heavily pressing the accelerator.
If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer Torque Converter Clutch
service is required.
A feature designed to improve fuel economy has been
included in the automatic transmission on your vehicle.
Overdrive Operation
A clutch within the torque converter engages automatiThe automatic transmission includes an electronically
cally at calibrated speeds. This may result in a slightly
controlled Overdrive (sixth gear). The transmission will
different feeling or response during normal operation in
automatically shift into Overdrive if the following conthe upper gears. When the vehicle speed drops or during
ditions are present:
some accelerations, the clutch automatically disengages.
• The shift lever is in the DRIVE position.
• The transmission fluid has reached an adequate temperature.
5
312 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: The torque converter clutch will not engage until
the transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm
(usually after 1 to 3 miles [2 to 5 km] of driving). Because
the engine speed is higher when the torque converter
clutch is not engaged, it may seem as if the transmission
is not shifting into Overdrive when cold. This is normal.
Using the AutoStick® shift control, when the transmission is sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that the
transmission is able to shift into and out of Overdrive.
Operation
When the shift lever is in the AutoStick® position (below
the DRIVE position), it can be moved from side to side.
This allows the driver to manually select the transmission
gear being used. Moving the shift lever to the left (-)
triggers a downshift and to the right (+) an upshift. The
current gear will be displayed in the instrument cluster.
In AutoStick® mode, the transmission will shift up or
down when the driver moves the shift lever to the right
AUTOSTICK® – IF EQUIPPED
(+) or left (-), unless an engine lugging or overspeed
AutoStick® is a driver-interactive transmission feature condition would result. It will remain in the selected gear
providing manual shift control, giving you more control until another upshift or downshift is chosen, except as
of the vehicle. AutoStick® allows you to maximize en- described below.
gine braking, eliminate undesirable upshifts and down- • The transmission will automatically downshift to first
shifts, and improve overall vehicle performance. This
gear when coming to a stop. After a stop, the driver
system can also provide you with more control during
should manually upshift (+) the transmission as the
passing, city driving, cold slippery conditions, mountain
vehicle is accelerated.
driving, trailer towing, and many other situations.
STARTING AND OPERATING 313
• You can start out, from a stop, in any gear except top • If the system detects a problem, it will disable
gear. Tapping (+) (at a stop) will allow starting in
AutoStick® mode and the transmission will return to
automatic mode until the problem is corrected.
second gear. Starting out in second gear is helpful in
snowy or icy conditions.
To disengage AutoStick® mode, return the shift lever to
• The transmission will automatically upshift when nec- the DRIVE position. You can shift in or out of the
AutoStick® position at any time without taking your foot
essary to prevent engine over-speed.
off the accelerator pedal.
• If a requested downshift would cause the engine to
over-speed, that shift will not occur.
• Avoid using speed control when AutoStick® is engaged.
• Transmission shifting will be more noticeable when
AutoStick® is engaged.
• If the system detects powertrain overheating, the
transmission will revert to automatic shift mode and
remain in that mode until the powertrain cools off.
WARNING!
Do not downshift for additional engine braking on a
slippery surface. The drive wheels could lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid, causing a collision or
personal injury.
5
314 STARTING AND OPERATING
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
Traction
Acceleration
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road
surface. This is hydroplaning and may cause partial or
complete loss of vehicle control and stopping ability. To
reduce this possibility, the following precautions should
be observed:
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slippery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull
erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs
when there is a difference in the surface traction under
the front (driving) wheels.
WARNING!
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is dangerous.
Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of the
front wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle
and possibly have a collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction
(ice, snow, wet, mud, loose sand, etc.).
1. Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are
slushy.
2. Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles.
3. Replace the tires when tread wear indicators first
become visible.
4. Keep tires properly inflated.
5. Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a
sudden stop.
STARTING AND OPERATING 315
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
Shallow Standing Water
Driving through water more than a few inches/ Although your vehicle is capable of driving through
centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure shallow standing water, consider the following Caution
safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
and Warning before doing so.
Flowing/Rising Water
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or path where water
is flowing and/or rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing water can wear away the road or path’s surface
and cause your vehicle to sink into deeper water.
Furthermore, flowing and/or rising water can carry
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in injuries that are serious or
fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
CAUTION!
• Always check the depth of the standing water
before driving through it. Never drive through
standing water that is deeper than the bottom of
the tire rims mounted on the vehicle.
• Determine the condition of the road or the path
that is under water and if there are any obstacles in
the way before driving through the standing water.
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when driving
through standing water. This will minimize wave
effects.
(Continued)
5
316 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Driving through standing water may cause damage
to your vehicle’s drivetrain components. Always
inspect your vehicle’s fluids (i.e., engine oil, transmission, axle, etc.) for signs of contamination (i.e.,
fluid that is milky or foamy in appearance) after
driving through standing water. Do not continue to
operate the vehicle if any fluid appears contaminated, as this may result in further damage. Such
damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
• Getting water inside your vehicle’s engine can
cause it to lock up and stall out, and cause serious
internal damage to the engine. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s traction capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through standing water.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s braking capabilities, which increases stopping
distances. Therefore, after driving through standing water, drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to dry the brakes.
• Failure to follow these warnings may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
POWER STEERING
The standard power steering system will give you good
vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability
in tight spaces. The system will provide mechanical
steering capability if power assist is lost.
STARTING AND OPERATING 317
If for some reason the power assist is interrupted, it will
still be possible to steer your vehicle. Under these conditions, you will observe a substantial increase in steering
effort, especially at very low vehicle speeds and during
parking maneuvers.
WARNING!
Continued operation with reduced power steering
assist could pose a safety risk to yourself and others.
Service should be obtained as soon as possible.
NOTE:
• Increased noise levels at the end of the steering wheel
travel are considered normal and do not indicate that
there is a problem with the power steering system.
• Upon initial start-up in cold weather, the power steering pump may make noise for a short amount of time.
This is due to the cold, thick fluid in the steering
system. This noise should be considered normal, and it
does not in any way damage the steering system.
CAUTION!
Prolonged operation of the steering system at the end
of the steering wheel travel will increase the steering
fluid temperature and it should be avoided when
possible. Damage to the power steering pump may
occur.
5
318 STARTING AND OPERATING
Power Steering Fluid Check
Checking the power steering fluid level at a defined
service interval is not required. The fluid should only be
checked if a leak is suspected, abnormal noises are
apparent, and/or the system is not functioning as anticipated. Coordinate inspection efforts through an authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your power steering
system as the chemicals can damage your power
steering components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WARNING!
Fluid level should be checked on a level surface and
with the engine off to prevent injury from moving
parts and to ensure accurate fluid level reading. Do
not overfill. Use only manufacturer’s recommended
power steering fluid.
If necessary, add fluid to restore to the proper indicated
level. With a clean cloth, wipe any spilled fluid from all
surfaces. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts”
in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 319
possible. To release the parking brake, pull the lever up
slightly, press the center button, then lower the lever
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking
completely.
brake is fully applied. Also, be certain to leave the
transmission in PARK.
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch ON, the “Brake Warning Light” in the instrument
cluster will illuminate.
PARKING BRAKE
NOTE:
• When the parking brake is applied and the transmission is placed in gear, the “Brake Warning Light” will
flash. If vehicle speed is detected, a chime will sound
to alert the driver. Fully release the parking brake
before attempting to move the vehicle.
• This light only shows that the parking brake is applied. It
does not show the degree of brake application.
Parking Brake
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front
The parking brake lever is located in the center console. wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away
To apply the parking brake, pull the lever up as firmly as from the curb on an uphill grade. Apply the parking
5
320 STARTING AND OPERATING
brake before placing the shift lever in PARK, otherwise
the load on the transmission locking mechanism may
make it difficult to move the shift lever out of PARK. The
parking brake should always be applied whenever the
driver is not in the vehicle.
WARNING!
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the key
fob from the ignition and lock your vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever.
• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake
failure and a collision.
• Always fully apply the parking brake when leaving your vehicle or it may roll and cause damage or
injury. Also, be certain to leave the transmission in
PARK. Failure to do so may cause the vehicle to roll
and cause damage or injury.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 321
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
CAUTION!
If the “Brake Warning Light” remains on with the
parking brake released, a brake system malfunction
is indicated. Have the brake system serviced by an
authorized dealer immediately.
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS)
The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) provides increased
vehicle stability and brake performance under most
braking conditions. The system operates with a separate
computer to modulate the hydraulic pressure to prevent
wheel lock-up and avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.
WARNING!
• Pumping of the anti-lock brakes will diminish
their effectiveness and may lead to a collision.
Pumping makes the stopping distance longer. Just
press firmly on your brake pedal when you need to
slow down or stop.
• The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase
braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded
by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or
the traction afforded.
• The ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
(Continued)
5
322 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner, which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
The “Anti-Lock Brake Warning Light” monitors the Anti-Lock Brake System. The light will
come on when the ignition switch is turned to
the ON position and may stay on for as long as
four seconds.
If the “Anti-Lock Brake Warning Light” remains on or
comes on while driving, it indicates that the anti-lock
portion of the brake system is not functioning and that
service is required. However, the conventional brake
system will continue to operate normally if the “Brake
Warning Light” is not on.
If the “Anti-Lock Brake Warning Light” is on, the brake
system should be serviced as soon as possible to restore
the benefits of anti-lock brakes. If the “Anti-Lock Brake
Warning Light” does not come on when the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position, have the bulb
repaired as soon as possible.
If both the “Brake Warning Light” and the “Anti-Lock
Brake Warning Light” remain on, the Anti-Lock Brake
(ABS) and Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD)
Systems are not functioning. Immediate repair to the ABS
system is required. See your authorized dealer.
When the vehicle is driven over 7 mph (11 km/h), you
may hear a slight clicking sound as well as some related
motor noises. These noises are the system performing its
self-check cycle to ensure that the ABS system is working
properly. This self check occurs each time the vehicle is
started and accelerated past 7 mph (11 km/h).
STARTING AND OPERATING 323
ABS is activated during braking under certain road or
stopping conditions. ABS-inducing conditions can include ice, snow, gravel, bumps, railroad tracks, loose
debris, or panic stops.
You also may experience the following when the brake
system goes into anti-lock:
• The ABS motor running (it may continue to run for a
short time after the stop).
• The clicking sound of solenoid valves.
WARNING!
The Anti-Lock Brake System contains sophisticated
electronic equipment that may be susceptible to
interference caused by improperly installed or high
output radio transmitting equipment. This interference can cause possible loss of anti-lock braking
capability. Installation of such equipment should be
performed by qualified professionals.
All vehicle wheels and tires must be the same size and
• Brake pedal pulsations.
type, and tires must be properly inflated to produce
• A slight drop or fall away of the brake pedal at the end accurate signals for the computer.
of the stop.
ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
These are all normal characteristics of ABS.
Your vehicle is equipped with an advanced electronic
brake control system that includes Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), Traction Control System (TCS), Brake Assist
System (BAS), and Electronic Stability Control (ESC). All
5
324 STARTING AND OPERATING
systems work together to enhance vehicle stability and
control in various driving conditions and are commonly
referred to as ESC.
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING! (Continued)
very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning. The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must never be
exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which
could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of
others.
This system aids the driver in maintaining vehicle control
under adverse braking conditions. The system controls
hydraulic brake pressure to prevent wheel lock-up and
help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces during braking. Traction Control System (TCS)
This system monitors the amount of wheel spin of each of
the driven wheels. If wheel spin is detected, brake
WARNING!
pressure is applied to the slipping wheel(s) and engine
The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics power is reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and
from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the stability. A feature of the TCS system functions similar to
traction afforded by prevailing road conditions. The a limited slip differential and controls the wheel spin
ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those re- across a driven axle. If one wheel on a driven axle is
sulting from excessive speed in turns, driving on spinning faster than the other, the system will apply the
brake of the spinning wheel. This will allow more engine
(Continued)
torque to be applied to the wheel that is not spinning.
STARTING AND OPERATING 325
This feature remains active even if TCS and ESC are in
the “Partial Off” mode. Refer to “Electronic Stability
Control (ESC)” in this section of this manual.
Brake Assist System (BAS)
WARNING!
• The BAS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase
braking efficiency beyond that afforded by the
condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the
traction afforded.
• The BAS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
• The capabilities of a BAS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner, which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
The BAS is designed to optimize the vehicle’s braking
capability during emergency braking maneuvers. The
system detects an emergency braking situation by sensing the rate and amount of brake application and then
applies optimum pressure to the brakes. This can help
reduce braking distances. The BAS complements the
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS). Applying the brakes very
quickly results in the best BAS assistance. To receive the
benefit of the system, you must apply continuous braking pressure during the stopping sequence. Do not
reduce brake pedal pressure unless braking is no longer Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
desired. Once the brake pedal is released, the BAS is This system enhances directional control and stability of
deactivated.
the vehicle under various driving conditions. ESC corrects for over/under steering of the vehicle by applying
5
326 STARTING AND OPERATING
the brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting the over/under steer condition. Engine power
may also be reduced to help the vehicle maintain the
desired path. ESC uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the vehicle path intended by the driver and compares it to the actual path of the vehicle. When the actual
path does not match the intended path, ESC applies the
brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting
the oversteer or understeer condition
• Over-steer - when the vehicle is turning more than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
• Under-steer - when the vehicle is turning less than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
WARNING!
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot prevent the
natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle,
nor can it increase the traction afforded by prevailing
road conditions. ESC cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in
turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent accidents resulting
from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate
driver input for the conditions. Only a safe, attentive,
and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must never be
exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which
could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of
others.
STARTING AND OPERATING 327
ESC Operating Modes
The ESC system has two available operating modes.:
intended to be used if the vehicle is in deep snow, sand,
or gravel conditions and more wheel spin than ESC
would normally allow is required to gain traction.
Full On
This is the normal operating mode for ESC. Whenever
the vehicle is started the ESC system will be in this mode.
This mode should be used for almost all driving situations. ESC should only be turned to “Partial Off” for
specific reasons as noted below.
5
Partial Off
This mode is entered by momentarily pressing the “ESC
Off” switch (located in the lower switch bank below the
heater/air conditioning controls). When in “Partial Off”
mode, the TCS portion of ESC, except for the limited slip
feature described in the TCS section, has been disabled
and the “ESC OFF Indicator Light” will be illuminated.
All other stability features of ESC function normally, with
the exception of engine power reduction. This mode is
ESC Off Switch
328 STARTING AND OPERATING
To turn ESC on again, momentarily press the “ESC Off” NOTE: To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving
switch. This will restore the normal “ESC On” mode of with snow chains, or starting off in deep snow, sand or
operation.
gravel, it may be desirable to switch to the “Partial Off”
mode by pressing the “ESC Off” switch. Once the situation requiring ESC to be switched to the “Partial Off”
WARNING!
mode is overcome, turn ESC on again by momentarily
When in “Partial Off” mode, the TCS functionality of pressing the “ESC Off” switch. This may be done while
ESC (except for the limited slip feature described in the vehicle is in motion.
the TCS section) has been disabled and the “ESC Off
Indicator Light” will be illuminated. When in “Par- ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
tial Off” mode, the engine power reduction of TCS is ESC OFF Indicator Light
disabled, and the enhanced vehicle stability offered
by the ECS system is reduced.
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on
when the ignition switch is cycled to the ON
position. It should go out with the engine
running. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” comes on continuously with the engine running, a
malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this
STARTING AND OPERATING 329
light remains on after several ignition cycles, and the NOTE:
vehicle has been driven several miles (kilometers) at
• The “ESC Off Indicator Light” and the “ESC
speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authoActivation/Malfunction Indicator Light” come on morized dealer as soon as possible to have the problem
mentarily each time the ignition switch is turned ON.
diagnosed and corrected.
• Each time the ignition is cycled ON, the ESC system
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” (lowill be ON even if it was cycled off previously.
cated in the instrument cluster) starts to flash as soon as
the tires lose traction and the ESC system becomes active. • The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” also
when it is active. This is normal; the sounds will stop
flashes when TCS is active. If the “ESC Activation/
when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver
Malfunction Indicator Light” begins to flash during acthat caused the ESC activation.
celeration, ease up on the accelerator and apply as little
throttle as possible. Be sure to adapt your speed and
The “ESC OFF Indicator Light” indicates the
driving to the prevailing road conditions.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is partially
off
5
330 STARTING AND OPERATING
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
Tire Markings
NOTE:
• P (Passenger) - Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P”
molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
• European-Metric tire sizing is based on European
design standards. Tires designed to this standard have
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with
the section width. The letter ⬙P⬙ is absent from this tire
size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
1 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards
Code (TIN)
2 — Size Designation
3 — Service Description
4 — Maximum Load
5 — Maximum Pressure
6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
• LT (Light Truck) - Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
STARTING AND OPERATING 331
• Temporary spare tires are designed for temporary • High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design
emergency use only. Temporary high pressure comstandards and it begins with the tire diameter molded
pact spare tires have the letter “T” or “S” molded into
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example:
T145/80D18 103M.
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE:
Size Designation:
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards
LT = Light truck tire based on U.S. design standards
T or S = Temporary spare tire
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
— Ratio of section height to section width of tire
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
5
332 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
R = Construction code
— ⬙R⬙ means radial construction
— ⬙D⬙ means diagonal or bias construction
15 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
— A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
— A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to
its load index under certain operating conditions
— The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under
specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and
posted speed limits)
STARTING AND OPERATING 333
EXAMPLE:
Load Identification:
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Absence of any text on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) tire
Extra Load (XL) = Extra load (or reinforced) tire
Light Load (LL) = Light load tire
C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load— Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure— Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for
this tire
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire, tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on
however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires the outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard
side of the tire.
with white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the
date code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire.
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
5
334 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
— This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
— 03 means the 3rd week
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
— 01 means the year 2001
— Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the
year in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991
STARTING AND OPERATING 335
Tire Terminology And Definitions
Term
B-Pillar
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Tire Placard
Definition
The vehicle B-Pillar is the structural member of the body located
behind the front door.
Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after
the vehicle has not been driven for at least 3 hours, or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a three hour period. Inflation
pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per square inch) or
kPa (kilopascals).
The maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible
cold tire inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation
pressure is molded into the sidewall.
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold tire inflation pressure
as shown on the tire placard.
A paper label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the
vehicle’s loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and
the recommended cold tire inflation pressures.
5
336 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
Tire And Loading Information Placard Location
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on
the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver’s
side door.
B-Pillar Location for Tire And Loading Information
Placard
STARTING AND OPERATING 337
Tire And Loading Information Placard
2) Total weight your vehicle can carry.
3) Tire size designed for your vehicle.
4) Told tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and
spare tires.
Loading
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You
will not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if you
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading
Information placard and in the “Vehicle Loading” section
of this manual.
Tire and Loading Information Placard
This placard tells you important information about
the:
1) Number of people that can be carried in the vehicle.
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition,
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
axles must not be exceeded. For further information on
GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to
“Vehicle Loading” in this section.
5
338 STARTING AND OPERATING
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your 4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
“XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will
XXX kg” on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
be five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the
The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed
is 650 lbs (295 kg) (since 5 x 150 lbs (68 kg) = 750 lbs
the weight referenced here.
(340 kg), and 1400 lbs (635 kg) – 750 lbs (340 kg) =
650 lbs [295 kg]).
Steps For Determining Correct Load Limit
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occubeing loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not
pants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load
XXX kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
capacity calculated in Step 4.
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and pasmanual to determine how this reduces the available
sengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 339
NOTE:
• The following table shows examples on how to calculate total load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities
of your vehicle with varying seating configurations
and number and size of occupants. This table is for
illustration purposes only and may not be accurate for
the seating and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
• For the following example, the combined weight of
occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs
(392 kg).
5
340 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING AND OPERATING 341
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading
can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and
increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never
overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Three primary
areas are affected by improper tire pressure:
Safety
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can
cause collisions.
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing and can result in over-heating and tire failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushion
shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can
cause damage that result in tire failure.
• Over-inflated or under-inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in
loss of vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
(Continued)
5
342 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the
right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
Economy
Improper inflation pressures can cause uneven wear patterns to develop across the tire tread. These abnormal wear
patterns will reduce tread life resulting in a need for earlier
tire replacement. Under-inflation also increases tire rolling
resistance resulting in higher fuel consumption.
stability of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of
sluggish response or over responsiveness in the steering.
NOTE:
• Unequal tire pressures from side to side may cause
erratic and unpredictable steering response.
• Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the
vehicle to drift left or right.
Tire Inflation Pressures
The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the
driver’s side “B” Pillar or rear edge of the driver’s side door.
At least once a month:
• Check and adjust tire pressure with a good quality
pocket-type pressure gauge. Do not make a visual judgeProper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.
ment when determining proper inflation. Tires may look
properly inflated even when they are under-inflated.
Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable
ride. Both under-inflation and over-inflation affect the
• Inspect tires for signs of tire wear or visible damage.
Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
STARTING AND OPERATING 343
CAUTION!
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will prevent
moisture and dirt from entering the valve stem,
which could damage the valve stem.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per
12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind
when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in
the winter.
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) and the
outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then the cold tire
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),
“cold tire inflation pressure”. Cold tire inflation pressure which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not outside temperature condition.
been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1 Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)
mile (1.6 km) after a three hour period. The cold tire during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
inflation pressure must not exceed the maximum infla- build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
tion pressure molded into the tire sidewall.
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds and
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditemperature changes.
tions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle
5
344 STARTING AND OPERATING
loading may be required for high-speed vehicle opera- Radial Ply Tires
tion. Refer to your authorized tire or original equipment
vehicle dealer for recommended safe operating speeds,
WARNING!
loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
Combining radial ply tires with other types of tires
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
WARNING!
poorly. The instability could cause a collision. AlHigh speed driving with your vehicle under maxiways use radial ply tires in sets of four. Never
mum load is dangerous. The added strain on your
combine them with other types of tires.
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a
serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle loaded to the Tire Repair
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if it
75 mph (120 km/h).
meets the following criteria:
• The tire has not been driven on when flat.
• The damage is only on the tread section of your tire
(sidewall damage is not repairable).
• The puncture is no greater than ¼⬙ (6 mm).
STARTING AND OPERATING 345
Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs and Summer Or Three Season Tires – If Equipped
additional information.
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or
experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced imme- on ice. Summer tires will not contain the all season
diately with another Run Flat tire of identical size and designation or mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire
sidewall. Use summer tires only in sets of four; failure to
service description (Load Index and Speed Code).
do so may adversely affect the safety and handling of
Tire Types
your vehicle.
All Season Tires – If Equipped
Snow Tires
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (spring,
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires
summer, fall and winter). Traction levels may vary beduring the winter. Snow tires can be identified by a
tween different all season tires. All season tires can be
mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall.
identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on
the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four; If you need snow tires, select tires equivalent in size and
failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires only
handling of your vehicle.
in sets of four; failure to do so may adversely affect the
safety and handling of your vehicle.
5
346 STARTING AND OPERATING
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph
(120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to
original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for
recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold
tire inflation pressures.
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid
and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states prohibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be
checked before using these tire types.
Run Flat Tires – If Equipped
Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive 50 miles
(80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a rapid loss of inflation
pressure. This rapid loss of inflation is referred to as the
Run Flat mode. A Run Flat mode occurs when the tire
inflation pressure is of/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a
Run Flat tire reaches the run flat mode it has limited
driving capabilities and needs to be replaced immediately. A Run Flat tire is not repairable.
It is not recommended driving a vehicle loaded at full
capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the run flat
mode.
See the tire pressure monitoring section for more information.
Spare Tires – If Equipped
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with TIREFIT instead of a
spare tire, please refer to “TIREFIT KIT” in “What To Do
In Emergencies” for further information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 347
CAUTION!
Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take
your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a
compact, full size or limited-use temporary spare
installed. Damage to the vehicle may result.
Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
Wheel – If Equipped
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and
wheel equivalent in look and function to the original
equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle
of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire
rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option
refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended
tire rotation pattern.
Compact Spare Tire – If Equipped
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only.
You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a
compact spare by looking at the spare tire description on
the Tire and Loading Information Placard located on the
driver’s side door opening or on the sidewall of the tire.
Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the letter “T”
or “S” preceding the size designation. Example: T145/
80D18 103M.
T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
Since this tire has limited tread life the original equipment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled
on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire.
5
348 STARTING AND OPERATING
Do not install more than one compact spare tire and spare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
first opportunity.
WARNING!
Compact spares are for temporary emergency use
only. With these spares, do not drive more than
50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary use spares have limited
tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear
indicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to be
replaced. Be sure to follow the warnings, which
apply to your spare. Failure to do so could result in
spare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.
Limited-Use Spare – If Equipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency
use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the
limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving
limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the
original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your
vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare
tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
Full Size Spare – If Equipped
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only. first opportunity.
This tire may look like the originally equipped tire on the
front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare
tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn
to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size
STARTING AND OPERATING 349
WARNING!
Limited-use spares are for emergency use only. Installation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle
handling. With this tire, do not drive more than the
speed listed on the limit-use spare wheel. Keep
inflated to the cold tire inflation pressures listed on
your Tire and Loading Information Placard located
on the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the
driver’s side door. Replace (or repair) the original
equipment tire at the first opportunity and reinstall it
on your vehicle. Failure to do so could result in loss
of vehicle control.
Refer to “Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire damage or failure. A tire could explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than
30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
Tread Wear Indicators
Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires
to help you in determining when your tires should be
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not
replaced.
spin your vehicle’s wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or
for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping.
Tire Spinning
5
350 STARTING AND OPERATING
tread wear indicators, the tire should be replaced. Refer
to “Replacement Tires” in this section for further information.
Life Of Tire
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
factors including, but not limited to:
• Driving style
• Tire pressure
• Distance driven
• Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or
higher, and summer tires typically have a reduced
tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle maintenance schedule is highly recommended.
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread
grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth
becomes 1/16 in (2 mm). When the tread is worn to the
1 — Worn Tire
2 — New Tire
STARTING AND OPERATING 351
WARNING!
Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after six
years, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to
follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure.
You could lose control and have a collision resulting
in serious injury or death.
Information placard or the Vehicle Certification Label for
the size designation of your tire. The Load Index and
Speed Symbol for your tire will be found on the original
equipment tire sidewall. See the Tire Sizing Chart example found in the Tire Safety Information section of this
manual for more information relating to the Load Index
and Speed Symbol of a tire.
Keep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two
exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously
affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a
with oil, grease, and gasoline.
wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match
Replacement Tires
those of the original wheels.
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressure. The manufacturer strongly recommends that you use tires equivalent to the originals in size, quality and performance
when replacement is needed. Refer to the paragraph on
“Tread Wear Indicators.” Refer to the Tire and Loading
It is recommended you contact your authorized tire or
original equipment dealer with any questions you may
have on tire specifications or capability. Failure to use
equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the
safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
5
352 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than
that specified for your vehicle. Some combinations
of unapproved tires and wheels may change suspension dimensions and performance characteristics, resulting in changes to steering, handling, and
braking of your vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handling and stress to steering and suspension components. You could lose control and have
a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use
only the tire and wheel sizes with load ratings
approved for your vehicle.
• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or
capacity, other than what was originally equipped
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load
index could result in tire overloading and failure.
You could lose control and have a collision.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having
adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
(Continued)
CAUTION!
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size
may result in false speedometer and odometer readings.
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
Due to limited clearance, tire chains or traction devices
are not recommended.
STARTING AND OPERATING 353
CAUTION!
Damage to the vehicle may result if tire chains are
used.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals. The reasons for any rapid or
unusual wear should be corrected prior to rotation being
performed.
The suggested rotation method is the “rearward cross”
shown in the following diagram. This rotation pattern
The tires on the front and rear of your vehicle operate at does not apply to some directional tires that must not be
different loads and perform different steering, driving, reversed.
and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at
unequal rates.
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires.
The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with
aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type
tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain
mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute to a
smooth, quiet ride.
5
354 STARTING AND OPERATING
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1
psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (6.5°C). This means that when
the outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will
decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on
cold inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire
pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least
three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a
three hour period. The cold tire inflation pressure must
not exceed the maximum inflation pressure molded into
the tire sidewall. Refer to “Tires – General Information”
in “Starting and Operating” for information on how to
properly inflate the vehicle’s tires. The tire pressure will
Tire Rotation
also increase as the vehicle is driven - this is normal and
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM (TPMS)
there should be no adjustment for this increased presThe Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the sure.
driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recom- The TPM System will warn the driver of a low tire
mended cold placard pressure.
pressure if the tire pressure falls below the low-pressure
warning limit for any reason, including low temperature
effects and natural pressure loss through the tire.
STARTING AND OPERATING 355
The TPM System will continue to warn the driver of low
tire pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not
turn off until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended cold placard pressure. Once the low tire pressure
warning (Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light) illuminates, you must increase the tire pressure to the recommended cold placard pressure in order for the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” to turn off. The
system will automatically update and the “Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off once the system
receives the updated tire pressures. The vehicle may need
to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended
cold (parked for more than three hours) placard pressure
of 30 psi (207 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68°F
(20°C) and the measured tire pressure is 27 psi (186 kPa),
a temperature drop to 20°F (-7°C) will decrease the tire
pressure to approximately 23 psi (158 kPa). This tire
pressure is sufficiently low enough to turn ON the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light.” Driving the vehicle
may cause the tire pressure to rise to approximately 27
psi (186 kPa), but the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light” will still be ON. In this situation, the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn OFF only
after the tires are inflated to the vehicle’s recommended
cold placard pressure value.
5
356 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
• The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using
replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
sensor damage. Do not use aftermarket tire sealants
or balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with a
TPMS, as damage to the sensors may result.
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure,
always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will
prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve
stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensor.
NOTE:
• The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care
and maintenance, or to provide warning of a tire
failure or condition.
• The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge
while adjusting your tire pressure.
• Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire
tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
• The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure using an accurate tire pressure
gauge, even if under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light.”
STARTING AND OPERATING 357
• Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure, Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in
the tire.
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
illuminate in the instrument cluster, a ⬙LOW
Base System
TIRE⬙ message will be displayed for a minimum of five
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
seconds and a chime will sound when tire pressure is low
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
in one or more of the four active road tires. An ⬙Inflate to
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each
XX⬙ message will also be displayed. Should this occur,
wheel as part of the valve stem, transmit tire pressure
you should stop as soon as possible, check the inflation
readings to the Receiver Module.
pressure of each tire on your vehicle, and inflate each tire
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard pressure
tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly value as shown in the ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message. Once the
and to maintain the proper pressure.
system receives the updated tire pressures, the system
will automatically update and the “Tire Pressure MoniThe TPMS consists of the following components:
toring Telltale Light” and ⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message will turn
• Receiver Module
off. The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20
minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors
to receive this information.
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
5
358 STARTING AND OPERATING
Check TPMS Warning
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will flash on NOTE:
and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid when a
system fault is detected. The system fault will also sound a 1. The compact spare tire (if equipped) does not have a
tire pressure monitoring sensor. Therefore, the TPMS
chime. If the ignition key is cycled, this sequence will
will not monitor the pressure in the compact spare tire.
repeat, providing the system fault still exists. The “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off when the 2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
fault condition no longer exists. A system fault can occur
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warndue to any of the following:
ing limit, upon the next ignition key cycle, a chime will
sound and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
1. Jamming due to electronic devices or driving next to
Light” will turn ON and a ⬙LOW TIRE⬙ message will
facilities emitting the same Radio Frequencies as the
be displayed for a minimum of five seconds. An
TPM sensors.
⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message will also be displayed.
2. Installing some form of aftermarket window tinting
3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
that affects radio wave signals.
15 mph (24 km/h), the “Tire Pressure Monitoring
3. Lots of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel
Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
housings.
then remain on solid.
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 359
4. For each subsequent ignition key cycle, a chime will
sound and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then
remain on solid.
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire, and
reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare,
the TPMS will update automatically and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn OFF, as long no
tire pressure is below the low-pressure warning limit in
any of the four active road tires. The vehicle may need to
be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h)
in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
Premium System – If Equipped
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the
tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly
and to maintain the proper pressure.
The TPMS consists of the following components:
• Receiver Module
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors
• Three Trigger Modules (mounted in three of the four
wheel-wells)
• Various Tire Pressure Monitoring System Messages,
which display in the Electronic Vehicle Information
Center (EVIC)
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
wheel as part of the valve stem, transmit tire pressure
illuminate in the instrument cluster and a chime
readings to the Receiver Module.
will sound when tire pressure is low in one or
5
360 STARTING AND OPERATING
more of the four active road tires. In addition, the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display
a graphic showing the pressure values of each tire with
the low tire pressure values flashing. An ⬙Inflate to XX⬙
message will also be displayed.
Check TPMS Warning
When a system fault is detected, a chime will sound and
the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will flash on
and off for 75 seconds and then remain on solid. In
addition, the EVIC will display a ⬙CHECK TPM SYSShould this occur, you should stop as soon as possible, TEM⬙ message for a minimum of five seconds and then
and inflate all tires with low pressure (those flashing in display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value to
the EVIC graphic) to the vehicle’s recommended cold indicate which sensor is not being received.
placard pressure value as shown in the ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ If the ignition key is cycled, this sequence will repeat,
message. Once the system receives the updated tire providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault
pressures, the system will automatically update, the no longer exists, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
graphic display in the EVIC will stop flashing, and the Light” will no longer flash, and the ⬙CHECK TPM
“Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off. SYSTEM⬙ message will no longer display, and a pressure
The vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes value will display in place of the dashes. A system fault
above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive can occur due to any of the following:
this information.
1. Jamming due to electronic devices or driving next to
facilities emitting the same Radio Frequencies as the
TPM sensors.
STARTING AND OPERATING 361
2. Installing some form of aftermarket window tinting NOTE:
that affects radio wave signals.
1. The compact spare tire (if so equipped) does not have
a tire pressure monitoring sensor. Therefore, the TPMS
3. Lots of snow or ice around the wheels or wheel
will not monitor the pressure in the compact spare tire.
housings.
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning limit, upon the next ignition key cycle, the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will remain ON, a
chime will sound, and the EVIC will still display a
flashing pressure value and the ⬙Inflate to XX⬙ message in the graphic display.
The EVIC will also display a ⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙
message for a minimum of five seconds when a system
fault related to an incorrect sensor location fault is
detected. In this case, the ⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙ message is then followed with a graphic display with pres3. After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
sure values still shown. This indicates that the pressure
15 mph (24 km/h), the “Tire Pressure Monitoring
values are still being received from the TPM sensors but
Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
they may not be located in the correct vehicle position.
then remain on solid. In addition, the EVIC will
The system still needs to be serviced as long as the
display a ⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙ message for a
⬙CHECK TPM SYSTEM⬙ message is displayed.
minimum of five seconds and then display dashes (- -)
in place of the pressure value.
5
362 STARTING AND OPERATING
4. For each subsequent ignition key cycle, a chime will
sound, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light”
will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on
solid, and the EVIC will display a ⬙CHECK TPM
SYSTEM⬙ message for a minimum of five seconds and
then display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value.
General Information
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire, and • This device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired opreinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare,
eration.
the TPMS will update automatically. In addition, the
“Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn The tire pressure sensors are covered under one of the
OFF and the graphic in the EVIC will display a new following licenses:
pressure value instead of dashes (- -), as long no tire
KR5S18002015B
pressure is below the low-pressure warning limit in United States
any of the four active road tires. The vehicle may need Canada
267T-S180015B
to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this
information.
STARTING AND OPERATING 363
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
Over 40 auto manufacturers worldwide have issued and
endorsed consistent gasoline specifications (the Worldwide Fuel Charter, WWFC) which define fuel properties
necessary to deliver enhanced emissions, performance,
and durability for your vehicle. The manufacturer recommends the use of gasolines that meet the WWFC specifications if they are available.
This engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide excellent
fuel economy and performance when using high-quality unleaded “regular” gasoline having an octane rating of 87. The use
of premium gasoline is not recommended, as it will not Reformulated Gasoline
provide any benefit over regular gasoline in these
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner
engines.
burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline.”
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to Reformulated gasolines contain oxygenates and are speyour engine. However, continued heavy spark knock at cifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and imhigh speeds can cause damage and immediate service is prove air quality.
required. Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gasoas hard starting, stalling, and hesitations. If you experi- lines. Properly blended reformulated gasolines will proence these symptoms, try another brand of gasoline vide excellent performance and durability of engine and
before considering service for the vehicle.
fuel system components.
5
364 STARTING AND OPERATING
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxy- Non-Flex Fuel Vehicle (FFV) is compatible with gasoline
genates such as Ethanol. Fuels blended with oxygenates containing 10% ethanol (E10). Gasoline with higher ethamay be used in your vehicle.
nol content may void the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
CAUTION!
DO NOT use gasoline containing Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol. Use of these
blends may result in starting and drivability problems, damage critical fuel system components, cause
emissions to exceed the applicable standard, and/or
cause the “Malfunction Indicator Light” to illuminate. Pump labels should clearly communicate if a
fuel contains greater than 10% Ethanol.
If a Non-FFV vehicle is inadvertently fueled with E-85
fuel, the engine will have some or all of these symptoms:
• Operate in a lean mode.
• OBD II “Malfunction Indicator Light” on.
• Poor engine performance.
• Poor cold start and cold drivability.
• Increased risk for fuel system component corrosion.
To fix a Non-FFV vehicle inadvertently fueled once with
Problems that result from using gasoline containing E-85 perform the following:
Methanol or gasoline containing more than 10% Ethanol
• Drain the fuel tank (see your authorized dealer.)
are not the responsibility of the manufacturer and may
• Change the engine oil and oil filter.
not be covered under New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
STARTING AND OPERATING 365
• Disconnect and reconnect the battery to reset the Materials Added To Fuel
engine controller memory.
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to
More extensive repairs will be required for prolonged contain effective detergent additives. Use of additional
detergents or other additives is not needed under normal
exposure to E-85 fuel.
conditions and they would result in additional cost.
MMT In Gasoline
Therefore, you should not have to add anything to the
MMT (Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl) fuel.
is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is
Fuel System Cautions
blended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasoline
blended with MMT provides no performance advantage
CAUTION!
beyond gasoline of the same octane number without
MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduces spark plug Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle’s
life and reduces emissions system performance in some performance:
vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that gasoline • The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law.
without MMT be used in your vehicle. The MMT content
Using leaded gasoline can impair engine perforof gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump,
mance and damage the emissions control system.
therefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether
the gasoline contains MMT. MMT is prohibited in Federal
(Continued)
and California reformulated gasoline.
5
366 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
• An out-of-tune engine or certain fuel or ignition
malfunctions can cause the catalytic converter to
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or
some light smoke, your engine may be out of tune
or malfunctioning and may require immediate service. Contact your authorized dealer for service
assistance.
• The use of fuel additives, which are now being
sold as octane enhancers, is not recommended.
Most of these products contain high concentrations
of methanol. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such
fuels or additives is not the responsibility of the
manufacturer.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with the emissions control
system can result in civil penalties being assessed against
you.
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.
Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon
monoxide poisoning:
• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbon
monoxide, a colorless and odorless gas, which can
kill. Never run the engine in a closed area, such as
a garage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running for an extended period. If the
vehicle is stopped in an open area with the engine
running for more than a short period, adjust the
ventilation system to force fresh, outside air into
the vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 367
WARNING! (Continued)
• Guard against carbon monoxide with proper maintenance. Have the exhaust system inspected every
time the vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal
conditions repaired promptly. Until repaired, drive
with all side windows fully open.
FLEXIBLE FUEL (3.6L ENGINE ONLY) — IF
EQUIPPED
5
E-85 General Information
The information in this section is for Flexible Fuel vehicles only. These vehicles can be identified by a unique
fuel filler door label that states Ethanol (E-85) or Unleaded Gasoline Only. This section only covers those
subjects that are unique to these vehicles. Please refer to
the other sections of this manual for information on
features that are common between Flexible Fuel and
gasoline-only powered vehicles.
E-85 Fuel Cap
CAUTION!
Only vehicles with the E-85 fuel filler door label can
operate on E-85.
368 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Ethanol vapors are extremely flammable and could
cause serious personal injury. Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the vehicle when removing the fuel filler tube cap (gas cap) or filling the
tank. Do not use E-85 as a cleaning agent and never
use it near an open flame.
Fuel Requirements
E-85 Badge
Ethanol Fuel (E-85)
If your vehicle is E-85 compatible, it will operate on
unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of 87, or E-85
fuel, or any mixture of these two fuels.
For best results, a refueling pattern that avoids alternatE-85 is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and ing between E-85 and unleaded gasoline is recom15% unleaded gasoline.
mended.
STARTING AND OPERATING 369
When you do switch fuel types it is recommended that:
• You do not add less than 5 gallons (19 Liters) when
refueling.
engine. To eliminate driveability issues that may be
caused by these deposits, a supplemental gasoline
additive, such as MOPAR® Injector Cleanup or
Techron may be used.
• You drive the vehicle immediately after refueling for at
Selection Of Engine Oil For Flexible Fuel Vehicles
least 5 miles (8 km).
(E-85) And Gasoline Vehicles
Observing these precautions will avoid possible hard
FFV vehicles operated on E-85 require specially formustarting and/or significant deterioration in driveability
lated engine oils. These special requirements are included
during warm up.
in MOPAR® engine oils, and in equivalent oils meeting
Chrysler Specification MS-6395. The manufacturer only
NOTE:
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
• Use seasonally adjusted E-85 fuel (ASTM D5798). With
the requirements of Material Standard MS-6395. MS-6395
non-seasonally adjusted E-85 fuel, you may experience
contains additional requirements, developed during exhard starting and rough idle following start up even if
tensive fleet testing, to provide additional protection to
the above recommendations are followed, especially
Chrysler Group LLC engines. Use MOPAR® or an
when the ambient temperature is below 32°F (0°C).
equivalent oil meeting the specification MS-6395.
• Some additives used in regular gasoline are not fully
compatible with E-85 and may form deposits in your
5
370 STARTING AND OPERATING
Starting
Replacement Parts
The characteristics of E-85 fuel make it unsuitable for use
when ambient temperatures fall below 0°F (-18°C). In the
range of 0°F (-18°C) to 32°F (0°C), you may experience an
increase in the time it takes for your engine to start, and
a deterioration in driveability (sags and/or hesitations)
until the engine is fully warmed up.
Many components in your Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV) are
designed to be compatible with ethanol. Always be sure
that your vehicle is serviced with correct ethanol compatible parts.
NOTE: Use of the engine block heater (if equipped) is
beneficial for E-85 startability when the ambient temperature is less than 32°F (0°C).
Replacing fuel system components with non-ethanol
compatible components can damage your vehicle.
Cruising Range
Because E-85 fuel contains less energy per gallon/liter
than gasoline, you will experience an increase in fuel
consumption. You can expect your miles per gallon
(mpg)/miles per liter and your driving range to decrease
by about 30%, compared to gasoline operation.
CAUTION!
Maintenance
CAUTION!
Do not use ethanol mixture greater than 85% in your
vehicle. It will cause difficulty in cold starting and
may affect drivability.
STARTING AND OPERATING 371
ADDING FUEL
Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap)
The gas cap is behind the fuel filler door, on the left rear
quarter panel of the vehicle. If the gas cap is lost or
damaged, be sure the replacement cap is for use with this
vehicle.
5
Fuel Filler Door
After removing the gas cap, place the gas cap tether cable
over a hook on the inside of the fuel door. This keeps the
gas cap suspended away from and protects the vehicle’s
surface.
372 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
• Damage to the fuel system or emission control
system could result from using an improper fuel
tank filler tube cap (gas cap).
• A poorly fitting gas cap may cause the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” to turn on.
• To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “top
off” the fuel tank after filling. When the fuel
nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank is full.
Tether Cable
NOTE: If the gas cap is lost or damaged, be sure the
replacement cap is for use with this vehicle.
WARNING!
• Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the
vehicle when the gas cap is removed or the tank is
being filled.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 373
WARNING! (Continued)
Loose Filler Cap Message
If the vehicles diagnostic system determines that the fuel
filler cap in loose, improperly installed, or damaged, a
“gASCAP” message will be displayed in the instrument
cluster. Tighten the gas cap until a “clicking” sound is
heard. This is an indication that the gas cap is properly
tightened. Press the trip odometer reset button to turn off
the message. If the problem persists, the message will
appear the next time the vehicle is started. This might
indicate a damaged cap. If the problem is detected twice
NOTE:
in a row, the system will turn on the MIL. Resolving the
• Tighten the gas cap until you hear a “clicking” sound. problem will turn the MIL off.
This is an indication that the gas cap is tightened
properly. The MIL in the instrument cluster may turn VEHICLE LOADING
on if the gas cap is not secured properly. Make sure
that the gas cap is tightened each time the vehicle is Vehicle Certification Label
refueled.
Your vehicle has a Vehicle Certification Label affixed to
the drivers side “B” Pillar or the rear of the driver’s door.
• When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank
is full.
• Never add fuel when the engine is running. This is
in violation of most state and federal fire regulations and doing so may cause the MIL to turn on.
• A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into a
portable container that is inside of a vehicle. You
could be burned. Always place gas containers on
the ground while filling.
5
374 STARTING AND OPERATING
The label contains the following information:
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
• Name of manufacturer
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear
axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles
evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or
rear GAWR.
• Month and year of manufacture
• Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
• Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) front
WARNING!
• Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) rear
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
• Type of Vehicle
• Month Day and Hour of Manufacture (MDH)
The bar code allows a computer scanner to read the VIN.
Because the front wheels steer the vehicle, it is
important that you do not exceed the maximum front
or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving condition can
result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose
control of the vehicle and have a collision.
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
Overloading
The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.
This includes driver, passengers, and cargo. The total
load must be limited so that you do not exceed the
GVWR.
The load carrying components (axle, springs, tires,
wheels, etc.) of your vehicle will provide satisfactory
service as long as you do not exceed the GVWR and the
front and rear GAWR.
STARTING AND OPERATING 375
The best way to figure out the total weight of your
vehicle is to weigh it when it is fully loaded and ready for
operation. Weigh it on a commercial scale to ensure that
it is not over the GVWR.
the specified GVWR, you must redistribute the weight.
Improper weight distribution can have an adverse effect
on the way your vehicle steers and handles and the way
the brakes operate.
Figure out the weight on the front and rear of the vehicle TRAILER TOWING
separately. It is important that you distribute the load
In this section you will find safety tips and information
evenly over the front and rear axles.
on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do
Overloading can cause potential safety hazards and with your vehicle. Before towing a trailer, carefully
shorten useful service life. Heavier axles or suspension review this information to tow your load as efficiently
components do not necessarily increase the vehicle’s and safely as possible.
GVWR.
To maintain the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage,
Loading
follow the requirements and recommendations in this
To load your vehicle properly, first figure out its empty manual concerning vehicles used for trailer towing.
weight, axle-by-axle and side-by-side. Store heavier items
down low and be sure you distribute their weight as
evenly as possible. Stow all loose items securely before
driving. If weighing the loaded vehicle shows that you
have exceeded either GAWR, but the total load is within
5
376 STARTING AND OPERATING
measure GTW is to put your fully loaded trailer on a
vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailer must be
The following trailer towing related definitions will assist
supported by the scale.
you in understanding the following information:
Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR)
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
Common Towing Definitions
The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.
This includes driver, passengers, cargo and tongue
weight. The total load must be limited so that you do not
exceed the GVWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle
Certification Label” in “Starting and Operating” for
further information.
The GCWR is the total permissible weight of your vehicle
and trailer when weighed in combination.
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rear
axles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axles
evenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front or
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW)
rear GAWR. Refer to “Vehicle Loading/Vehicle CertificaThe GTW is the weight of the trailer plus the weight of all tion Label” in “Starting and Operating” for further
cargo, consumables and equipment (permanent or tem- information.
porary) loaded in or on the trailer in its ⬙loaded and
ready for operation⬙ condition. The recommended way to
STARTING AND OPERATING 377
WARNING!
It is important that you do not exceed the maximum
front or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving condition
can result if either rating is exceeded. You could lose
control of the vehicle and have a collision.
Frontal Area
The frontal area is the maximum height multiplied by the
maximum width of the front of a trailer.
Weight-Carrying Hitch
A weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongue
weight, just as if it were luggage located at a hitch ball or
Tongue Weight (TW)
some other connecting point of the vehicle. These kinds
The tongue weight is the downward force exerted on the of hitches are the most popular on the market today and
hitch ball by the trailer. In most cases it should not be less they are commonly used to tow small and medium sized
than 10% of the trailer load. You must consider this as trailers.
part of the load on your vehicle.
5
378 STARTING AND OPERATING
Trailer Hitch Classification
The following chart provides the industry standard for
the maximum trailer weight a given trailer hitch class can
tow and should be used to assist you in selecting the
correct trailer hitch for your intended towing condition.
Trailer Hitch Classification Definitions
Class
Max. Trailer Hitch Industry Standards
I - Light Duty
2,000 lbs (907 kg)
II - Medium Duty
3,500 lbs (1 587 kg)
III - Heavy Duty
5,000 lbs (2 268 kg)
IV - Extra Heavy
10,000 lbs (4 540 kg)
Class
Class
Class
Class
Duty
Refer to the “Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum
Trailer Weight Ratings)” chart for the Maximum
Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) towable for your given
drivetrain.
All trailer hitches should be professionally installed
on your vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 379
Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings)
The following chart provides the maximum trailer weight ratings towable for your given drivetrain.
Engine/Transmission
2.4L/Auto
3.6L/Auto
Max. Frontal Area
Max. Gross Trailer Wt.
(GTW)
1,000 lbs (450 kg)
11 sq.ft. (1.0 sq.m) (See
Note 2)
22 sq.ft. (2.0 sq.m)
1,000 lbs (450 kg)
Refer to local laws for maximum trailer towing speeds.
Note 1: The trailer tongue weight must be considered as
part of the combined weight of occupants and cargo,
and it should never exceed the weight referenced on the
Tire and Loading Information placard. Refer to “Tire
Safety Information” in “Starting and Operating” for
further information.
Max. Trailer Tongue Wt.
(See Note 1)
100 lbs (45 kg)
100 lbs (45 kg)
all four-cylinder engines with automatic transmission.
Please see your authorized dealer for additional information.
Trailer And Tongue Weight
Always load a trailer with 60% to 65% of the weight in
the front of the trailer. This places 10% to 15% of the
Note 2: Enclosed trailers or open utility trailers with Gross Trailer Weight (GTW) on the tow hitch of your
front shields/guards are not recommended for use with vehicle. Loads balanced over the wheels or heavier in the
5
380 STARTING AND OPERATING
rear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to side Consider the following items when computing the
which will cause loss of control of the vehicle and trailer. weight on the rear axle of the vehicle:
Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause of • The tongue weight of the trailer.
many trailer collisions.
• The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment
Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped on
put in or on your vehicle.
your bumper or trailer hitch.
• The weight of the driver and all passengers.
NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on the
trailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also, additional
factory-installed options or dealer-installed options must
be considered as part of the total load on your vehicle.
Refer to the “Tire and Loading Information” placard for
the maximum combined weight of occupants and cargo
for your vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 381
Towing Requirements
To promote proper break-in of your new vehicle drivetrain components the following guidelines are recommended:
CAUTION!
• Do not tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles
(805 km) the new vehicle is driven. The engine, axle
or other parts could be damaged.
• Then, during the first 500 miles (805 km) that a
trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h)
and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps
the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at
the heavier loads.
WARNING!
Improper towing can lead to a collision. Follow these
guidelines to make your trailer towing as safe as
possible:
• Make certain that the load is secured in the trailer
and it will not shift during travel. When trailering
cargo that is not fully secured, dynamic load shifts
can occur that may be difficult for the driver to
control. You could lose control of your vehicle and
have a collision.
• When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not
overload your vehicle or trailer. Overloading can
cause a loss of control, poor performance, or damage to brakes, axle, engine, transmission, steering,
suspension, chassis structure, or tires.
(Continued)
5
382 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Safety chains must always be used between your
vehicle and trailer. Always connect the chains to
the frame or hook retainers of the vehicle hitch.
Cross the chains under the trailer tongue and allow
enough slack for turning corners.
• Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a
grade. When parking, apply the parking brake on
the tow vehicle. Put the tow vehicle automatic
transmission in PARK. Always, block or ⴖchockⴖ
the trailer wheels.
• GCWR must not be exceeded.
• Total weight must be distributed between the tow
vehicle and the trailer such that the following four
ratings are not exceeded:
(Continued)
1. Max loading as defined on the “Tire and Loading
Information” placard.
2. GTW
3. GAWR
4. Tongue weight rating for the trailer hitch utilized.
Towing Requirements – Tires
• Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact
spare tire.
• Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safe
and satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Refer to
STARTING AND OPERATING 383
“Tires – General Information” in “Starting and Oper- Towing Requirements – Trailer Brakes
ating” for proper tire inflation procedures.
• Do not interconnect the hydraulic brake system or
vacuum system of your vehicle with that of the trailer.
• Check the trailer tires for proper tire inflation presThis could cause inadequate braking and possible
sures before trailer usage.
personal injury.
• Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damage
before towing a trailer. Refer to “Tires – General • An electronically actuated trailer brake controller is
required when towing a trailer with electronically
Information” in “Starting and Operating” for the
actuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped with
proper inspection procedure.
a hydraulic surge actuated brake system, an electronic
• When replacing tires, refer to “Tires – General Inforbrake controller is not required.
mation” in “Starting and Operating” for the proper tire
replacement procedures. Replacing tires with a higher • Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over
1,000 lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in excess of
load carrying capacity will not increase the vehicle’s
2,000 lbs (907 kg).
GVWR and GAWR limits.
5
384 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
WARNING! (Continued)
If the trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg)
loaded, it should have its own brakes and they
should be of adequate capacity. Failure to do this
could lead to accelerated brake lining wear, higher
brake pedal effort, and longer stopping distances.
• Towing any trailer will increase your stopping
distance. When towing you should allow for additional space between your vehicle and the vehicle
in front of you. Failure to do so could result in a
collision.
Towing Requirements – Trailer Lights And Wiring
WARNING!
• Do not connect trailer brakes to your vehicle’s
hydraulic brake lines. It can overload your brake
system and cause it to fail. You might not have
brakes when you need them and could have a
collision.
(Continued)
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size,
stop lights and turn signals on the trailer are required for
motoring safety.
The Trailer Tow Package may include a four-pin and
seven-pin wiring harness. Use a factory approved trailer
harness and connector.
NOTE: Do not cut or splice wiring into the vehicle’s
wiring harness.
STARTING AND OPERATING 385
The electrical connections are all complete to the vehicle,
but you must mate the harness to a trailer connector.
Refer to the following illustrations.
5
1 — Female Pins
2 — Male Pin
3 — Ground
4 — Park
5 — Left Stop/Turn
6 — Right Stop/Turn
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Battery
Backup Lamps
Right Stop/Turn
Electric Brakes
5 — Ground
6 — Left Stop/Turn
7 — Running Lamps
386 STARTING AND OPERATING
If you REGULARLY TOW a trailer for more than 45
minutes of continuous operation, then change the autoBefore setting out on a trip, practice turning, stopping,
matic transmission fluid and filter as specified for “poand backing up the trailer in an area located away from
lice, taxi, fleet, or frequent trailer towing.” Refer to the
heavy traffic.
“Maintenance Schedule” for the proper maintenance
Automatic Transmission
intervals.
Towing Tips
The DRIVE range can be selected when towing. However, if frequent shifting occurs while in DRIVE, select the
⬙3⬙ range (with four-speed transmission) or select a lower
gear using the AutoStick® shift control (with six-speed
transmission).
NOTE: Check the transmission fluid level (four-speed
transmission only) before towing. The six-speed transmission does not require a fluid level check before
towing. If, however, you notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunction, see your authorized dealer immediNOTE: Using a lower gear while operating the vehicle ately for assistance.
under heavy loading conditions, will improve perfor- AutoStick®
mance and extend transmission life by reducing exces– When using the AutoStick® shift control, select the
sive shifting and heat build-up. This action will also
highest gear that allows for adequate performance and
provide better engine braking.
avoids frequent downshifts. For example, choose “4” if
the desired speed can be maintained. Choose “3” or
“2” if needed to maintain the desired speed.
STARTING AND OPERATING 387
– To prevent excess heat generation, avoid continuous
driving at high RPM. Reduce vehicle speed as necessary to avoid extended driving at high RPM. Return to
a higher gear or vehicle speed when grade and road
conditions allow.
Cooling System
Electronic Speed Control – If Equipped
When stopped for short periods of time, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and increase engine idle speed.
• Do not use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.
To reduce potential for engine and transmission overheating, take the following actions:
City Driving
Highway Driving
• When using the speed control, if you experience speed
drops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), disengage until Reduce speed.
you can get back to cruising speed.
Air Conditioning
• Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads to
Turn off temporarily.
maximize fuel efficiency.
5
388 STARTING AND OPERATING
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Dolly Tow
On Trailer
Wheels OFF the Ground
NONE
Front
Rear
ALL
All Models
NOT ALLOWED
OK
NOT ALLOWED
OK
STARTING AND OPERATING 389
Recreational Towing – All Models
Recreational towing is allowed ONLY if the front wheels
are OFF the ground. This may be accomplished using a
tow dolly or vehicle trailer. If using a tow dolly, follow
this procedure:
1. Properly secure the dolly to the tow vehicle, following
the dolly manufacturer’s instructions.
2. Drive the front wheels onto the tow dolly.
3. Firmly apply the parking brake. Place the transmission in PARK.
4. Properly secure the front wheels to the dolly, following
the dolly manufacturer’s instructions.
5. Release the parking brake.
CAUTION!
• DO NOT flat tow this vehicle. Damage to the
drivetrain will result.
• Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage.
Damage from improper towing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
5
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
䡵 HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS . . . . . . . . . . .392
▫ Road Tire Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .403
䡵 IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS . . . . . . . . . . . .392 䡵 JUMP-STARTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
▫ Engine Oil Overheating (2.4L Engine Only) —
If Equipped. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
䡵 JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Spare Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Preparations For Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
▫ Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .396
▫ Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
▫ Jump-Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .408
䡵 FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
䡵 SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
䡵 TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . .413
▫ Without The Ignition Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
6
392 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located on the In any of the following situations, you can reduce the
instrument panel, below the radio.
potential for overheating by taking the appropriate action.
Press the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning
flasher. When the switch is activated, all direc- • On the highways — Slow down.
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming • In city traffic — While stopped, put transaxle in
traffic of an emergency. Press the switch a second time to
NEUTRAL, but do not increase engine idle speed.
turn off the Hazard Warning flashers.
This is an emergency warning system and it should not
be used when the vehicle is in motion. Use it when your
vehicle is disabled and it is creating a safety hazard for
other motorists.
When you must leave the vehicle to seek assistance, the
Hazard Warning flashers will continue to operate even
though the ignition is placed in the OFF position.
NOTE: With extended use the Hazard Warning flashers
may wear down your battery.
CAUTION!
Driving with a hot cooling system could damage
your vehicle. If temperature gauge reads “H”, pull
over and stop the vehicle with the engine at idle,
when safe. Turn the air conditioner off and wait until
the pointer drops back into the normal range. After
appropriate action has been taken, if the pointer
remains on the “H”, turn the engine off immediately,
and call for service.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 393
NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down Engine Oil Overheating (2.4L Engine Only) — If
an impending overheat condition:
Equipped
• If your air conditioner (A/C) is on, turn it off. The A/C During sustained high-speed driving or trailer tow up
system adds heat to the engine cooling system and long grades on a hot day, the engine oil temperature may
become too hot. If this happens, the “HOTOIL” message
turning the A/C off can help remove this heat.
• You can also turn the temperature control to maximum flashes in the odometer and the vehicle speed will be
heat, the mode control to floor and the blower control reduced to 53 mph (85 km/h) until the engine oil
to high. This allows the heater core to act as a temperature is reduced.
supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat NOTE: The vehicle speed is reduced to a maximum of
from the engine cooling system.
53 mph (85 km/h). You may of course, reduce your
vehicle speed further if needed.
WARNING!
You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If you
see or hear steam coming from under the hood, do not
open the hood until the radiator has had time to cool.
Never try to open a cooling system pressure cap when
the radiator or coolant bottle is hot.
6
394 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
• Being under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous. The
vehicle could slip off the jack and fall on you. You
could be crushed. Never put any part of your body
under a vehicle that is on a jack. If you need to get
under a raised vehicle, take it to a service center
where it can be raised on a lift.
• Never start or run the engine while the vehicle is
on a jack.
(Continued)
• The jack is designed to be used as a tool for
changing tires only. The jack should not be used to
lift the vehicle for service purposes. The vehicle
should be jacked on a firm level surface only.
Avoid ice or slippery areas.
Jack Location
The jack and jack-handle are stowed under the load floor
in the trunk.
Spare Tire Stowage
The compact spare tire is stowed under the rear load floor
in the trunk.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 395
Spare Tire Removal
Preparations For Jacking
Lift up the load floor cover and remove the hold down.
1. Park the vehicle on a firm, level surface. Avoid ice or
slippery areas.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic, pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
2. Turn on the Hazard Warning flashers.
3. Set the parking brake.
Spare Tire And Jack Storage
4. Place the shift lever into PARK (automatic transmission) or REVERSE (manual transmission).
6
396 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
5. Turn OFF the ignition.
6. Block both the front and rear of the wheel diagonally
opposite the jacking position. For
example, if changing the right front
tire, block the left rear wheel.
NOTE: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle
while the vehicle is being jacked.
Jacking Instructions
WARNING!
Carefully follow these tire changing warnings to help
prevent personal injury or damage to your vehicle:
• Always park on a firm, level surface as far from the
edge of the roadway as possible before raising the
vehicle.
• Turn on the Hazard Warning flashers.
• Block the wheel diagonally opposite the wheel to
be raised.
• Set the parking brake firmly and set an automatic
transmission in PARK; a manual transmission in
REVERSE.
• Never start or run the engine with the vehicle on a
jack.
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 397
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not let anyone sit in the vehicle when it is on a
jack.
• Do not get under the vehicle when it is on a jack. If
you need to get under a raised vehicle, take it to a
service center where it can be raised on a lift.
• Only use the jack in the positions indicated and for
lifting this vehicle during a tire change.
• If working on or near a roadway, be extremely
careful of motor traffic.
• To assure that spare tires, flat or inflated, are
securely stowed, spares must be stowed with the
valve stem facing the ground.
Jack Warning Label
CAUTION!
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on
locations other than those indicated in the Jacking
Instructions for this vehicle.
NOTE: Refer to the Compact Spare Tire section of Tires-General Information--for information about the spare
tire, its use, and operation.
6
398 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
1. Remove the scissors jack and lug wrench from the
spare wheel as an assembly. Turn the jack screw to the
left to loosen the lug wrench, and remove the wrench
from the jack assembly.
NOTE: The jack handle attaches to the side of the jack
with two attachment points. When the jack is partially
expanded, the tension between the two attachment
points holds the jack handle in place.
Removing Jack Handle From Jack
2. Loosen, but do not remove, the wheel nuts by turning
them to the left one turn while the wheel is still on the
ground.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 399
CAUTION!
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on
locations other than those indicated in Step 3.
3. There is a front and rear jacking location on each side
of the vehicle. The plastic trim has been cut away to
expose the jacking locations on the body.
6
Front Jacking Location
Jacking Locations
400 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Rear Jacking Location
4. Turn the jack screw to the left until the jack can be
placed under the jacking location. Once the jack is
positioned, turn the jack screw to the right until the
jack head is properly engaged to the jacking location
on the wheel to be changed. Do not raise the vehicle
until you are sure the jack is securely engaged.
Jack Engaged (Front Jacking Location)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 401
5. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the right,
using the swivel wrench. Raise the vehicle only until
the tire just clears the surface and enough clearance is
obtained to install the spare tire. Minimum tire lift
provides maximum stability.
6. Remove the wheel nuts, and pull the wheel and wheel
covers (where applicable) off the hub. Install the spare
wheel and wheel nuts with the cone shaped end of the
nuts toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the nuts.
CAUTION!
Jack Engaged (Rear Jacking Location)
WARNING!
Raising the vehicle higher than necessary can make
the vehicle less stable. It could slip off the jack and
hurt someone near it. Raise the vehicle only enough
to remove the tire.
Be sure to mount the spare tire with the valve stem
facing outward. The vehicle could be damaged if the
spare tire is mounted incorrectly.
6
402 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
• To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning
may result in personal injury.
• To avoid possible personal injury, handle the
wheel covers with care to avoid contact with any
sharp edges.
7. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the left.
Mounting Spare Tire
8. Finish tightening the nuts. Push down on the wrench
while at the end of the handle for increased leverage.
Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until each nut has
been tightened twice. The correct wheel nut torque is
100 ft lbs (135 N·m). If you doubt that you have
tightened the nuts correctly, have them checked with a
torque wrench by your authorized dealer or at a
service station.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 403
9. Lower the jack until it is free. Remove the wheel Road Tire Installation
blocks. Reassemble the lug wrench to the jack assemVehicles Equipped With Wheel Covers
bly and stow it in the spare tire area. Secure the
assembly using the means provided. Release the park- 1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
ing brake before driving the vehicle.
2. To ease the installation process for steel wheels with
wheel covers, install two lug nuts on the mounting
WARNING!
studs which are on each side of the valve stem. Install
the lug nuts with the cone shaped end of the nut
A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision or
toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the lug nuts.
hard stop could endanger the occupants of the vehicle. Always stow the jack parts and the spare tire in
WARNING!
the places provided.
10. Place the deflated (flat) tire in the cargo area and have
the tire repaired or replaced as soon as possible.
11. Check the tire pressure as soon as possible. Correct
the tire pressure as required.
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
6
404 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
3. Align the valve notch in the wheel cover with the
valve stem on the wheel. Install the cover by hand,
snapping the cover over the two lug nuts. Do not use
a hammer or excessive force to install the cover.
4. Install the remaining lug nuts with the cone shaped
end of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the
lug nuts.
WARNING!
Tire And Wheel Cover Or Center Cap
1 — Valve Stem
2 — Valve Notch
3 — Wheel Lug Nut
4 — Wheel Cover
5 — Mounting Stud
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
5. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
handle counterclockwise.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 405
6. Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the
WARNING!
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
each nut has been tightened twice. The correct tight- do not tighten the wheel nuts fully until the vehicle
ness of each lug nut is 100 ft/lbs (135 N·m). If in doubt has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
about the correct tightness, have them checked with a result in personal injury.
torque wrench by your authorized dealer or service
3. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
station.
handle counterclockwise.
7. After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut torque with a
torque wrench to ensure that all lug nuts are properly 4. Finish tightening the lug nuts. Push down on the
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
seated against the wheel.
leverage. Tighten the lug nuts in a star pattern until
Vehicles Without Wheel Covers
each nut has been tightened twice. The correct tightness of each lug nut is 100 ft/lbs (135 N·m). If in doubt
1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
about the correct tightness, have them checked with a
2. Install the remaining lug nuts with the cone shaped
torque wrench by your authorized dealer or service
end of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the
station.
lug nuts.
6
406 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
5. After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut torque with a
torque wrench to ensure that all lug nuts are properly
seated against the wheel.
JUMP-STARTING
If your vehicle has a discharged battery it can be jumpstarted using a set of jumper cables and a battery in
another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster
pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly
so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
CAUTION!
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system voltage greater
than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, starter motor,
alternator or electrical system may occur.
WARNING!
Do not attempt jump-starting if the battery is frozen.
It could rupture or explode and cause personal injury.
NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack
follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions and Preparations For Jump-Start
precautions.
The battery in your vehicle is located between the left
front headlight assembly and the left front wheel splash
shield. To allow jump-starting there are remote battery
posts located on the left side of the engine compartment.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 407
WARNING!
Remote Battery Posts
1 — Remote Positive (+) Post (covered with protective cap)
2 — Remote Negative (-) Post
• Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be injured by
moving fan blades.
• Remove any metal jewelry such as rings, watch
bands and bracelets that could make an inadvertent
electrical contact. You could be seriously injured.
• Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn your
skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas which is
flammable and explosive. Keep open flames or
sparks away from the battery.
1. Set the parking brake, shift the automatic transmission
into PARK and turn the ignition to LOCK.
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
6
408 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
3. Remove the protective cover over the remote positive 4. If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park
(+) battery post. To remove the cover, press the locking
the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the
tab and pull upward on the cover.
parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this
could establish a ground connection and personal
injury could result.
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Locking Tab
Failure to follow this procedure could result in personal injury or property damage due to battery explosion.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 409
CAUTION!
WARNING!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
damage to the charging system of the booster vehicle
or the discharged vehicle.
Do not connect the cable to the negative post (-) of the
discharged battery. The resulting electrical spark
could cause the battery to explode and could result in
personal injury.
1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the
remote positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
5. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
start the engine in the vehicle with the discharged
cable to the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
battery.
3. Connect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable to the Once the engine is started, remove the jumper cables in
negative (-) post of the booster battery.
the reverse sequence:
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper 6. Disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable from the
cable to the remote negative (-) post of the vehicle with
remote negative (-) post of the vehicle with the disthe discharged battery.
charged battery.
7. Disconnect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable
from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
6
410 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
8. Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable from the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
9. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable
from the remote positive (+) post of the discharged
vehicle.
CAUTION! (Continued)
the vehicle’s battery will discharge sufficiently to
degrade battery life and/or prevent the engine from
starting.
10. Reinstall the protective cover over the remote posi- FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
tive (+) battery post of the discharged vehicle.
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand, or snow, it
If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle, can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the
you should have the battery and charging system in- steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the
front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE
spected at your authorized dealer.
and REVERSE, while gently pressing the accelerator. Use
the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure that will
CAUTION!
maintain the rocking motion, without spinning the
Accessories plugged into the vehicle power outlets wheels, or racing the engine.
draw power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not
in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough without engine operation,
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 411
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
Racing the engine or spinning the wheels may lead to
transmission overheating and failure. Allow the engine to idle with the transmission in NEUTRAL for at
least one minute after every five rocking-motion
cycles. This will minimize overheating and reduce
the risk of transmission failure during prolonged
efforts to free a stuck vehicle.
• When “rocking” a stuck vehicle by shifting between DRIVE and REVERSE, do not spin the
wheels faster than 15 mph (24 km/h), or drivetrain
damage may result.
• Revving the engine or spinning the wheels too fast
may lead to transmission overheating and failure.
It can also damage the tires. Do not spin the wheels
above 30 mph (48 km/h) while in gear (no transmission shifting occurring).
NOTE: Press the ⬙ESC Off⬙ switch, to place the Electronic
Stability Control (ESC) system in ⬙Partial Off⬙ mode,
before rocking the vehicle. Refer to “Electronic Brake
Control” in “Starting And Operating” for further information. Once the vehicle has been freed, press the ⬙ESC
Off⬙ switch again to restore ⬙ESC On⬙ mode.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the axle and tires. A tire could
(Continued)
6
412 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING! (Continued)
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for
longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE
4. Turn the ignition to the ACC or ON/RUN position,
but do not start the engine.
5. Press and maintain firm pressure on the brake pedal.
6. Insert a screwdriver or similar tool into the access hole
(at the front of the cupholder) and push and hold the
override release lever forward.
7. Move the shift lever to the NEUTRAL position.
If a malfunction occurs and the shift lever cannot be 8. The vehicle may then be started in NEUTRAL.
moved out of the PARK position, you can use the 9. Reinstall the cupholder liner.
following procedure to temporarily move the shift lever:
1. Turn the engine OFF.
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.
3. Remove the rubber cupholder liner. Squeeze one side
of the liner’s center to expose its edge and facilitate
removal.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 413
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
This section describes procedures for towing a disabled vehicle using a commercial wrecker service.
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Wheel Lift Or Dolly Tow
Wheels OFF the Ground
NONE
Rear
Flatbed
Front
ALL
Proper towing or lifting equipment is required to prevent
damage to your vehicle. Use only tow bars and other
equipment designed for this purpose, following equipment manufacturer’s instructions. Use of safety chains is
mandatory. Attach a tow bar or other towing device to
main structural members of the vehicle, not to bumpers
or associated brackets. State and local laws regarding
vehicles under tow must be observed.
All Models
If transmission is operable:
• Transmission in NEUTRAL
• 25 mph (40 km/h) max speed
• 15 mi (24 km) max distance
OK
BEST METHOD
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.)
while being towed, the ignition must be in the ON/RUN
position, not the ACC position.
If your vehicle’s battery is discharged, refer to ⬙Shift
Lever Override⬙ in this section for instructions on shifting
the transmission out of PARK for towing.
6
414 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
• Do not use sling type equipment when towing.
Damage to the fascia will occur.
• When securing the vehicle to a flatbed truck, do not
attach to front or rear suspension components.
Damage to your vehicle may result from improper
towing.
• Do not push or tow this vehicle with another
vehicle as damage to the bumper fascia and transmission may result.
The manufacturer recommends towing your vehicle with
all four wheels OFF the ground using a flatbed.
If flatbed equipment is not available, and the transmission is operable, the vehicle may be flat towed (with all
four wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:
• The transmission must be in NEUTRAL.
• The towing distance must not exceed 15 mi (24 km).
• The towing speed must not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).
If the transmission is not operable, or the vehicle must
be towed faster than 25 mph (40 km/h) or farther than 15
mi (24 km), it must be towed with the front wheels OFF
the ground (using a flatbed truck, towing dolly, or
wheel lift equipment with the front wheels raised).
CAUTION!
Towing faster than 25 mph (40 km/h) or farther than
15 mi (24 km) with front wheels on the ground can
cause severe transmission damage. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 415
Without The Ignition Key
Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed
with the ignition in the LOCK/OFF position. Flatbed
towing is the preferred towing method. However, if a
flatbed towing vehicle is not available, wheel lift towing
equipment may be used. Rear towing (with the front
wheels on the ground) is not allowed, as transmission
damage will occur. If rear towing is the only alternative,
the front wheels must be placed on a towing dolly. Proper
towing equipment is necessary to prevent damage to the
vehicle.
CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
6
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 2.4L . . . . . . . . . .419
▫ Engine Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L . . . . . . . . . .420
▫ Engine Air Cleaner Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
䡵 ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II . .421
▫ Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
▫ Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . .421
▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
䡵 EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
PROGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .422
▫ A/C Air Filter – If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
䡵 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
䡵 DEALER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
䡵 MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .424
▫ Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
▫ Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
▫ Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .436
▫ Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
7
418 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
▫ Headlamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .446
▫ Front Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
▫ Appearance Care And Protection From
Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
▫ Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
▫ Cleaning Center Console Cupholders. . . . . . . .456
䡵 FUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .457
▫ Integrated Power Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .457
䡵 VEHICLE STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .463
䡵 REPLACEMENT BULBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
䡵 BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
▫ Backup Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .469
▫ License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .470
䡵 FLUID CAPACITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .471
䡵 FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS . .472
▫ Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .472
▫ Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .473
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 419
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 2.4L
7
1
2
3
4
— Engine Coolant Reservoir
— Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
— Automatic Transmission Dipstick
— Brake Fluid Reservoir
5
6
7
8
— Integrated Power Module (Fuses)
— Power Distribution Center (Fuses)
— Air Cleaner Filter
— Engine Oil Fill
9 — Coolant Pressure Cap
10 — Engine Oil Dipstick
11 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
420 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 3.6L
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Engine Coolant Reservoir
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Brake Fluid Reservoir
Integrated Power Module (Fuses)
5
6
7
8
— Air Cleaner Filter
— Engine Oil Dipstick
— Engine Oil Fill
— Washer Fluid Reservoir
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 421
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard
diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors
the performance of the emissions, engine, and automatic
transmission control systems. When these systems are
operating properly, your vehicle will provide excellent
performance and fuel economy, as well as engine emissions well within current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system
will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light” (MIL). It
will also store diagnostic codes and other information to
assist your service technician in making repairs. Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not
need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as
soon as possible.
CAUTION!
• Prolonged driving with the MIL on could cause
further damage to the emission control system. It
could also affect fuel economy and driveability.
The vehicle must be serviced before any emissions
tests can be performed.
• If the MIL is flashing while the engine is running,
severe catalytic converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service is required.
Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message
After fuel is added, the vehicle diagnostic system can
determine if the fuel filler cap is possibly loose or
improperly installed. A “gASCAP” message will be displayed in the instrument cluster. Tighten the gas cap until
a ⬙clicking⬙ sound is heard. This is an indication that the
gas cap is properly tightened. Press the trip odometer
“Reset” button to turn off the message. If the problem
7
422 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
persists, the message will appear the next time the
vehicle is started. This might indicate a damaged cap. If
the problem is detected twice in a row, the system will
turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).” Resolving the problem will turn the MIL light off.
Normally, the OBD II system will be ready. The OBD II
system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently
serviced, recently had a dead battery or a battery replacement. If the OBD II system should be determined not
ready for the I/M test, your vehicle may fail the test.
Your vehicle has a simple ignition key-actuated test,
which you can use prior to going to the test station. To
check if your vehicle’s OBD II system is ready, you must
In some localities, it may be a legal requirement to pass do the following:
an inspection of your vehicle’s emissions control system.
1. Cycle the ignition switch to the ON position, but do
Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.
not crank or start the engine.
For states that require an Inspection and Maintenance (I/M), this check verifies the “Malfunction NOTE: If you crank or start the engine, you will have to
Indicator Light (MIL)” is functioning and is not start this test over.
on when the engine is running, and that the OBD II 2. As soon as you cycle the ignition switch to the ON
system is ready for testing.
position, you will see the MIL symbol come on as part
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
PROGRAMS
of a normal bulb check.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 423
3. Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things will Regardless of whether your vehicle’s OBD II system is
happen:
ready or not, if the MIL is illuminated during normal
vehicle operation you should have your vehicle serviced
• The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then
before going to the I/M station. The I/M station can fail
return to being fully illuminated until you turn OFF
your vehicle because the MIL is on with the engine
the ignition or start the engine. This means that your
running.
vehicle’s OBD II system is not ready and you should
not proceed to the I/M station.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
• The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully
illuminated until you turn OFF the ignition or start the
engine. This means that your vehicle’s OBD II system
is ready and you can proceed to the I/M station.
Use of genuine MOPAR® parts for normal/scheduled
maintenance and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures
caused by the use of non-MOPAR® parts for mainteIf your OBD II system is not ready, you should see your nance and repairs will not be covered by the New Vehicle
authorized dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was Limited Warranty.
recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement, DEALER SERVICE
you may need to do nothing more than drive your
vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD II Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personsystem to update. A recheck with the above test routine nel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service
operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are
may then indicate that the system is now ready.
7
424 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
available which include detailed service information for MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before The pages that follow contain the required maintenance
attempting any procedure yourself.
services determined by the engineers who designed your
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control vehicle.
systems may void your warranty and could result in civil Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed
penalties being assessed against you.
“Maintenance Schedule”, there are other components
WARNING!
You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Only do service work for which you
have the knowledge and the proper equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
which may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
• Failure to properly maintain your vehicle or perform repairs and service when necessary could
result in more costly repairs, damage to other
components or negatively impact vehicle performance. Immediately have potential malfunctions
examined by an authorized dealer or qualified
repair center.
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 425
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Your vehicle has been built with improved fluids
that protect the performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended maintenance intervals. Do not use chemical flushes in these components as the chemicals can damage your engine,
transmission, power steering or air conditioning.
Such damage is not covered by the New Vehicle
Limited Warranty. If a flush is needed because of
component malfunction, use only the specified
fluid for the flushing procedure.
Engine Oil
Checking Oil Level
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at
regular intervals, such as every fuel stop. The best time to
check the engine oil level is about five minutes after a
fully warmed engine is shut off. Do not check oil level
before starting the engine after it has sat overnight.
Checking engine oil level when the engine is cold will
give you an incorrect reading.
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground and
only when the engine is hot, will improve the accuracy of
the oil level readings. Maintain the oil level between the
range markings on the dipstick. Either the range markings consist of a crosshatch zone marked SAFE or a
crosshatch zone marked with MIN at the low end of the
range and MAX at the high end of the range. Adding one
quart of oil when the reading is at the low end of the
range marking will raise the oil level to the high end of
the range marking.
7
426 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not overfill the engine. Overfilling the engine
will cause oil aeration, which can lead to loss of oil
pressure and an increase in oil temperature. This
could damage your engine. Also, be sure the oil fill
cap is replaced and tightened after adding oil.
Engine Oil Selection
For best performance and maximum protection under all
types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395.
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil
Identification Symbol
Change Engine Oil
The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is
time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for further information.
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change intervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve
months, whichever occurs first.
This symbol means that the oil has
been certified by the American
Petroleum Institute (API). The
manufacturer only recommends
API Certified engine oils.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 427
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your engine oil as the
chemicals can damage your engine. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Lubricants that do not have both, the engine oil certification mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade number
should not be used.
Engine Oil Viscosity – 3.6L Engine
MOPAR® SAE 5W-20 engine oil or equivalent Pennzoil®
or Shell Helix® is recommended for all operating temMOPAR SAE 5W-20 engine oil or equivalent Pennzoil® peratures. This engine oil improves low temperature
or Shell Helix® is recommended for all operating tem- starting and vehicle fuel economy.
peratures. This engine oil improves low temperature The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended
starting and vehicle fuel economy.
engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended engine oil filler cap location, refer to the “Engine Comengine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on partment” illustration in this section.
Engine Oil Viscosity – 2.4L Engine
the engine oil filler cap location, refer to “Engine Com- NOTE: SAE 5W-30 engine oil may be used when SAE
partment” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further 5W-20 engine oil meeting MS- 6395 is not available.
information.
7
428 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
station or governmental agency for advice on how and
where used oil and oil filters can be safely discarded in
You may use synthetic engine oils provided the recomyour area.
mended oil quality requirements are met, and the recommended maintenance intervals for oil and filter changes Engine Oil Filter
are followed.
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new filter
Materials Added To Engine Oil
at every engine oil change.
Synthetic Engine Oils
The manufacturer strongly recommends against the addition of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) to
the engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product and its
performance may be impaired by supplemental additives.
Engine Oil Filter Selection
This manufacturer’s engines have a full-flow type oil
filter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The quality
of replacement filters varies considerably. Only high
quality filters should be used to assure most efficient
Disposing Of Used Engine Oil And Oil Filters
service. MOPAR® engine oil filters are a high quality oil
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and filter and are recommended.
oil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters, Engine Air Cleaner Filter
indiscriminately discarded, can present a problem to the
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
environment. Contact your authorized dealer, service
maintenance intervals.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 429
WARNING!
The air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.) can
provide a measure of protection in the case of engine
backfire. Do not remove the air induction system (air
cleaner, hoses, etc.) unless such removal is necessary
for repair or maintenance. Make sure that no one is
near the engine compartment before starting the
vehicle with the air induction system (air cleaner,
hoses, etc.) removed. Failure to do so can result in
serious personal injury.
Engine Air Cleaner Filter Selection
The quality of replacement engine air cleaner filters
varies considerably. Only high quality filters should be
used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR® engine air
cleaner filters are a high quality filter and are recommended.
Maintenance-Free Battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free battery.
You will never have to add water, nor is periodic maintenance required.
NOTE: The battery is stored in a compartment behind
the left front fender and is accessible without removing
the tire and wheel. Remote battery terminals are located
in the engine compartment for jump-starting. Refer to
“Jump-Starting Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
To access the battery, turn the steering wheel fully to the
right and remove the inner fender shield.
7
430 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
CAUTION!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can
burn or even blind you. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do not lean
over a battery when attaching clamps. If acid
splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with large amounts of water.
• Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep
flame or sparks away from the battery. Do not use
a booster battery or any other booster source with
an output greater than 12 Volts. Do not allow cable
clamps to touch each other.
• Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands
after handling.
• It is essential when replacing the cables on the
battery that the positive cable is attached to the
positive post and the negative cable is attached to
the negative post. Battery posts are marked positive
(+) and negative (-) and are identified on the
battery case. Cable clamps should be tight on the
terminal posts and free of corrosion.
• If a “fast charger” is used while the battery is in the
vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Do not
use a “fast charger” to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
For best possible performance, your air conditioner should
be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer at the start
of each warm season. This service should include cleaning
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 431
of the condenser fins and a performance test. Drive belt
tension should also be checked at this time.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
system as the chemicals can damage your air conditioning components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WARNING!
• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants
approved by the manufacturer for your air conditioning system. Some unapproved refrigerants are
flammable and can explode, injuring you. Other
unapproved refrigerants or lubricants can cause the
system to fail, requiring costly repairs. Refer to
Warranty Information Book, located on the DVD,
for further warranty information.
• The air conditioning system contains refrigerant
under high pressure. To avoid risk of personal
injury or damage to the system, adding refrigerant
or any repair requiring lines to be disconnected
should be done by an experienced technician.
7
432 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling
WARNING!
R-134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Do not remove the A/C air filter while the blower is
Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product. How- operating or personal injury may result.
ever, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning The A/C Air Filter is located in the fresh air inlet behind
service be performed by authorized dealer or other the glove box. Perform the following procedure to reservice facilities using recovery and recycling equipment. place the filter:
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system 1. Open the glove box and remove all contents.
sealers, stop leak products, seal conditioners, compressor
2. Push in on the sides of the glove box and lower the
oil, and refrigerants.
door.
A/C Air Filter – If Equipped
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 433
3. Disconnect the glove box door dampener from the slot
on the side of the box. This is done by grasping the
dampener connector (on the outside of the box) and the
end of the connector pin (on the inside of the box) with
your thumb and forefinger and pulling outward while
lightly lifting upward on the door with your other hand.
Once disconnected, the dampener will retract underneath the instrument panel if you release it.
4. Pivot the glove box downward.
5. Disengage the two retaining tabs that secure the filter
cover to the HVAC housing and remove the cover.
A/C Air Filter Replacement
6. Remove the A/C Air Filter by pulling it straight out of
the housing.
7
434 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
7. Install the A/C Air Filter with the arrow on the filter
pointing toward the floor. When installing the filter
cover, make sure the retaining tabs fully engage the
cover.
CAUTION!
The A/C air filter is identified with an arrow to
indicate airflow direction through the filter. Failure
to install the filter properly will result in the need to
replace it more often.
MOPAR® Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to the
application of any lubricant, the parts concerned should
be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after lubricating
excess oil and grease should be removed. Particular
attention should also be given to hood latching components to ensure proper function. When performing other
underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism
and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a
year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
8. Reinstall the glove box door dampener and glove box. amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR®
Lock Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.
Body Lubrication
Windshield Wiper Blades
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as
seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate, Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the
tailgate, sliding doors and hood hinges, should be lubri- windshield periodically with a sponge or soft cloth and a
cated periodically with a lithium based grease, such as mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will remove accumulations of salt or road film.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 435
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt
from a dry windshield.
reservoir with windshield washer solvent (not radiator
antifreeze) and operate the system for a few seconds to
flush out the residual water.
When refilling the washer fluid reservoir, apply some
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from washer fluid to a cloth or towel and wipe the wiper
the windshield. Keep the blade rubber out of contact with blades clean. This will help blade performance.
petroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer system
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depend- in cold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets or
ing on geographical area and frequency of use. Poor exceeds the temperature range of your climate. This
performance of blades may be present with chattering, rating information can be found on most washer fluid
marks, water lines or wet spots. If any of these conditions containers.
are present, clean the wiper blades or replace as necesWARNING!
sary.
Adding Washer Fluid
The windshield washer and the rear window washer
share the same fluid reservoir. The fluid reservoir is
located in the engine compartment. Be sure to check the
fluid level in the reservoir at regular intervals. Fill the
Commercially available windshield washer solvents
are flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care
must be exercised when filling or working around
the washer solution.
7
436 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Exhaust System
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system;
or if the exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle;
or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged;
have an authorized technician inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams
or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep
into the passenger compartment. In addition, have the
exhaust system inspected each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
WARNING!
• Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain
carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and
odorless. Breathing it can make you unconscious
and can eventually poison you. To avoid breathing
CO, refer to “Safety Tips/Exhaust Gas” in “Things
To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further
information.
• A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park
over materials that can burn. Such materials might
be grass or leaves coming into contact with your
exhaust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in areas where your exhaust system can contact anything that can burn.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 437
CAUTION!
• The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the
effectiveness of the catalyst as an emissions control
device and may seriously reduce engine performance and cause serious damage to the engine.
• Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your
vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition.
In the event of engine malfunction, particularly
involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of
performance, have your vehicle serviced promptly.
Continued operation of your vehicle with a severe
malfunction could cause the converter to overheat,
resulting in possible damage to the converter and
vehicle.
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic converter will not require maintenance. However, it is important to keep the engine properly tuned to assure
proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst
damage.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed
against you.
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning
engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe
and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop
the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool.
Service, including a tune-up to manufacturer’s specifications, should be obtained immediately.
7
438 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter dam- Cooling System
age:
• Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition,
when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in
motion.
• Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the
vehicle.
• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires
disconnected or removed, such as when diagnostic
testing, or for prolonged periods during very rough
idle or malfunctioning operating conditions.
WARNING!
• When working near the radiator cooling fan,
disconnect the fan motor lead or turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK position. The fan is temperature controlled and can start at anytime the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
• You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had
time to cool. Never try to open a cooling system
pressure cap when the radiator is hot.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 439
Coolant Checks
Cooling System – Drain, Flush, And Refill
Check engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12
months (before the onset of freezing weather, where
applicable). If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or
rusty in appearance, the system should be drained,
flushed, and refilled with fresh engine coolant (antifreeze). Check the front of the A/C condenser for any
accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the
face of the condenser.
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains
visible sediment, have an authorized dealer clean and
flush with OAT coolant (antifreeze) (conforming to MS12106).
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
Selection Of Coolant
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in
Check the coolant recovery bottle tubing for brittle rub- “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
ber, cracking, tears, cuts, and tightness of the connection
at the bottle and radiator. Inspect the entire system for
leaks.
7
440 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) or any “globally compatible” coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, the cooling system will
need to be drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh
OAT coolant (conforming to MS-12106), by an
authorized dealer as soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
(Continued)
Adding Coolant
Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine
coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS-12106) that
allows extended maintenance intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze) can be used up to ten years or 150,000
miles (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reducing this extended maintenance period, it is important that
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 441
you use the same engine coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS-12106) throughout the life of your vehicle.
(antifreeze) solution. The use of lower quality water
will reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the
engine cooling system.
Please review these recommendations for using Organic
Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to mainthat meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Stan- tain the proper level of protection against freezing acdard MS-12106. When adding engine coolant (antifreeze): cording to the temperatures occurring in the area where
the vehicle is operated.
• We recommend using MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant
10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive NOTE: Mixing engine coolant (antifreeze) types is not
Technology) that meets the requirements of Chrysler recommended and can result in cooling system damage.
If HOAT and OAT coolant are mixed in an emergency,
Material Standard MS-12106.
have a authorized dealer drain, flush, and refill with OAT
• Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine coolant
coolant (conforming to MS-12106) as soon as possible.
that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-12106 and distilled water. Use higher concen- Cooling System Pressure Cap
trations (not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of engine
−34° F (−37° C) are anticipated.
coolant (antifreeze), and to ensure that engine coolant
• Use only high purity water such as distilled or deion- (antifreeze) will return to the radiator from the coolant
ized water when mixing the water/engine coolant recovery tank.
7
442 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any Disposal Of Used Engine Coolant
accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces. Used ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is
a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. Check
WARNING!
with your local authorities to determine the disposal
• The warning words “DO NOT OPEN HOT” on the rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by anicooling system pressure cap are a safety precaution. mals or children, do not store ethylene glycol-based
Never add engine coolant (antifreeze) when the engine coolant in open containers or allow it to remain in
engine is overheated. Do not loosen or remove the puddles on the ground. If ingested by a child or pet, seek
cap to cool an overheated engine. Heat causes emergency assistance immediately. Clean up any ground
pressure to build up in the cooling system. To spills immediately.
prevent scalding or injury, do not remove the
pressure cap while the system is hot or under
pressure.
• Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or engine damage may result.
Coolant Level
Four-Cylinder Engines – the coolant bottle provides a
quick visual method for determining that the engine
coolant (antifreeze) level is adequate. With the engine
idling and warm to normal operating temperature, the
level of the engine coolant (antifreeze) in the bottle
should be between the “ADD” and “FULL” lines, shown
on the bottle.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 443
Six-Cylinder Engines – the level of the engine coolant Points To Remember
(antifreeze) in the pressurized coolant bottle should be
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/
between the “COLD” and “FULL” range on the bottle
kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor coming
when the engine is cold.
from the front of the engine compartment. This is norThe radiator normally remains completely full, so there is mally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high
no need to remove the radiator cap unless checking for humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vaporengine coolant (antifreeze) freeze point or replacing cool- ized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot engine
ant. Advise your service attendant of this. As long as the coolant (antifreeze) to enter the radiator.
engine operating temperature is satisfactory, the coolant If an examination of your engine compartment shows no
bottle need only be checked once a month. When addi- evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be
tional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to maintain safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.
the proper level, it should be added to the coolant bottle.
• Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle.
Do not overfill.
• Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator and in the
coolant expansion bottle. If engine coolant (antifreeze)
needs to be added, the contents of the coolant expansion
bottle must also be protected against freezing.
7
444 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• If frequent engine coolant (antifreeze) additions are Brake System
required, the cooling system should be pressure tested In order to assure brake system performance, all brake
for leaks.
system components should be inspected periodically.
• Maintain engine coolant (antifreeze) concentration at a Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
minimum of 50% OAT coolant (conforming to MS- maintenance intervals.
12106) and distilled water for proper corrosion protection of your engine which contains aluminum compoWARNING!
nents.
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and
• Make sure that the coolant expansion bottle overflow possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or
hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally
• Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle is high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and
equipped with air conditioning, keep the front of the possible brake damage. You would not have your full
braking capacity in an emergency.
condenser clean.
• Do not change the thermostat for Summer or Winter Master Cylinder – Brake Fluid Level Check
operation. If replacement is ever necessary, install ONLY
the correct type thermostat. Other designs may result in Check the fluid level in the master cylinder immediately if
unsatisfactory engine coolant (antifreeze) performance, the brake system warning light indicates system failure.
poor gas mileage, and increased emissions.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 445
Check the fluid level in the master cylinder when performing underhood services.
Clean the top of the master cylinder area before removing
the cap. If necessary, add fluid to bring the fluid level up
to the requirements described on the brake fluid reservoir.
Overfilling of fluid is not recommended because it may
cause leaking in the system.
Fluid level can be expected to fall as the brake pads wear.
Brake fluid level should be checked when pads are
replaced. However, low fluid level may be caused by a
leak and a checkup may be needed.
Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
WARNING!
• Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine
Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid
can severely damage your brake system and/or
impair its performance. The proper type of brake
fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the
original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder
reservoir.
(Continued)
7
446 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that has
been in a tightly closed container. Keep the master
cylinder reservoir cap secured at all times. Brake
fluid in a open container absorbs moisture from the
air resulting in a lower boiling point. This may
cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in
spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts, causing
the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can also
damage painted and vinyl surfaces, care should be
taken to avoid its contact with these surfaces.
• Do not allow petroleum based fluid to contaminate
the brake fluid. Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or complete brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
(Continued)
Automatic Transmission
Selection Of Lubricant
It is important to use the proper transmission fluid to
ensure optimum transmission performance and life. Use
only the manufacturer’s specified transmission fluid.
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in this
section for fluid specifications. It is important to maintain
the transmission fluid at the correct level using the
recommended fluid.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 447
NOTE: No chemical flushes should be used in any Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is an engineered
transmission; only the approved lubricant should be product and its performance may be impaired by supplemental additives. Therefore, do not add any fluid addiused.
tives to the transmission. The only exception to this
policy is the use of special dyes for diagnosing fluid
CAUTION!
leaks. Avoid using transmission sealers as they may
Using a transmission fluid other than the manufac- adversely affect seals.
turer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter
CAUTION!
shudder, and will require more frequent fluid and
Do not use chemical flushes in your transmission as
filter changes. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and
the chemicals can damage your transmission compoGenuine Parts” in this section for fluid specificanents. Such damage is not covered by the New
tions.
Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Special Additives
The manufacturer strongly recommends against using
any special additives in the transmission.
7
448 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
6. Remove the dipstick and determine if the fluid is hot
or cold. Hot fluid is approximately 180° F (82° C),
Use the following procedure to check the transmission
which is the normal operating temperature after the
fluid level properly:
vehicle is driven at least 15 miles (24 km). Hot fluid
1. Park the vehicle on level ground.
cannot be held comfortably between the fingertips.
Cold fluid is at a temperature of approximately 80° F
2. Run the engine at normal idle speed for at least 60
(27° C).
seconds, and leave the engine running for the rest of
this procedure.
7. Wipe the dipstick clean and reinsert it until seated.
Then, remove the dipstick and note the fluid level on
3. Fully apply the parking brake, and press the brake
both sides. The fluid level reading is only valid if there
pedal.
is a solid coating of oil on both sides of the dipstick.
4. Place the shift lever momentarily into each gear posiNote that the holes in the dipstick will be full of fluid
tion (allowing time for the transmission to fully enif the actual level is at or above the hole.
gage in each position), ending with the transmission in
• If the fluid is hot, the fluid level should be in the
PARK.
crosshatched area marked “HOT” (between the upper two holes in the dipstick).
5. Wipe the area around the dipstick clean to prevent dirt
• If the fluid is cold, the fluid level should be between
from entering the transmission.
the lower two holes in the area marked “COLD.”
Fluid Level Check – Four-Speed Transmission
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 449
If the fluid level is low, add fluid through the dipstick
tube to bring it to the proper level. Do not overfill. After
adding any quantity of oil through the dipstick tube, wait
at least two minutes for the oil to fully drain into the
transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
8. Check for leaks. Release the parking brake.
To prevent dirt and water from entering the transmission
after checking or replenishing fluid, make sure that the
dipstick cap is properly reseated.
CAUTION!
• Using a transmission fluid other than the manufacturer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter shudder, and will require more frequent
fluid and filter changes. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in this section for fluid
specifications.
• Dirt and water in the transmission can cause serious damage. To prevent dirt and water from entering the transmission after checking or replenishing
fluid, make sure that the dipstick cap is re-seated
properly.
Fluid Level Check – Six-Speed Transmission
The fluid level is preset at the factory and does not
require adjustment under normal operating conditions.
7
450 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Routine fluid level checks are not required, therefore the
transmission filler tube is capped and no dipstick is
provided. Your authorized dealer can check your transmission fluid level using a special service dipstick. If you
notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunction, visit
your authorized dealer immediately to have the transmission fluid level checked. Operating the vehicle with
an improper fluid level can cause severe transmission
damage.
CAUTION!
• If a transmission fluid leak occurs, visit your authorized dealer immediately. Severe transmission
damage may occur. Your authorized dealer has the
proper tools to adjust the fluid level accurately.
Fluid And Filter Changes
Refer to the ⬙Maintenance Schedule⬙ for the proper
maintenance intervals. In addition, change the fluid and
filter if the fluid becomes contaminated (with water, etc.),
or if the transmission is disassembled for any reason.
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
Protection Of Body And Paint From Corrosion
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads
passable in snow and ice and those that are sprayed on
trees and road surfaces during other seasons are highly
corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,
which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,
road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme
hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will
have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and underbody protection.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 451
The following maintenance recommendations will enable Washing
you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion • Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your veresistance built into your vehicle.
hicle in the shade using MOPAR® Car Wash, or a mild
car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with
What Causes Corrosion?
clear water.
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of
• If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumupaint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
lated on your vehicle, use MOPAR® Super Kleen Bug
The most common causes are:
and Tar Remover to remove.
• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
• Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR®
• Stone and gravel impact.
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect
your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
• Insects, tree sap and tar.
• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.
• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing that
may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish.
7
452 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials
such as steel wool or scouring powder that will
scratch metal and painted surfaces.
• Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274
kPa) can result in damage or removal of paint and
decals.
• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint,
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is
considered the responsibility of the owner.
• If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar
cause that destroys the paint and protective coating,
have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The
cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of
the owner.
• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers,
de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well
• If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive
packaged and sealed.
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once
a month.
• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
• It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and • Use MOPAR® Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as
open.
possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to
match the color of your vehicle.
Special Care
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 453
Wheel And Wheel Trim Care
Cleaning Headlights
• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlights and fog
chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly lights (if equipped) that are lighter and less susceptible to
stone breakage than glass headlights.
with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
• To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner.
CAUTION!
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle brush,
or metal polishes. Do not use oven cleaner. These
products may damage the wheel’s protective finish.
Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic solutions
or harsh brushes that may damage the wheel’s protective finish. Only MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner or
equivalent is recommended.
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution followed by rinsing.
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.
7
454 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Stain Repel Fabric Cleaning Procedure – If
Equipped
Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following manner:
Interior Care
Instrument Panel Cover
The instrument panel cover has a low glare surface,
• Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting which minimizes reflections in the windshield. Do not
with a clean, dry towel.
use protectants or other products, which may cause
undesirable reflections. Use soap and warm water to
• Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
restore the low glare surface.
• For tough stains, apply MOPAR® Total Clean, or a
Cleaning Interior Trim
mild soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove
stain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue. Interior Trim should be cleaned starting with a damp
cloth, a damp cloth with MOPAR® Total Clean or equiva• For grease stains, apply MOPAR® Multi-Purpose
lent, then MOPAR® Spot & Stain Remover or equivalent
Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use
if absolutely necessary. Do not use harsh cleaners or
a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
Armor All®. Use MOPAR® Total Clean or equivalent to
• Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of clean vinyl upholstery
protectants on Stain Repel products.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 455
Cleaning Leather Upholstery
MOPAR® Total Clean or equivalent is specifically recommended for leather upholstery.
Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular
cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt
can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery
and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.
Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth
and MOPAR® Total Clean or equivalent. Care should be
taken to avoid soaking your leather upholstery with any
liquid. Please do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids,
solvents, detergents, or ammonia-based cleaners to clean
your leather upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not required to maintain the original condition.
WARNING!
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.
Glass Surfaces
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis
with MOPAR® Glass Cleaner, or any commercial
household-type glass cleaner. Never use an abrasive type
cleaner. Use caution when cleaning the inside rear window equipped with electric defrosters or the right rear
quarter window equipped with the radio antenna. Do
not use scrapers or other sharp instrument that may
scratch the elements.
When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the
towel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleaner
directly on the mirror.
7
456 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the
buckles do not work properly.
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care Cleaning Center Console Cupholders
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
Removal
1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be
Grab the rubber portion of the cupholder and lift upused, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasive
ward.
cleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp
Cleaning
rag.
Soak the rubber cupholder liner in a mixture of medium
hot tap water and one teaspoon of mild liquid dish soap.
Seat Belt Maintenance
Let soak for approximately one hour. After one hour pull
Do not bleach, dye, or clean the belts with chemical the liner from the water and dip it back into the water
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric. about six times. This will loosen any remaining debris.
Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
Rinse the liner thoroughly under warm running water.
Shake the excess water from the liner and dry the outer
If the belts need cleaning, use MOPAR® Total Clean, a
surfaces with a clean soft cloth.
mild soap solution, or lukewarm water. Do not remove
the belts from the vehicle to wash them. Dry with a soft
cloth.
2. Dry with a soft cloth.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 457
Installation
WARNING!
Align the liner in the cupholder and press down firmly.
FUSES
If the replaced fuse blows again, contact an authorized dealer.
WARNING!
WARNING!
• When replacing a blown fuse, always use an appropriate replacement fuse with the same amp rating as
the original fuse. Never replace a fuse with another
fuse of higher amp rating. Never replace a blown fuse
with metal wires or any other material. Failure to use
proper fuses may result in serious personal injury,
fire and/or property damage.
• Before replacing a fuse, make sure that the ignition
is off and that all the other services are switched off
and/or disengaged.
If a general protection fuse for safety systems (air bag
system, braking system), power unit systems (engine
system, gearbox system) or steering system blows,
contact an authorized Dealer.
Integrated Power Module
The Integrated Power Module is located in the engine
compartment near the air cleaner assembly. This center
contains cartridge fuses and mini fuses. A label that
identifies each component may be printed on the inside
of the cover. Refer to the graphic below for FUSES/TIPM
location.
7
458 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
2
Cartridge
Fuse
—
3
—
4
—
5
—
6
—
Cavity
Integrated Power Module
Cavity
1
Cartridge
Fuse
40 Amp
Green
Mini
Fuse
—
Description
Power Top Module
– If Equipped
Mini
Fuse
20 Amp
Yellow
10 Amp
Red
10 Amp
Red
20 Amp
Yellow
10 Amp
Red
Description
Brake Vacuum
Pump
Center High
Mounted Stop
Light (CHMSL)/
Brake Switch
Ignition Switch
Trailer Tow – If
Equipped
Power Mirror
Switch/Climate
Controls
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 459
7
Cartridge
Fuse
—
8
—
9
40 Amp
Green
10
—
Cavity
11
—
Mini
Fuse
30 Amp
Green
30 Amp
Green
20 Amp
Yellow
15 Amp
Lt Blue
Description
Cavity
Ignition Off Draw
(IOD) Sense 1
Ignition Off Draw
(IOD) Sense 2
Battery Feed –
Power Seats – If
Equipped
Instrument Panel/
Power Locks/
Interior Lights
Selectable Power
Outlet (Inside Center Arm Rest)
12
Cartridge
Fuse
—
13
—
14
—
15
40 Amp
Green
—
16
Mini
Fuse
Description
20 Amp
Yellow
20 Amp
Yellow
10 Amp
Red
—
—
Radiator Fan Relay
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
Sunroof – If
Equipped
Ignition/Cigar
Lighter
Instrument Panel
7
460 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
17
18
Cartridge
Fuse
—
19
40 Amp
Green
—
20
—
21
—
Mini
Fuse
10 Amp
Red
—
20 Amp
Yellow
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
10 Amp
Red
Description
Cavity
Wireless Control
Module (WCM)/
Clock/Steering
Control Module
(SCM)
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay
Audio Amplifier –
If Equipped
Radio
22
Cartridge
Fuse
—
23
—
24
—
25
—
Siren – If Equipped
26
—
Mini
Fuse
10 Amp
Red
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
25 Amp
Natural
10 Amp
Red
15 Amp
Lt. Blue
Description
Ignition Run – Climate Controls/Hot
Cupholder – If
Equipped
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay 3
Sunroof – If
Equipped
Ignition Run —
Heated Mirrors - If
Equipped
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay 2
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 461
Cavity
27
28
29
Cartridge
Fuse
—
—
—
Mini
Fuse
10 Amp
Red
10 Amp
Red
—
Description
Cavity
Ignition Run – Occupant Classification Module
(OCM)/Occupant
Restraint Controller
(ORC)
Ignition Run —
Occupant Classification Module
(OCM)/Occupant
Restraint Controller
(ORC)
Hot Car (No Fuse
Required)
30
31
32
33
Cartridge
Fuse
—
—
30 Amp
Pink
—
Mini
Fuse
20 Amp
Yellow
—
—
10 Amp
Red
Description
Ignition Run –
Heated Seats – If
Equipped
Spare
Auto Shutdown
(ASD) Relay 1
Switch Bank/
Diagnostic Link
Connector/
Powertrain Control
Module (PCM)
7
462 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
34
35
Cartridge
Fuse
30 Amp
Pink
40 Amp
Green
Mini
Fuse
—
—
Description
Cavity
Anti-Lock Brakes
(ABS) Module – If
Equipped/
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC)
Module – If
Equipped
Anti-Lock Brakes
(ABS) Module – If
Equipped/
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC)
Module – If
Equipped
36
37
Cartridge
Fuse
30 Amp
Pink
—
Mini
Fuse
—
25 Amp
Natural
Description
Passenger Door
Module (PDM)/
Driver Door Module (DDM)
Power Top Module
– If Equipped
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 463
CAUTION!
• When installing the Integrated Power Module
cover, it is important to ensure the cover is properly
positioned and fully latched. Failure to do so may
allow water to get into the Integrated Power Module, and possibly result in an electrical system
failure.
• When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use
only a fuse having the correct amperage rating. The
use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may
result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If
a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates
a problem in the circuit that must be corrected.
VEHICLE STORAGE
If you will not be using your vehicle for more than 21
days, you may want to take steps to preserve your
battery.
• Disengage the mini-fuse in the Power Distribution
Center labeled IOD (Ignition Off-Draw).
• Or disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
• Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of
service (i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the
air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes
in the fresh air and high blower setting. This will
ensure adequate system lubrication to minimize the
possibility of compressor damage when the system is
started again.
7
464 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
REPLACEMENT BULBS
Exterior Bulbs
Interior Bulbs
Front Courtesy/Reading
Lamp
Center Courtesy/Reading
Lamp
Visor Vanity Lamp
Glove Box Lamp
Shift Indicator Lamp
Rear Compartment
(Trunk) Lamp
Bulb Number
578/W5W
578/W5W
A6220
A6220
IKLE14140
579
NOTE: For lighted switches, see your authorized
dealer for replacement.
Bi-Halogen Headlamp
Front Turn Signal Lamp
Front Park Lamp
Front Fog Lamp
Center High Mounted
Stop (CHMSL) Lamp
Rear Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp
Backup Lamp
License Lamp
Bulb Number
HIR2
3157NAK
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
H11
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
LED (Serviced at Authorized Dealer)
921
W5W
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 465
2. To begin removal of the driver side headlamp, reach in
through the inner fender headlamp access door and
NOTE: Lens fogging can occur under certain atmograsp the bulb cover.
spheric conditions. This will usually clear as atmospheric
conditions change to allow the condensation to change
back into a vapor. Turning the lamps on will usually
accelerate the clearing process.
BULB REPLACEMENT
Headlamp
1. Raise and prop open the hood. Locate the connector
behind the headlamp.
NOTE: To service the driver’s or passenger side headlamp, it is necessary turn the steering wheel to access the
inner fender headlamp access door.
7
1 — Headlamp
2 — Turn Signal
466 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
To begin removal of the passenger side headlamp, reach 3. Rotate bulb cover and one-quarter turn and pull
in through the inner fender headlamp access door and
outward from assembly.
grasp the bulb cover.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 467
4. Rotate bulb and connector one-quarter turn and pull 5. Pull the bulb out of the socket and replace the bulb.
outward from assembly.
6. If the bulb comes in contact with any oily surface,
wipe the bulb with a clean cloth and rubbing alcohol.
CAUTION!
Do not touch the new bulb with your fingers. Oil
contamination will severely shorten bulb life.
7. Reinsert the bulb and socket assembly and rotate
clockwise one-quarter turn to secure.
7
468 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
8. Place bulb cover back and rotate one-quarter turn Front Fog Lamp
clockwise to secure.
NOTE: Access to the lamps through the lower fascia
Front Turn Signal
cutout is limited. We recommend you access the lamps by
turning the steering wheel to allow access and remove
1. Raise and prop open the hood.
the inner fender shield.
2. Rotate the bulb’s electrical connector one-quarter turn
1. Rotate the bulb’s electrical connector one-quarter turn
counterclockwise and remove it from the headlamp
counterclockwise and remove it from the fog lamp
housing.
housing.
3. Remove the bulb from the connector socket and install
2. Remove the bulb from the connector socket and install
the replacement bulb.
the replacement bulb.
4. Install the bulb and connector assembly into the
headlamp housing and rotate the connector oneCAUTION!
quarter turn clockwise to lock it in place.
Do not touch the new bulb with your fingers. Oil
contamination will severely shorten bulb life. If the
bulb comes in contact with an oily surface, clean the
bulb with rubbing alcohol.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 469
3. Install the bulb and connector assembly into the fog
lamp housing and rotate the connector one-quarter
turn clockwise to lock it in place.
Backup Lamps
1. Open the trunk and gently pull back the trunk liner
behind the tail lamp (requires removal of a push pin
holding the trunk trim in place near the tail lamp).
2. Remove the two plastic wing nuts from the tail lamp
housing.
NOTE: Placing a small flat head screwdriver or similar
tool between the lamp outboard ball stud and plastic
grommet from inside the trunk can help to disengage the
outboard edge of the tail lamp.
3. Grasp the tail lamp by both the outboard and inboard
sides, and pull firmly to disengage the tail lamp from
the vehicle.
7
470 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: It is normal to hear a loud sound when the lower 6. Reinstall the tail lamp, fasteners, and trunk liner.
tail lamp area unsnaps from the vehicle mounting
License Plate Lamp
bracket during tail lamp removal.
1. Using a small screwdriver, press inward the locking
tab on the side of the lamp assembly and pull down on
the lamp assembly for removal.
2. Pull bulb from socket, replace, and reinstall the lamp
assembly into place ensuring the locking tab is secure.
4. Twist and remove socket from lamp.
5. Remove bulb from socket and replace.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 471
FLUID CAPACITIES
U.S.
Fuel (Approximate)
All Engines — (Except 2.4L PZEV)
16.9 Gallons
2.4L PZEV (Partial Zero Emissions Vehicle)
18.5 Gallons
Engine Oil With Filter
2.4L Engine (SAE 5W-20, API Certified)
4.5 Quarts
3.6L Engine (SAE 5W-20, API Certified)
6 Quarts
Cooling System*
2.4L Engine (MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine
7.7 Quarts
Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula or
equivalent)
11.6 Quarts
3.6L Engine (MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine
Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula or
equivalent)
* Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX level.
Metric
64 Liters
70 Liters
4.26 Liters
5.6 Liters
7.3 Liters
7
11 Liters
472 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS
Engine
Component
Engine Coolant
Engine Oil – 2.4L Engine
Engine Oil – 3.6L Engine
Engine Oil Filter
Spark Plugs – 2.4L Engine except PZEV*
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile
Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology).
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting the
requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as MOPAR, Pennzoil®, and Shell Helix®. Refer to your engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-20 Engine Oil, meeting the
requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS-6395 such as MOPAR, Pennzoil®, and Shell Helix®. Refer to your engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Engine Oil Filter.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs (Gap 0.043 in [1.1 mm]).
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 473
Component
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
Spark Plugs – 2.4L with PZEV* We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs (Gap 0.031 in [0.8 mm]).
Spark Plugs – 3.6L Engine
We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs (Gap 0.043 in [1.1 mm]).
Fuel Selection
87 Octane
* PZEV = Partial Zero Emission Vehicle
Chassis
Component
Automatic Transmission
Brake Master Cylinder
Power Steering Reservoir
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
Use only ATF+4® Automatic Transmission Fluid. Failure to use ATF+4® fluid
may affect the function or performance of your transmission. We recommend
MOPAR® ATF+4® fluid.
We recommend you use MOPAR® DOT 3 and SAE J1703. If DOT 3 brake fluid
is not available, then DOT 4 is acceptable.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Power Steering Fluid +4, MOPAR® ATF+4®
Automatic Transmission Fluid.
7
M
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
▫ Maintenance Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .478 N
C
E
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
䡵 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . .476
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
M
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
476 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
than your authorized dealer, the message can be reset by
referring to the steps described under “Electronic Vehicle
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic oil change
Information Center (EVIC)/Oil Change Required” in
indicator system. The oil change indicator system will
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further inremind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for
formation.
scheduled maintenance.
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change interBased on engine operation conditions, the oil change
vals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months,
indicator message will illuminate. This means that serwhichever comes first.
vice is required for your vehicle. Operating conditions
such as frequent short-trips, trailer tow, extremely hot or Once A Month Or Before A Long Trip:
cold ambient temperatures, and E85 fuel usage will
• Check engine oil level
influence when the “Oil Change Required” message is
displayed. Severe Operating Conditions can cause the • Check windshield washer fluid level
change oil message to illuminate as early as 3,500 miles
(5,600 km) since last reset. Have your vehicle serviced as • Check the tire inflation pressures and look for unusual
wear or damage
soon as possible, within the next 500 miles (805 km).
• Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoir, brake
Your authorized dealer will reset the oil change indicator
master cylinder, power steering and transmission
message after completing the scheduled oil change. If a
(four-speed only) and fill as needed
scheduled oil change is performed by someone other
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 477 M
• Check function of all interior and exterior lights
Required Maintenance Intervals.
Refer to the maintenance schedules on the following
page for the required maintenance intervals.
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
• Change oil and filter.
• Rotate the tires. Rotate at the first sign of irregular wear, even if it occurs before the oil indicator
system turns on.
• Inspect battery and clean and tighten terminals as
required.
• Inspect automatic transmission fluid if equipped
with dipstick.
• Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, hoses
and park brake.
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
• Inspect engine cooling system protection and
hoses.
• Inspect exhaust system.
• Inspect engine air cleaner if using in dusty or
off-road conditions.
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
8
Additional Inspections
Inspect the CV joints.
Inspect front suspension, tie rod
ends, boot seals and replace if
necessary.
Inspect the brake linings, replace
as necessary.
Adjust parking brake as necessary
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
2
32,000
M 478 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
A
I Maintenance Chart
N
T
Mileage or time passed
E
(whichever comes first)
N
A
N
Or Years:
C
E
Or Kilometers:
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Additional Maintenance
Replace engine air filter.
Replace cabin/air conditioning
filter.
Replace spark plugs (2.4L Engine). **
Replace spark plugs (2.4L PZEV
Engine Only). **
Replace spark plugs (3.6L Engine). **
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 479 M
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
Flush and replace the engine
coolant at 10 years or
150,000 miles (240,000 km)
whichever comes first.
Change automatic transmission
fluid and filter if using your vehicle for any of the following: police, taxi, fleet, or frequent trailer
towing.
Change automatic transmission
fluid and filter.
Inspect and replace PCV valve if
necessary.
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
32,000
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
M 480 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
A
I
Mileage or time passed
N
(whichever comes first)
T
E
N
Or Years:
A
Or
Kilometers:
N
C
E
X
X
X
X
X
X
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 481 M
** The spark plug change interval is mileage based only,
yearly intervals do not apply.
WARNING!
• You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you
have the knowledge and the right equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
• Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and
effect vehicle handling and performance. This
could cause an accident.
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
䡵 SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
▫ Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
▫ Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . .485
▫ Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485 䡵 WARRANTY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . .485 䡵 MOPAR® PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
䡵 IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485 䡵 REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS . . . . . . . . . . . .489
▫ Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center. . . . . . .486
▫ In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C. . .489
▫ Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center . . . . . .486
▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
▫ In Mexico Contact:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487 䡵 PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .490
9
484 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
䡵 DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
▫ Treadwear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
▫ Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
▫ Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .492
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 485
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.
At many authorized dealer, you may obtain a rental
vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it
is advisable to make these arrangements when you call
for an appointment.
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have
the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history. This can often provide a clue to the IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
current problem.
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally
Prepare A List
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy
Make a written list of your vehicle’s problems or the with our products and services.
specific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer.
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an
service advisor know.
authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and
are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality
service. The manufacturer’s authorized dealer have the
9
486 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and • Authorized dealer name
the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
correctly and in a timely manner.
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage
This is why you should always talk to an authorized
dealer service manager first. Most matters can be re- Chrysler Group LLC Customer Center
solved with this process.
P.O. Box 21–8004
• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004
general manager or owner of the authorized dealer.
Phone: (800) 247–9753
They want to know if you need assistance.
• If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the con- Chrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center
cern, you may contact the manufacturer’s customer P.O. Box 1621
center.
Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6
Any communication to the manufacturer’s customer cenPhone: (800) 465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French
ter should include the following information:
• Owner’s name and address
• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 487
Mexico, D. F.
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require
assistance can use the special needs relay service offered
by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711
and for Voice callers, dial 1 800 855-0511 to connect with
a Bell Relay Service operator.
In Mexico City: 5081-7568
Service Contract
Outside Mexico City: 1-800-505-1300
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle
to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected
repairs after the manufacturer’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only
the manufacturer’s service contracts. If you purchased a
manufacturer’s service contract, you will receive Plan
Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail
within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you
have any questions about the service contract, call the
manufacturer’s Service Contract National Customer
Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call (800)
465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French).
In Mexico Contact:
Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240
Sante Fe C.P. 05109
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY)
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer
center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter
(TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the
manufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.
9
488 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service
contract that is not the manufacturer’s service contract. It
is not responsible for any service contract other than the
manufacturer’s service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer’s service contract,
and you require service after the manufacturer’s New
Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the
contract documents, and contact the person listed in
those documents.
We appreciate that you have made a major investment
when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer
has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and
training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with
the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their
sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related
concerns.
WARNING!
Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain
vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals
known to the State of California to cause cancer and
birth defects, or other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of component wear contain, or emit, chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer
and birth defects, or other reproductive harm.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the
DVD, for the terms and provisions of Chrysler Group
LLC warranties applicable to this vehicle and market.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 489
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your authorized
MOPAR® fluids, lubricants, parts, and accessories are
dealer, and the manufacturer.
available from an authorized dealer. They are recommended for your vehicle in order to help keep the vehicle To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety
Hotline toll free at 1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–
operating at its best.
9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
West Building, Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could http://www.safercar.gov.
cause a crash or cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety In Canada
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you
manufacturer.
should contact the Customer Service Department immeIf NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an diately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in defect to the Canadian government should contact Transa group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy port Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and
Recalls at 1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety/
MOPAR® PARTS
9
490 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
To order the following manuals, you may use either the
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mastercard, American Express, and Discover orders are accepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call
for an order form.
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams,
charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals
make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix
problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and
features. They show exactly how to find and correct
problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshootNOTE: A street address is required when ordering
ing and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests
manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
Service Manuals
Owner’s Manuals
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the inforThese Owner’s Manuals have been prepared with the
mation that students and professional technicians need in
assistance of service and engineering specialists to acdiagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintainquaint you with specific Chrysler Group LLC vehicles.
ing, servicing, and repairing Chrysler Group LLC veIncluded are starting, operating, emergency and maintehicles. A complete working knowledge of the vehicle,
system, and/or components is written in straightforward nance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities
and safety tips.
language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 491
Call toll free at:
Treadwear
• 1–800–890–4038 (U.S.)
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on the
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a
tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well
on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative
performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of
their use, however, and may depart significantly from the
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices,
and differences in road characteristics and climate.
• 1–800–387–1143 (Canada)
Or
Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
• www.techauthority.com
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES
The following tire grading categories were established by
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The
specific grade rating assigned by the tire’s manufacturer
in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on
your vehicle.
All passenger car tires must conform to Federal safety
requirements in addition to these grades.
Traction Grades
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
and C. These grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on
wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.
A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
9
492 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
WARNING!
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
Temperature Grades
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all
passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test
wheel, than the minimum required by law.
WARNING!
The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure.
INDEX
10
494 INDEX
About Your Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
ABS (Anti-Lock Brake System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .440
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
Airbag. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Airbag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Airbag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Airbag Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Airbag, Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Airbag, Window (Side Curtain) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . .428
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
Air Conditioning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Air Conditioning Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Air Conditioning, Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Air Pressure, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .342
Alarm System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Antenna, Satellite Radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .442
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Anti-Theft Security Alarm (Theft Alarm) . . . . . . . . . .19
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
Ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Assistance Towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Auto Down Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Automatic Oil Change Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .275
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
INDEX 495
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293 Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
Anti-Lock (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .448
Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
Fluid and Filter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .448
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .446
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Special Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .447 Brake/Transmission Interlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312 Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Auto Unlock, Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Bulbs, Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Auto Up Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Calibration, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429 Capacities, Antifreeze (Engine Coolant). . . . . . . . . . .21
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) . . . . . . . .26 Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .471
Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429 Caps, Filler
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .336
Radiator (Coolant Pressure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .441
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319 Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
10
496 INDEX
Car Washes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .451
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Certification Label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
Check Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator Light) . .422
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Checks, Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Child Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Cigar Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Clean Air Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Cleaning
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Cold Weather Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Compact Disc (CD) Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Compass Variance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Computer, Trip/Travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Connector
UCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) . . . . . . . . . .261
Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Console, Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Coolant Pressure Cap (Radiator Cap) . . . . . . . . . . .441
Cooling System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .440
Coolant Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .471
Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .442
Drain, Flush, and Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .442
INDEX 497
Dimmer Switch, Headlight. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Dipsticks
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .448
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Disabled Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .413
Disposal
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .442
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Door Locks, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Driving
Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow Standing
Data Recorder, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Dealer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Deck Lid, Power Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 E-85 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
Defroster, Rear Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199 Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 Electric Rear Window Defrost. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Delay (Intermittent) Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170 Electric Remote Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421 Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . .174
Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .443
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .441
Radiator Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .441
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
Crankcase Ventilation Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Cruise Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Customer Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
10
498 INDEX
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) . . . . . .222
Emergency, In Case of
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .413
Emergency Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . .422
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Block Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Checking Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .420
Compartment Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .420
Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .439
Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Flooded, Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .425
Oil Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .419
Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
Oil Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Engine Oil Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
Engine Oil Viscosity Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
Enhanced Accident Response Feature . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Entry System, Illuminated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Exhaust Gas Caution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
INDEX 499
Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Fabric Care. . . . . . . . .
Filler Location Fuel . . .
Filters
Air Cleaner . . . . . .
Air Conditioning . .
Engine Oil . . . . . . .
Engine Oil Disposal
Flashers . . . . . . . . . . .
Hazard Warning . . .
Turn Signal . . . . . .
Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . .
Flexible Fuel Vehicles
Cruising Range . . . .
Engine Oil . . . . . . .
Fuel Requirements .
Maintenance . . . . . .
Replacement Parts . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.428
.282
.428
.428
.392
.392
.100
.166
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.370
.369
.367
.370
.370
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flooded Engine Starting . . . . . . . . .
Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fluid Level Checks
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . .
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts
Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fog Light Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.370
.291
.471
.100
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.448
.444
.439
.425
.318
.472
.166
.468
.159
.410
.363
.371
.365
.363
10
500 INDEX
Ethanol . . . . . . . . . .
Filler Cap (Gas Cap) .
Filler Door (Gas Cap)
Gasoline . . . . . . . . . .
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . .
Light . . . . . . . . . . . .
Materials Added . . . .
Methanol . . . . . . . . .
Octane Rating . . . . . .
Requirements . . . . . .
Tank Capacity . . . . . .
Fuel, Flexible . . . . . . . .
Fueling . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel System Caution . . .
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.364
.206
.206
.363
.206
.207
.365
.364
.363
.363
.471
.367
.371
.372
.457
Gauges
Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Gear Select Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .455
Gross Axle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
GVWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
Hands-Free Phone (Uconnect®) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hazard
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow
Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gas Cap (Fuel Filler Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363 Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . .109
. . .315
. . .392
. . .465
INDEX 501
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Infant Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Information Center, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
Inside Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Instrument Panel and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Instrument Panel Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .456
Integrated Power Module (Fuses) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .457
Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
. . . . . . . . .378 Intermittent Wipers (Delay Wipers). . . . . . . . . . . . .170
. . . . . . . . .161 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
. . . . . . . . .160
Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .396
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Beam/Low Beam Select Switch
On With Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heated Seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Heater, Engine Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hitches
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hood Prop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.465
.453
.165
.165
.164
.166
.465
.163
.154
.108
.150
.270
.293
10
502 INDEX
Jack Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394 Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406 Light Bulbs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Back-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .469
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Keyless Entry System (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Brake Assist Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
Key, Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Daytime Running . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Key, Sentry (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) Indicator . . . . .328
Knee Bolster. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Engine Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Lane Change and Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Lap/Shoulder Belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Headlights On With Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Headlight Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Leaks, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
INDEX 503
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .470
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Low Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) . . . . . . . . .218
Map Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Security Alarm (Theft Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
Theft Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . .206
Loading Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .336
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Auto Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Child Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Low Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
Lumbar Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Maintenance Free Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Malfunction Indicator Light (Check Engine).
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Map/Reading Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Master Cylinder (Brakes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.429
.424
.476
.218
.490
.168
.444
10
504 INDEX
Methanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
Mini-Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Electric Powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Vanity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Monitor, Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Mopar Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
MTBE/ETBE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Occupant Restraints (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Octane Rating, Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Odometer. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Oil Change Indicator . . . . .
Oil Change Indicator, Reset
Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . .
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . .
Change Interval . . . . . .
Checking . . . . . . . . . . .
Dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . .
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . .
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Filter Disposal . . . . . . .
Identification Logo . . . .
Materials Added to . . . .
Recommendation . . . . .
Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . .
Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . .
Oil Filter, Selection . . . . . .
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.210
.210
.212
.212
.425
.471
.212
.425
.425
.428
.428
.428
.426
.428
.426
.428
.427
.428
.208
INDEX 505
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
Operating Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
Operator Manual (Owner’s Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Owner’s Manual (Operator Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .450
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Personal Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Pets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Phone, Cellular . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Phone, Hands-Free (Uconnect®) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Placard, Tire and Loading Information . . . . . . . . . .337
Power
Deck Lid Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Outlet (Auxiliary Electrical Outlet) . . . . . . . . . . .189
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Pregnant Women and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Preparation for Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
Pretensioners
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Programmable Electronic Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radiator Cap (Coolant Pressure Cap)
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radio Remote Controls . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Cupholder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Seat, Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.344
.441
.270
.268
.194
.159
.105
.199
10
506 INDEX
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Recorder, Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
Reminder, Seat Belt. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Remote Control
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Remote Keyless Entry (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Remote Sound System (Radio) Controls . . . . . . . . .268
Remote Starting System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Remote Trunk Release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .464
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Replacement Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .423
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
Resetting Oil Change Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Restraint, Head. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
Safety, Exhaust Gas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Satellite Radio Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .476
Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .456
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Adjustable Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Anchorage . . . . . . . . .51
And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
INDEX 507
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Seat Belts (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Lumbar Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Rear Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Reclining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Security Alarm (Theft Alarm). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .472
Sentry Key (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Sentry Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .485
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .487
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .490
Settings, Personal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Setting the Clock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Shift Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Side Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Side Window Demisters (Defrosters) . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Signals, Turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Snow Chains (Tire Chains) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345
Spare Tire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
Speed Control (Cruise Control). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Speedometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
10
508 INDEX
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Cold Weather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Engine Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Starting and Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Starting Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Steering
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Steering Wheel Audio Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
Steering Wheel Mounted Sound System Controls . . .268
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .463
Storage, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Supplemental Restraint System - Airbag . . . . . . . . . .60
Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Tachometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Taillights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .469
Telescoping Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Temperature Control, Automatic (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .275
Temperature Gauge, Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Theft Alarm (Security Alarm). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Theft System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Time Delay, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Tire and Loading Information Placard . . . . . . . . . . .336
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Aging (Life of Tires) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .343
INDEX 509
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . .
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)
Pressure Warning Light . . . . . . .
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . .
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . .
Tongue Weight/Trailer Weight . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.342
.394
.350
.336
.354
.216
.491
.344
.351
.353
.330
.331
.345
.394
.349
.382
.349
.330
.379
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
24-Hour Towing Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .413
Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Towing Assistance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Cooling System Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
Hitches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
Minimum Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381
Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
Trailer and Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .384
Trailer Towing Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Trailer Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Transaxle
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
10
510 INDEX
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .446
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Transmitter Battery Service (Remote Keyless Entry). . . .26
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Trip Odometer Reset Button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213
Trunk Lid (Deck Lid) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Trunk Release, Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Trunk Release Remote Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
UCI Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Uconnect® (Hands-Free Phone) . . . . .
Understanding Your Instrument Panel.
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) Connector . . . .261
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Upholstery Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .454
Vanity Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Variance, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Vehicle Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
Vehicle Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Vehicle Theft Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Viscosity, Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
.261 Voice Recognition System (VR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
.109
.204 Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . . .206
.491 Warnings and Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
INDEX 511
Washer
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .451
Water
Driving Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
Wheel and Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
Wheel and Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
Wind Buffeting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .435
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
Wipers, Intermittent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
10
INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING
EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this vehicle’s
electronic system to provide immunity to radio frequency signals.
Mobile two-way radios and telephone equipment must be installed
properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed
during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly to the
battery and fused as close to the battery as possible. The negative
power connection should be made to body sheet metal adjacent to
the negative battery connection. This connection should not be
fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the roof or the
rear area of the vehicle. Care should be used in mounting antennas
with magnet bases. Magnets may affect the accuracy or operation
of the compass on vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and routed away
from the vehicle wiring when possible. Use only fully shielded
coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to ensure a low
Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than normal
may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications equipment and the vehicle’s electronic
systems.
2014 200
2014
OWNER’S MANUAL
Chrysler Group LLC
14C41-126-AA
First Edition
Printed in U.S.A.
200